Annual Statements Open main menu

Veritex Holdings, Inc. - Annual Report: 2020 (Form 10-K)



UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549
FORM 10-K
Annual Report to Section 13 OR 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934
 
For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2020
OR
Transition Report Pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934
 
For the transition period from to
Commission File No. 001-36682
Veritex Holdings, Inc.
(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)
Texas 27-0973566
(State or other jurisdiction of
incorporation or organization)
 (I.R.S. Employer
Identification No.)
8214 Westchester Drive, Suite 800
Dallas, Texas
75225
(Address of principal executive offices)Zip Code

(972) 349 6200
(Registrant’s telephone number, including area code)

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:
Title of Each Class Trading SymbolName of Each Exchange on Which Registered
Common Stock, par value $0.01 VBTXNasdaq Global Market
Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act: None
 
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act. Yes ¨ No
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act. Yes ¨ No
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days. Yes No ¨
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically every Interactive Data File required to be submitted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§ 232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files). Yes No ¨
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, a smaller reporting company or an emerging growth company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer,” “smaller reporting company” and "emerging growth company"in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.
Large Accelerated Filer
Accelerated filer ☐
Non-accelerated filer ¨
Smaller reporting company ☐
Emerging growth company ☐
If an emerging growth company, indicate by check mark if the registrant has elected not to use the extended transition period for complying with any new or revised financial accounting standards provided pursuant to Section 13(a) of the Exchange Act. ☐

 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has filed a report on and attestation to its management’s assessment of the effectiveness of its internal control over financial reporting under Section 404(b) of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act (15 U.S.C. 7262(b)) by the registered public accounting firm that prepared or issued its audit report.
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Act). Yes No
The aggregate market value of the shares of common stock held by non-affiliates based on the closing price of the common stock on the Nasdaq Global Market on June 30, 2020 was approximately $853,904,000.
 
At February 25, 2021, we had outstanding 49,423,873 shares of common stock, par value $0.01 per share.
Documents Incorporated By Reference:




Portions of the registrant’s Definitive Proxy Statement relating to the 2021 Annual Meeting of Shareholders are incorporated by reference into Part III of this Annual Report on Form 10-K to the extent stated herein. Such Definitive Proxy Statement will be filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission within 120 days after the end of the registrant’s fiscal year ended December 31, 2020.




VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC.
Annual Report on Form 10-K
December 31, 2020
  
  
  
  
 
Signatures
S-1

1



PART I
ITEM 1.  BUSINESS
Our Company
Except where the context otherwise requires or where otherwise indicated, references in this Annual Report on Form 10-K to “we,” “us,” “our,” “our company,” the “Company” or “Veritex” refer to Veritex Holdings, Inc. and its subsidiaries, including Veritex Community Bank. The word “Holdco” refers to Veritex Holdings, Inc. The word “the Bank” refers to Veritex Community Bank.
Veritex is a Texas state banking organization, with corporate offices in Dallas, Texas. The Bank provides a full range of banking services, including commercial and retail lending and checking and savings deposit products, to individual and corporate customers. The Texas Department of Banking (the "TDB") and the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (the "Federal Reserve") are the primary regulators of the Company and the Bank, and both regulatory agencies perform periodic examinations to ensure regulatory compliance. Our current primary market includes the broader Dallas-Fort Worth metroplex and the Houston metropolitan area. As we continue to grow, we may expand to other metropolitan banking markets in Texas.

Our business is conducted through one reportable segment, community banking, which generates the majority of our revenues from interest income on loans, customer service and loan fees, gains on sale of government guaranteed loans and mortgage loans and interest income from securities. We incur interest expense on deposits and other borrowed funds, as well as noninterest expense, such as salaries and employee benefits and occupancy expenses. We analyze our ability to maximize income generated from interest-earning assets and interest expense of our interest-bearing liabilities through our net interest margin. Net interest margin is a ratio calculated as net interest income divided by average interest-earning assets. Net interest income is the difference between interest income on interest-earning assets, such as loans and securities, and interest expense on interest-bearing liabilities, such as deposits and borrowings, which are used to fund those assets.
Changes in the market interest rates and interest rates we earn on interest-earning assets and pay on interest-bearing liabilities, as well as the volume and types of interest-earning assets, and interest-bearing and noninterest-bearing liabilities, are usually the largest drivers of periodic changes in net interest spread, net interest margin and net interest income. Fluctuations in market interest rates are driven by many factors, including governmental monetary policies, inflation, deflation, macroeconomic developments, changes in unemployment, the money supply, political and international conditions and conditions in domestic and foreign financial markets. Periodic changes in the volume and types of loans in our loan portfolio are affected by, among other factors, economic and competitive conditions in Texas and, specifically, in the Dallas-Fort Worth metroplex and Houston metropolitan area, as well as developments affecting the real estate, technology, financial services, insurance, transportation, manufacturing and energy sectors within our target market and throughout the state of Texas.
Our primary customers are small and medium-sized businesses, generally with annual revenues of under $30 million, and professionals. We believe that these businesses and professionals highly value the local decision-making and relationship-driven, quality service we provide and our deep, long-term understanding of Texas community banking. As a result of consolidation, we believe that few locally-based publicly traded banks are dedicated to providing this level of service to small and medium-sized businesses and professionals. Our management team’s long-standing presence and experience in Texas gives us unique insight into local market opportunities and the needs of our customers. This enables us to respond quickly to customers, provide high quality personal service and develop comprehensive, long-term banking relationships by providing products and services tailored to meet the individual needs of our customers. This focus and approach enhances our ability to continue to grow organically, successfully recruit and retain talented bankers and strategically source potential acquisitions in our target markets.





2



Our History and Growth
Since commencing banking operations in 2010, we have experienced significant growth through our strategy of pursuing organic growth and strategic acquisitions. Since inception, we have completed seven whole-bank acquisitions that increased our market presence within the Dallas-Fort Worth metroplex, including an acquisition that resulted in us entering the Houston metropolitan market in 2017. We completed an initial public offering of our common stock in October 2014 and are one of the ten largest banks headquartered in Texas.

Our management team is led by our Chairman of the Board of Directors, Chief Executive Officer and President, C. Malcolm Holland, III, who has overseen and managed our organic growth and acquisition activity since we commenced banking operations.
The following table summarizes our seven completed acquisitions since inception through December 31, 2020:
 DateNumber of 
 CompletedBranchesLocations
Bank Acquired   
Professional Bank, N.A. through Professional Capital, Inc.September 2010Park Cities, Lakewood and Garland
Fidelity Bank through Fidelity Resources CompanyMarch 2011Preston Center, SMU and Plano
Bank of Las ColinasOctober 2011Las Colinas
Independent Bank of Texas through IBT Bancorp, Inc.July 2015Irving and Frisco
Sovereign Bank through Sovereign Bancshares, Inc.August 2017Dallas, Fort Worth, Houston and Austin
Liberty Bank through Liberty Bancshares, Inc.December 2017Fort Worth
Green Bank ("Green") through Green Bancorp, Inc.January 201921 Houston and Dallas

Our Strategy
Our business strategy consists of the following components:
Continued Organic Growth.  Our organic growth strategy focuses on penetrating our markets through our community-focused, relationship-driven approach to banking. We believe that our current market area provides abundant opportunities to continue to grow our customer base, increase loans and deposits and expand our overall market share. Our team of seasoned bankers is an important driver of our organic growth by virtue of its role in further developing banking relationships with current and potential customers. Many of these customer relationships span more than 20 years. Our market presidents and relationship managers are incentivized to increase the size of their loan and deposit portfolios and generate fee income while maintaining strong credit quality. We expect to have continued success adding to our team of experienced bankers in order to grow our market presence and scale. Also, preserving sound credit underwriting standards as we grow our loan portfolio will continue to be the foundation of our organic growth strategy.

Pursue Strategic Acquisitions.  We intend to continue to grow through acquisitions. We believe there are banking organizations in our market area that face significant scale and operational challenges, regulatory pressure, management succession issues and shareholder liquidity needs, which we believe will present attractive acquisition opportunities for us in the future. We believe we have developed an experienced and disciplined acquisition and integration approach capable of identifying candidates, conducting thorough due diligence, determining financial attractiveness and integrating the acquired institution. Utilizing our management team’s experience of acquiring financial institutions, we believe that we have built a corporate infrastructure capable of supporting additional acquisitions and continued organic growth. We believe our acquisition experience and our reputation as a successful acquirer position us to capitalize on potential additional opportunities in the future.
Improve Operational Efficiency and Increase Profitability.  We are committed to maintaining and enhancing profitability. We employ a systematic and calculated approach to improving our operational efficiency, which in turn, we believe, increases our profitability. We believe that our scalable infrastructure and efficient operating platform will allow us to achieve continued growth without incurring significant incremental noninterest expenses and will enhance our returns.
3



Strengthen Our Community Ties.  Our officers and employees are heavily involved in civic and community organizations, and we sponsor numerous activities that benefit our community. Our business development strategy, which focuses on building market share through personal relationships, as opposed to formal advertising, is consistent with our customer-centric culture and is a cost-effective approach to developing new relationships and enhancing existing ones.
Our Banking Services
We focus on delivering a wide variety of relationship-driven commercial banking products and services tailored to meet the needs of small to medium-sized businesses and professionals. A general discussion of the range of commercial banking products and other services we offer follows.
Lending Activities. As of December 31, 2020, total loans held for investment, including mortgage warehouse ("MW") and Paycheck Protection Program ("PPP") loans, totaled $6.7 billion, representing 76.9% of our total assets. Our loan portfolio primarily consists of commercial real estate and general commercial loans, MW loans, residential real estate loans, construction and land loans, farmland loans, consumer loans and PPP loans.
The U.S. Coronavirus Aid, Relief, and Economic Security Act (the "CARES Act") established and provided $349 billion in funding for the PPP, a loan program administered by the Small Business Administration ("SBA"). Under the PPP, small businesses, sole proprietorships, independent contractors and self-employed individuals may apply for forgivable loans from existing SBA lenders and other approved regulated lenders that enroll in the program, subject to numerous limitations and eligibility criteria. Congress appropriated an additional $310 billion for PPP commitments on April 24, 2020, and amended the PPP on June 5, 2020 to make the terms of the PPP loans and loan forgiveness more flexible. The Consolidated Appropriations Act, 2021, provided additional funding for the PPP of approximately $284 billion and allows eligible borrowers, including certain borrowers who already received a PPP loan, to apply for PPP loans through March 31, 2021. Beginning in early April 2020, we began processing loan applications under the PPP, and in January 2021, we began processing applications under this latest round of the PPP. Other banking regulatory agencies have encouraged lenders to extend additional loans, and the federal government is considering additional stimulus and support legislation focused on providing aid to various sectors, including small businesses. We are focused on taking care of our clients and communities who may be experiencing financial hardship due to the COVID-19 pandemic, including by participating in the PPP to provide direct assistance to small businesses in our communities.

Our underwriting philosophy seeks to balance our desire to make sound, high quality loans while recognizing that lending money involves a degree of business risk. Managing credit risk is a company-wide process. Our strategy for credit risk management includes well-defined, centralized credit policies, uniform underwriting criteria by loan type and ongoing risk monitoring and review processes for all types of credit exposures. Our processes emphasize early-stage review of loans, regular credit evaluations and management reviews of loans, which supplement the ongoing and proactive credit monitoring and loan servicing provided by our loan officers and lending support staff. Our Executive Loan Committee and Credit Risk Committee provide company-wide credit oversight and periodically review all credit risk portfolios to ensure that the risk identification processes are functioning properly and that our credit standards are followed. In addition, a third-party loan review is performed at least annually to identify problem assets and confirm our internal risk rating of loans. We attempt to identify potential problem loans early in an effort to aggressively seek resolution of these situations before the loans become a loss, record any necessary charge-offs promptly and maintain adequate allowance for credit loss ("ACL") levels for probable credit losses inherent in the loan portfolio.
Deposits. Deposits are our principal source of funds for our interest-earning assets. We believe that a critical component of our success is the importance we place on our deposit services. Our services include typical deposit functions of commercial banks, safe deposit facilities and commercial and personal banking services, in addition to our loan offerings. We offer a variety of deposit products and services consistent with the goal of attracting a wide variety of customers, including high net worth individuals and small to medium-sized businesses. We offer demand, savings, money market and time deposit accounts. We actively pursue business checking accounts by offering competitive rates, telephone banking, online banking and other convenient services to our customers. We also pursue commercial deposit and financial institution money market accounts that will benefit from the utilization of our treasury management services.
Other Products and Services. We offer banking products and services that are attractively priced and we believe easily understood by customers, with a focus on convenience and accessibility. We offer an interest rate swap program as well as a full suite of online banking solutions, including access to account balances, online transfers, online bill payment and electronic delivery of customer statements, as well as ATMs, and mobile banking, mail and personal appointment. We also offer debit cards, night depository, direct deposit, cashier’s checks and letters of credit.
4



We offer a full array of commercial treasury management services designed to be competitive with banks of all sizes. Treasury management services include balance reporting (including current day and previous day activity), transfers between accounts, wire transfer initiation, automated clearinghouse origination and stop payments. Cash management deposit products and services consist of lockbox, remote deposit capture, positive pay, reverse positive pay, account reconciliation services, zero balance accounts and sweep accounts, including loan sweep.
We remain focused on our organic loan growth and deposit repricing strategy to expand net interest margin. In addition, we are currently focused on limiting our interest rate exposure and expanding noninterest income though increased income from our derivative program. Our interest rate swap program has been developed as an accommodation to our customers who desire a fixed rate on loans over a certain size threshold with a defined repayment schedule. In such cases, we enter into a derivative contract with our borrower using a standard International Swaps and Derivative Association agreement and confirmation, while simultaneously entering into a “mirror” derivative contract with a correspondent bank counterparty. The two derivatives are carried at market value with changes in value offsetting. We uses interest rate swaps, floors, caps and collars to manage overall cash flow changes related to interest rate risk exposure on benchmark interest rate loans.
Investments
The primary objectives of our investment policy are to provide a source of liquidity, to provide an appropriate return on funds invested, to manage interest rate risk, to meet pledging requirements and to meet or exceed regulatory capital requirements.  As of December 31, 2020, the book value of our available for sale and held to maturity debt securities portfolio totaled $1.0 billion, with an average tax-equivalent yield of 2.96% and an estimated effective duration of approximately 4.1 years.
Our Market Area
We currently operate in the Dallas-Fort Worth metroplex and the Houston metropolitan area. The economy in these areas is fueled by the real estate, technology, financial services, insurance, transportation, manufacturing, health care and energy sectors. These market areas are among the most vibrant in the United States with rapidly growing populations, a high level of job growth, an affordable cost of living and a pro-growth business climate.
Competition
The Texas market for banking services is highly competitive. Texas’ largest banking organizations are headquartered outside of Texas and are controlled by organizations outside the state. We compete with numerous commercial banks, savings institutions, mortgage brokerage firms, credit unions, finance companies, mutual funds, insurance companies, and brokerage and investment banking firms operating locally and nationally, and more recently with financial technology companies that rely on technology to provide financial services. We believe that many small to medium-sized businesses and professionals are interested in banking with a company headquartered in, and with decision-making authority based in, Texas. We also believe these customers seek established Texas bankers who have the expertise to act as trusted advisors regarding their banking needs. We believe Veritex can offer customers more responsive and personalized service than many of our competitors can not. We also believe that, if we service these customers properly, we will be able to establish long-term relationships and provide multiple products to our customers, thereby enhancing our profitability. See “Risk Factors — Risks Related to Veritex’s Business — We face strong competition from financial services companies and other companies that offer banking services, which could adversely affect our business, financial condition, and results of operations.” in Item 1A of this report.
Employees and Human Capital Resources
As of December 31, 2020, we had 636 full-time employees and seven part-time employees. Our employees are not represented by a union. We strive to maintain a culture where employees are rewarded for hard work and share in the benefits of the success of our company.
5



We believe we are able to attract and retain top talent by creating a culture that challenges and engages our employees, offering them opportunities to learn, grow and achieve their career goals. Further, our commitment to a culture of inclusion is integral to our goal of attracting and retaining the best talent and ultimately driving our business performance. We also have an established corporate social responsibility strategy with a focus on five core areas: Be Better, Be Healthy, Be Mindful, Be Faithful and Be Prosperous. Our employees participate in a wide array of volunteer activities and we support their charitable giving by matching employee contributions to qualified nonprofit organizations.
We offer comprehensive compensation and benefits packages to our employees, including a 401(k) Plan, healthcare and insurance benefits, health savings and flexible spending accounts, paid time off and family assistance programs, including paid family leave, flexible work arrangements and adoption assistance plans, amongst others. We also offer stock-based compensation to certain management personnel as a way to attract and retain key talent. See Notes 20 and 21 in the consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this report for further discussion of our benefit plans and stock-based compensation.

In response to the COVID-19 pandemic, in March 2020, we pivoted to a remote working environment for substantially all of our employees with a commitment to the safety of our employees and the communities we serve. In the fourth quarter of 2020 we began re-opening some of our offices on a voluntary basis to accommodate employees seeking the flexibility to work from the office. We are carefully monitoring the conditions in those areas and continuing to adhere to health and safety protocols.

Our Corporate Information
Our principal executive offices are located at 8214 Westchester Drive, Suite 800, Dallas, Texas 75225, and our telephone number is (972) 349-6200. Our website is www.veritexbank.com. We make available at this address, free of charge, our annual report on Form 10-K, our annual reports to shareholders, quarterly reports on Form 10-Q, current reports on Form 8-K and amendments to those reports filed or furnished pursuant to Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 (the “Exchange Act”) as soon as reasonably practicable after such material is electronically filed with, or furnished to, the SEC. These documents are also available on the website of the Securities and Exchange Commission (the "SEC") at www.sec.gov. The information contained on or accessible from our website does not constitute a part of this Annual Report on Form 10-K and is not incorporated by reference herein.
Regulation and Supervision
The U.S. banking industry is highly regulated under federal and state law. These laws and regulations affect the operations and performance of Veritex and our subsidiaries and are intended primarily for the protection of the Deposit Insurance Fund of the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (the “FDIC”), the bank’s depositors and the public, rather than our shareholders or creditors.
Statutes, regulations and policies limit the activities in which we may engage and how we conduct certain permitted activities. Further, the bank regulatory agencies impose reporting and information collection obligations on us. We incur significant costs relating to compliance with these laws and regulations. Banking statutes, regulations and policies are continually under review by federal and state legislatures and regulatory agencies, and a change in them, including changes in how they are interpreted or implemented, could have a material adverse effect on our business. We cannot predict whether or in what form any statute, regulation or policy will be proposed or adopted or the extent to which our business may be affected by any new statute, regulation or policy.

The material statutory and regulatory requirements that are applicable to us and our subsidiaries are summarized below. The description below is not intended to summarize all laws and regulations applicable to us and our subsidiaries, and is based upon the statutes, regulations, policies, interpretive letters and other written guidance that are in effect as of the date of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
Bank and Bank Holding Company Regulation
The Bank is a Texas-chartered banking association, the deposits of which are insured by the DIF of the FDIC up to applicable legal limits. The Bank is a member of the Federal Reserve System; therefore, the Bank is subject to ongoing and comprehensive supervision, regulation, examination and enforcement by the TDB and the Federal Reserve.
6



A company that acquires ownership or control of 25% or more of any class of voting securities of a bank or bank holding company, that controls the election of a majority of the board of directors of such an institution, or that exercises a controlling influence over the affairs of such an institution, is a bank holding company and must obtain the prior approval of and later register with the Federal Reserve under the Bank Holding Company Act of 1956, as amended (the “BHC Act”).
Bank holding companies are subject to regulation, examination, supervision and enforcement by the Federal Reserve under the BHC Act. The Federal Reserve’s jurisdiction also extends to any company that is directly or indirectly controlled by a bank holding company. Similarly, bank holding companies of Texas state-chartered banks are subject to regulation, examination, supervision and enforcement by the TDB.

As a bank holding company, we are subject to ongoing and comprehensive supervision, regulation, examination and enforcement by the Federal Reserve. As a bank holding company of a Texas state-chartered bank, we are also subject to supervision, regulation, examination and enforcement by the TDB.

Broad Supervision, Examination and Enforcement Powers
A principal objective of the U.S. bank regulatory system is to protect depositors by ensuring the financial safety and soundness of banking organizations. To that end, the banking regulators have broad regulatory, examination and enforcement authority. The regulators regularly examine the operations of banking organizations. In addition, banking organizations are subject to periodic reporting requirements. Insured depository institutions with total assets of $500 million or more, such as the Bank, must submit annual audit reports prepared by independent auditors to federal and state regulators. In some instances, the audit report of the insured depository institution’s bank holding company can be used to satisfy this requirement. Under regulatory guidance, auditors are expected to receive examination reports, supervisory agreements and reports of enforcement actions.
The regulators have various remedies available if they determine that the financial condition, capital resources, asset quality, earnings prospects, management, liquidity or other aspects of a banking organization’s operations are unsatisfactory. The regulators may also take action if they determine that the banking organization or its management is violating or has violated any law or regulation. The regulators have the power to, among other things:
require affirmative actions to correct any violation or practice;
issue administrative orders that can be judicially enforced;
direct increases in capital;
direct the sale of subsidiaries or other assets;
limit dividends and distributions;
restrict growth;
assess civil monetary penalties;
remove officers and directors; and
terminate deposit insurance
Engaging in unsafe or unsound practices or failing to comply with applicable laws, regulations and supervisory agreements could subject the Company and their officers, directors and institution-affiliated parties to the remedies described above and other sanctions. See “Item 1A. Risk Factors—Risks Related to Veritex’s Industry and Regulation.”
The Dodd-Frank Act and the Economic Growth, Regulatory Reform, and Consumer Protection Act (“EGRRCPA”)
On July 21, 2010, the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act (the “Dodd-Frank Act”) was signed into law. The Dodd-Frank Act imposed significant regulatory and compliance requirements, including the designation of certain financial companies as systemically important financial companies, enhanced oversight of credit rating agencies, the imposition of increased capital, leverage and liquidity requirements, and numerous other provisions designed to improve supervision and oversight of, and strengthen safety and soundness within, the financial services sector.
7



Various provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act may affect our business and include, but may not be limited to the following:
Source of strength.  Under Federal Reserve policy, bank holding companies have historically been required to act as a source of financial and managerial strength to each of their banking subsidiaries, and the Dodd-Frank Act codified this policy as a statutory requirement. As a result of this requirement, in the future we could be required to provide financial assistance to the Bank should it experience financial distress and in circumstances in which we might not otherwise be inclined or in a financial position to do so.

Mortgage loan origination. The Dodd-Frank Act created the Consumer Financial Protection Bureau (the “CFPB”) and authorized the CFPB to establish certain minimum standards for the origination of residential mortgages, including a determination of the borrower’s ability to repay a residential mortgage loan. Under the Dodd-Frank Act, financial institutions may not make a residential mortgage loan unless it makes a “reasonable and good faith determination” that the consumer has a “reasonable ability” to repay the loan. The Dodd-Frank Act allows borrowers to raise certain defenses to foreclosure but provides a full or partial safe harbor from such defenses for loans that are “qualified mortgages.” The CFPB has promulgated and amended final rules to, among other things, specify the types of income and assets that may be considered in the ability to repay determination, the permissible sources for verification and the required methods of calculating the loan’s monthly payments. The rules extend the requirement that creditors verify and document a borrower’s income and assets to include all information that creditors rely on in determining repayment ability. The rules also provide further examples of third party documents that may be relied on for such verification, such as government records and check cashing or funds transfer service receipts. As revised in December 2020, the rules set conditions for “qualified mortgages,” including price-based limits and limits on other terms of the loans. Points and fees are subject to a relatively stringent cap, and are defined to include a wide array of payments that may be made in the course of closing a loan. Certain loans, including interest only loans and negative amortization loans, cannot be qualified mortgages. EGRRCPA modified certain of these requirements by, among other things, creating a safe harbor from the ability-to-repay standards for certain mortgage loans made by a bank with less than $10 billion in total consolidated assets.

Risk retention. The Federal Reserve, together with the FDIC, the SEC, the Federal Housing Finance Agency and the Department of Housing and Urban Development, issued a final rule in 2014 to implement the risk retention requirement mandated by Section 941 of the Dodd-Frank Act. The risk retention requirement generally requires a securitizer to retain no less than 5% of the credit risk in assets it sells into a securitization and prohibits a securitizer from directly or indirectly hedging or otherwise transferring the credit risk that the securitizer is required to retain, subject to limited exemptions. One significant exemption is for securities entirely collateralized by “qualified residential mortgages” (“QRMs”), which are loans deemed to have a lower risk of default. The rule defines QRMs to have the same meaning as the term “qualified mortgage,” as defined by the CFPB. In addition, the rule provides for reduced risk retention requirements for qualifying securitizations of commercial loans, commercial real estate loans and auto loans.

Imposition of restrictions on swaps activities. The Dodd-Frank Act imposes a new regulatory structure on the over-the-counter derivatives market, including requirements for clearing, exchange trading, capital, margin, reporting and record keeping. This framework covers any person required to register as a “major swap participant,” “swap dealer,” “major security-based swap participant” or a “security-based swap dealer.” We are treated as an end user and are not subject directly to many of these requirements, but the requirements may affect the nature of the business we conduct with persons required to register.

Consumer Financial Protection Bureau. The Dodd-Frank Act created the CFPB, which is tasked with establishing and implementing rules and regulations under certain federal consumer protection laws with respect to the conduct of providers of certain consumer financial products and services. The CFPB has rulemaking authority over many of the statutes governing products and services offered to bank and thrift consumers. For banking organizations with assets of $10 billion or more, the CFPB has exclusive rule-making, examination, and primary enforcement authority under federal consumer financial laws.  In addition, the Dodd-Frank Act permits states to adopt certain types of consumer protection laws and regulations that are stricter than those regulations promulgated by the CFPB. Compliance with any such new regulations would increase our cost of operations. The rulemaking, examination and enforcement priorities of the CFPB may change under the Biden administration, but we are unable to predict what effect, if any, these changes may have on the Bank.

Deposit insurance. The Dodd-Frank Act made permanent the general $250,000 deposit insurance limit for insured deposits. Amendments to the Federal Deposit Insurance Act (the “FDIA”) also revised the assessment base against
8



which an insured depository institution’s deposit insurance premiums paid to the FDIC’s Deposit Insurance Fund will be calculated. Under the amendments, the assessment base is no longer the institution’s deposit base, but rather its average consolidated total assets less its average tangible equity. Additionally, the Dodd-Frank Act made changes to the minimum designated reserve ratio of the Deposit Insurance Fund, increasing the minimum from 1.15% to 1.35% of the estimated amount of total insured deposits, and eliminating the requirement that the FDIC pay dividends to depository institutions when the reserve ratio exceeds certain thresholds. For a discussion of the assessments the Bank pays to the FDIC, see “Deposit Insurance and Deposit Insurance Assessments” below.

Transactions with affiliates and insiders. The Dodd-Frank Act generally enhanced the restrictions on transactions with affiliates under Section 23A and 23B of the Federal Reserve Act, including an expansion of the definition of “covered transactions” and clarification regarding the amount of time for which collateral requirements regarding covered credit transactions must be satisfied. Insider transaction limitations were expanded through the strengthening of loan restrictions to insiders and the expansion of the types of transactions subject to the various limits, including derivatives transactions, repurchase agreements, reverse repurchase agreements and securities lending or borrowing transactions. For a discussion of the restrictions on transactions with affiliates and insiders applicable to the Bank, see “Limits on Transactions with Affiliates and Insiders” below

Corporate governance. The Dodd-Frank Act addressed many investor protections, corporate governance and executive compensation matters that affect most U.S. publicly traded companies, including Veritex. The Dodd-Frank Act: (i) granted shareholders of U.S. publicly traded companies an advisory vote on executive compensation, (ii) enhanced independence requirements for compensation committee members, (iii) required companies listed on national securities exchanges to adopt incentive-based compensation clawback policies for executive officers and (iv) provided the SEC with authority to adopt proxy access rules that would allow shareholders of publicly traded companies to nominate candidates for election as a director and have those nominees included in a company’s proxy materials. For so long as we were an emerging growth company, we took advantage of the provisions of the JOBS Act that allowed us to not seek a non-binding advisory vote on executive compensation or golden parachute arrangements.

In May 2018, EGRRCPA was signed into law. While EGRRCPA preserved the fundamental elements of the post Dodd-Frank regulatory framework, it included modifications that were intended to result in meaningful regulatory relief both from certain Dodd-Frank provisions and from certain regulatory capital rules for smaller and certain regional banking organizations. Among other things, EGRRCPA exempted banks with total consolidated assets of $10 billion or less, including us, from the Volcker Rule, allowed us to avoid risk-based capital rules if we maintain a specific “community bank leverage ratio,” revised the capital treatment of certain commercial real estate loans, and amended certain Truth in Lending Act requirements for residential mortgage loans.
The Volcker Rule
Section 619 of the Dodd-Frank Act, popularly known as the “Volcker Rule,” generally prohibits “banking entities” from engaging in “proprietary trading” and making investments and conducting certain other activities with private equity funds and hedge funds. These prohibitions apply to banking entities of any size, including us and the Bank. In 2013, the Federal Reserve, together with the FDIC, the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency (the “OCC”), the SEC and the Commodity Futures Trading Commission, issued regulations to implement the Volcker Rule. As implemented by the federal banking agencies, EGRRCPA exempted banking entities with total consolidated assets of $10 billion or less, and total trading assets and liabilities of less than 5% of total consolidated assets, from the Volcker Rule. Although we do not believe we engaged in any activities covered by the Volcker Rule, the exemption eliminates any need for a Volcker Rule compliance program for so long as we remain covered by the exemption. We have reviewed the scope of the Volcker Rule and have determined that we do not have any activities or investments at this time that would be subject to the requirements of the rule.
9



Notice and Approval Requirements Related to Control
Federal and state banking laws impose notice, application, approval or non-objection and ongoing regulatory requirements on any shareholder or other person that controls or seeks to acquire direct or indirect “control” of an FDIC-insured depository institution. In addition to requirements that may apply under the BHC Act, described above under “Bank and Bank Holding Company Regulation,” the Change in Bank Control Act and the Texas Banking Act require regulatory filings by a shareholder or other person that seeks to acquire direct or indirect “control” of an FDIC-insured, Texas-chartered depository institution. The determination of whether a person “controls” a depository institution or its holding company is based on all of the facts and circumstances surrounding the investment. As a general matter, a person is deemed to control a depository institution or other company if the person owns or controls 25% or more of any class of voting stock. Subject to rebuttal, a person is presumed to control a depository institution or other company if the person owns or controls 10% or more of any class of voting stock and other regulatory criteria are met. The holdings of certain affiliated persons, or persons acting in concert, are typically aggregated for the purpose of applying the 10% and 25% thresholds.
In addition, except under limited circumstances, bank holding companies are prohibited from acquiring, without prior approval of the Federal Reserve, control of any other bank or bank holding company or all or substantially all the assets thereof, or more than 5% of the voting shares of a bank or bank holding company that is not already a subsidiary.
Permissible Activities and Investments
Banking laws generally restrict our ability to engage in, or acquire 5% or more of the voting shares of a company engaged in, activities other than those determined by the Federal Reserve to be so closely related to banking as to be a proper incident thereto. The Gramm-Leach-Bliley Financial Modernization Act of 1999 (the “GLB Act”) expanded the scope of permissible activities to include those that are financial in nature or incidental or complementary to a financial activity for a bank holding company that elects to be a financial holding company, which requires the satisfaction of certain conditions. We have not elected financial holding company status.
In addition, as a general matter, we must receive prior regulatory approval before establishing or acquiring a depository institution or, in certain cases, a non-bank entity.
The Texas Constitution, as amended in 1986, provides that a Texas-chartered bank has the same rights and privileges that are or may be granted to national banks domiciled in Texas. To the extent that the Texas laws and regulations may have allowed state-chartered banks to engage in a broader range of activities than national banks, the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation Improvement Act of 1991 (“FDICIA”) has operated to limit such activities. FDICIA provides that no state bank or subsidiary thereof may engage as a principal in any activity in which national banks are not permitted to engage, unless the institution complies with applicable capital requirements and the FDIC determines that the activity poses no significant risk to the DIF of the FDIC. In general, statutory restrictions on the activities of banks are aimed at protecting the safety and soundness of depository institutions.
Branching
Texas law provides that a Texas-chartered bank can establish a branch anywhere in Texas provided that the branch is approved in advance by the TDB. The branch must also be approved by the Federal Reserve.  The regulators consider a number of factors, including financial history, capital adequacy, earnings prospects, character of management, needs of the community, record of Community Reinvestment Act ("CRA") performance and consistency with corporate powers. The Dodd-Frank Act permits insured state banks that satisfy certain conditions to engage in de novo interstate branching if the laws of the state where the new branch is to be established would permit the establishment of the branch if it were chartered by such state.
Regulatory Capital Requirements and Capital Adequacy
The bank regulators view capital levels as important indicators of an institution’s financial soundness. As a general matter, FDIC-insured depository institutions and their holding companies are required to maintain minimum capital relative to the amount and types of assets they hold. The final supervisory determination on an institution’s capital adequacy is based on the regulator’s assessment of numerous factors.  As a bank holding company and a state-chartered member bank, we and the Bank are subject to several regulatory capital requirements.
The federal banking agencies' current generally applicable capital requirements for bank holding companies and banks took effect on January 1, 2015, with phase-in periods for certain requirements; as of January 1, 2019, all of the requirements were fully phased in. The requirements are based on a set of international standards popularly known as Basel III.
10



Under the EGRRCPA and implementing regulations of the federal banking agencies, certain banking organizations with less than $10 billion in assets may elect to satisfy a single Community Bank Leverage Ratio (“CBLR”) of Tier 1 capital to average total consolidated assets in lieu of the generally applicable capital requirements of the capital rules implementing Basel III. We have elected to use the CBLR framework. Accordingly, if we and the Bank continue to meet all requirements under this framework, we and the Bank will not be required to report or calculate risk-based capital, and the Bank will be considered to have met the well-capitalized ratio requirements under Prompt Corrective Action (“PCA”) regulations. The federal banking agencies have finalized the CBLR minimum at 9% and we and the Bank exceed this standard. The CARES Act, enacted March 27, 2020, temporarily reduced the CBLR to 8% until the earlier of December 31, 2020 or the expiration of the national emergency declaration, and rules issued by the federal banking agencies provide a graduated transition back to the 9% threshold by January 1, 2022.

If we were not eligible for or did not opt into the CBLR framework, under the generally applicable capital requirements, we and the Bank would be required to maintain common equity Tier 1 capital of at least 4.5% of risk-weighted assets, Tier 1 capital of at least 6% of risk-weighted assets, total capital (a combination of Tier 1 and Tier 2 capital) of at least 8% of risk-weighted assets, and a leverage ratio of Tier 1 capital to average total consolidated assets of at least 4%. In addition, generally applicable capital requirements subject banking organizations not opting into the CBLR to limitations on capital distributions and discretionary bonus payments to executive officers if the organization does not maintain a “capital conservation buffer” of common equity Tier 1 capital in an amount greater than 2.5% of its total risk-weighted assets in excess of the minimum risk-based capital ratio requirements. The effect of the fully phased-in capital conservation buffer is to increase the minimum common equity Tier 1 capital ratio to 7.0%, the minimum tier 1 risk-based capital ratio to 8.5% and the minimum total risk-based capital ratio to 10.5%, for banking organizations seeking to avoid the limitations on capital distributions and discretionary bonus payments to executive officers. The capital regulations also determine the thresholds necessary for a bank to be deemed well or adequately capitalized; these adjustments are discussed below under “Prompt Corrective Action.”

For purposes of the CBLR or the generally applicable capital requirements, the components of common equity Tier 1 capital include common stock instruments (including related surplus), retained earnings, and certain minority interests in the equity accounts of fully consolidated subsidiaries (subject to certain limitations). A bank must make certain deductions from and adjustments to the sum of these components to determine common equity Tier 1 capital. Additional Tier 1 capital includes noncumulative perpetual preferred stock and related surplus, and certain minority interests in the equity accounts of fully consolidated subsidiaries not included in common equity Tier 1 capital, subject to certain limitations. As a bank holding company with less than $15 billion in total assets, we may include certain existing trust preferred securities and cumulative perpetual preferred stock in regulatory capital while other instruments are disallowed. Tier 2 capital includes subordinated debt with a minimum original maturity of five years, related surplus, certain minority interests in in the equity accounts of fully consolidated subsidiaries not included in Tier 1 capital (subject to certain limitations), and limited amounts of a bank’s ACL. Certain deductions and adjustments are necessary for both additional Tier 1 capital and Tier 2 capital.

In the first quarter of 2020, U.S. federal regulatory authorities issued an interim final rule that provides banking organizations that adopt CECL during the 2020 calendar year with the option to delay for two years the estimated impact of CECL on regulatory capital relative to regulatory capital determined under the prior incurred loss methodology, followed by a three-year transition period to phase out the aggregate amount of the capital benefit provided during the initial two-year delay (i.e., a five-year transition in total). In connection with our adoption of CECL on January 1, 2020, the Company elected to utilize the five-year CECL transition. As a result, the effects of CECL on the Company's and the Bank’s regulatory capital will be delayed through the year 2021, after which the effects will be phased-in over a three-year period from January 1, 2022 through December 31, 2024.

At December 31, 2020, if we and the Bank had not been eligible for or elected to be subject to the CBLR, we and the Bank would have been in compliance with the generally applicable minimum common equity Tier 1 capital, Tier 1 capital, total capital, and leverage capital requirements, and would have exceeded the capital conservation buffer. See Note 24 – Capital Requirements and Restrictions on Retained Earnings in the accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this report for more details.
For us to be “well capitalized,” the Bank must be well capitalized and Veritex must not be subject to any written agreement, order, capital directive or prompt corrective action directive issued by the Federal Reserve to meet and maintain a specific capital level for any capital measure. As of December 31, 2020, we met all the requirements to be deemed well-capitalized.
11



The capital requirements described above are minimum ratios generally applicable to banking organizations. The Federal Reserve (and the other federal bank regulatory agencies) may set capital requirements for a particular banking organization that are higher than the minimum ratios when circumstances warrant. Federal Reserve guidelines also provide that banking organizations experiencing internal growth or making acquisitions will be expected to maintain strong capital positions substantially above the minimum supervisory levels, without significant reliance on intangible assets.
Prompt Corrective Action
In addition to the capital rules described above, the Bank is subject to the PCA regime. The PCA regime subjects an insured depository institution to increasingly stringent restrictions and supervisory actions by its primary federal regulator, if the institution becomes undercapitalized and its financial condition continues to deteriorate. Each U.S. insured depository institution falls within one of five assigned capital categories: “well capitalized,” “adequately capitalized,” “undercapitalized,” “significantly undercapitalized” and “critically undercapitalized.” An insured depository institution is deemed to be “well capitalized” if it has a total risk-based capital ratio of 10.0% or greater, a common equity Tier 1 capital ratio of 6.5% or greater, a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of 8.0% or greater and a leverage ratio of 5.0% or greater and the institution is not subject to an order, written agreement, capital directive or prompt corrective action directive to meet and maintain a specific level for any capital measure. However, if an institution subject to the CBLR framework, such as the Bank, satisfies the CBLR minimum requirement, it will be considered to have met the well-capitalized ratio requirements for purposes of the PCA regime. A well-capitalized institution is not subject to any restrictions on its activities and enjoys certain regulatory advantages such as streamlined processing of many applications. A depository institution is deemed to be “adequately capitalized” if it has a total risk-based capital ratio of 8.0% or greater, a common equity Tier 1 capital ratio of 4.5% or greater, a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of 6.0% or greater and a leverage ratio of 4.0% or greater and does not meet the criteria for a “well capitalized” bank. Adequately-capitalized status is necessary in order to undertake a variety of regulated activities. An institution that is adequately capitalized but not well capitalized may be restricted in its ability to rely on brokered deposits, which is discussed further below under “Brokered Deposits.”

A depository institution is “under capitalized” if it has a total risk-based capital ratio of less than 8.0%, a common equity Tier 1 capital ratio of less than 4.5%, a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of less than 6.0% or a leverage ratio of less than 4.0%. A depository institution is “significantly undercapitalized” if it has a total risk-based capital ratio of less than 6.0%, a common equity Tier 1 capital ratio of less than 3.0%, a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of less than 4.0% or a leverage ratio of less than 3.0%. An institution is critically undercapitalized if its ratio of tangible equity to total assets is equal to or less than 2.0%. Significantly undercapitalized institutions are subject to a wider array of adverse agency actions than undercapitalized institutions. A critically undercapitalized institution is likely to be place in receivership if it does not find a merger partner. Under certain circumstances, an institution may be treated as if the institution were in the next lower capital category.
A banking institution that is undercapitalized is required to submit a capital restoration plan. The capital restoration plan will not be accepted by the regulators unless each company having control of the undercapitalized institution provides a performance guarantee of the subsidiary’s compliance with the capital restoration plan up to the lesser of 5% of the bank’s total assets or the amount necessary to bring the bank into compliance with capital requirements as of the time it fell out of compliance.
Failure to meet capital guidelines could subject an institution to a variety of enforcement remedies by federal bank regulatory agencies, including termination of deposit insurance upon notice and hearing, restrictions on certain business activities, and appointment of the FDIC as conservator or receiver. As of December 31, 2020, the Bank met all requirements under the CBLR framework and the requirements to be “well capitalized” under the PCA regulations.

Regulatory Limits on Dividends and Distributions
As a bank holding company, we are subject to certain restrictions on paying dividends under applicable federal and Texas laws, regulations and guidance. The Federal Reserve has issued a policy statement that provides that a bank holding company should not pay dividends unless (i) its net income over the last four quarters (net of dividends paid) has been sufficient to fully fund the dividends, (ii) the prospective rate of earnings retention appears to be consistent with the capital needs, asset quality and overall financial condition of the bank holding company and its subsidiaries and (iii) the bank holding company will continue to meet minimum required capital adequacy ratios. Accordingly, a bank holding company should not pay cash dividends that exceed its net income or that can only be funded in ways that weaken the bank holding company’s financial health, such as by borrowing.
Substantially all of our income, and a principal source of our liquidity, are dividends from the Bank. Bank dividend activity is governed by federal and state laws, regulations and policies.
12



Applicable requirements serve to limit the amount of dividends that may be paid by the Bank. The Bank may not declare or pay a dividend if (i) the total of all dividends declared during the calendar year, including the proposed dividend, exceeds the sum of the Bank’s net income during the current calendar year and the retained net income of the prior two calendar years, unless the dividend has been approved by the Federal Reserve, (ii) the dividend would exceed the Bank’s undivided profits, unless the Bank has received the prior approval of the Board and of at least two-thirds of the shareholders of each class of stock outstanding, or (iii) the dividend would cause any portion of the Bank’s permanent capital to be withdrawn unless the withdrawal has been approved by the Federal Reserve and by at least two-thirds of the shareholders of each class of stock outstanding. Under the FDIA, an insured depository institution such as the Bank is prohibited from making capital distributions, including the payment of dividends, if, after making such distribution, the institution would become “undercapitalized.” The Federal Reserve may further restrict the payment of dividends by requiring the Bank to maintain a higher level of capital than would otherwise be required to be adequately capitalized for regulatory purposes. In addition, the Bank may not reduce or increase its outstanding capital and surplus through dividend, redemption, share issuance, or otherwise, without the prior approval of the TDB, except as permitted by the Texas Finance Code. Payment of dividends by the Bank also may be restricted at any time at the discretion of the appropriate regulator if it deems the payment to constitute an unsafe and unsound banking practice. As noted above, if we no longer operate under the CBLR framework, failure to satisfy the capital conservation buffer may also have the effect of limiting the payment of capital distributions from the Bank.

On January 26, 2021, Veritex Holdings, Inc. announced that its Board of Directors declared a quarterly cash dividend of $0.17 per share on our outstanding common stock. The dividend was paid on February 18, 2021 to shareholders of record as of February 4, 2021. This dividend reflects the strength of our performance over the last fiscal year as well as organic capital generation.

Reserve Requirements
Pursuant to regulations of the Federal Reserve, all banking organizations are required to maintain average daily reserves at mandated ratios against their transaction accounts. In addition, reserves must be maintained on certain non-personal time deposits. These reserves must be maintained in the form of vault cash or in an account at a Federal Reserve Bank. In response to the COVID-19 pandemic, the Federal Reserve reduced reserve requirement ratios to 0% effective March 26, 2020. Increases to the reserve requirement would decrease the amount of the Bank’s assets that it may make available for lending and investment activities.

Limits on Transactions with Affiliates and Insiders
Sections 23A and 23B of the Federal Reserve Act, as implemented by the Federal Reserve’s Regulation W, subjects insured depository institutions to restrictions on their ability to conduct transactions with affiliates, including their parent bank holding companies and other related parties. Section 23A of the Federal Reserve Act imposes quantitative limits, qualitative requirements, and collateral standards on certain transactions by an insured depository institution with, or for the benefit of, its affiliates, including by requiring that covered transactions between the insured depository institution and any one affiliate are limited to 10% of the insured depository institution’s capital and surplus, and that the aggregate of all covered transactions with all affiliates are limited to 20% of the insured depository institution’s capital and surplus. Transactions covered by Section 23A include loans, extensions of credit, investment in securities issued by an affiliate, and acquisitions of assets from an affiliate. Section 23B of the Federal Reserve Act requires that most types of transactions by an insured depository institution with, or for the benefit of, an affiliate be on terms substantially the same or at least as favorable to the insured depository institution as if the transaction were conducted with an unaffiliated third party.

As noted above, the Dodd-Frank Act generally enhanced the restrictions on transactions with affiliates under Section 23A and 23B of the Federal Reserve Act, including by expanding the definition of “covered transactions” and clarifying the amount of time for which collateral requirements regarding covered credit transactions must be satisfied. The ability of the Federal Reserve to grant exemptions from these restrictions is also narrowed by the Dodd-Frank Act, including by requiring coordination with other bank regulators.

The Federal Reserve’s Regulation O imposes restrictions and procedural requirements in connection with the extension of credit by an insured depository institution to directors, executive officers, principal shareholders and their related interests. Section 18(z) of the FDIA limits purchases and sales of assets between an insured depository institution and its executive officers, directors, and principal shareholders.
13



Brokered Deposits
The FDIA restricts the use of brokered deposits by certain depository institutions. A well capitalized insured depository institution may solicit and accept, renew or roll over any brokered deposit without restriction. An adequately capitalized insured depository institution may not accept, renew or roll over any brokered deposit unless it has applied for and been granted a waiver of this prohibition by the FDIC. The FDIC may grant a waiver upon a finding that the acceptance of brokered deposits does not constitute an unsafe or unsound practice with respect to such institution. The rates that an adequately capitalized institution with a waiver may pay on brokered deposits may not exceed certain ceilings. An “undercapitalized insured depository institution” may not accept, renew or roll over any brokered deposit. As of December 31, 2020, the Bank is considered a well capitalized insured depository institution and had total brokered deposits of $199.8 million.
Concentrated Commercial Real Estate Lending Guidance
The federal banking agencies, including the Federal Reserve, have promulgated guidance governing financial institutions with concentrations in commercial real estate lending. The guidance provides that a bank has a concentration in commercial real estate lending if (i) total reported loans for construction, land development and other land represent 100% or more of total risk-based capital or (ii) total reported loans secured by multifamily and non-farm, non-residential properties and loans for construction, land development and other land represent 300% or more of total risk-based capital and the bank’s commercial real estate loan portfolio has increased 50% or more during the prior 36 months. Owner-occupied commercial real estate loans are excluded from this second category. If a concentration is present, management must employ heightened risk management practices that address the following key elements: board and management oversight and strategic planning, portfolio management, development of underwriting standards, risk assessment and monitoring through market analysis and stress testing, and maintenance of increased capital levels as needed to support the level of commercial real estate lending. At December 31, 2020, our total reported loans for construction, land development and other land represented over 100% of our total capital, indicating a concentration in commercial real estate lending. At December 31, 2020, our management believes that it has adequately addressed the requirements and guidance of federal banking agencies, including the Federal Reserve, for institutions with concentrations in commercial real estate lending.
Examination and Examination Fees
The Federal Reserve and TDB periodically examine our business, including our compliance with laws and regulations. These agencies may conduct joint examinations, and the TDB may accept the results of the Federal Reserve’s examination in lieu of conducting an independent examination. If, as a result of an examination, the Federal Reserve or the TDB were to determine that our financial condition, capital resources, asset quality, earnings prospects, management, liquidity or other aspects of any of our operations had become unsatisfactory, or that we were in violation of any law or regulation, they may take a number of different remedial actions as they deem appropriate. These actions may include requiring us to remediate any such adverse examination findings.

In addition, these agencies have the authority to take enforcement action against us to enjoin “unsafe or unsound” practices, to require affirmative action to correct any conditions resulting from any violation of law or regulation or unsafe or unsound practice, to issue an administrative order that can be judicially enforced, to direct an increase in our capital, to direct the sale of subsidiaries or other assets, to limit dividends and distributions, to restrict our growth, to assess civil money penalties against us or our officers or directors, to remove officers and directors and, if it is concluded that such conditions cannot be corrected or there is imminent risk of loss to depositors, to terminate our deposit insurance and place our Bank into receivership or conservatorship. Any regulatory enforcement action against us could have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

The TDB charges fees to recover the costs of examining Texas chartered banks, as well as filing fees for certain applications and other filings. The Dodd-Frank Act provides various agencies with the authority to assess additional supervision fees.

14



Deposit Insurance and Deposit Insurance Assessments
The Bank’s deposits are insured by the Deposit Insurance Fund (the “DIF”) to the maximum extent permitted by the FDIC. This amount is $250,000 per depositor per account. The Dodd-Frank Act increased the minimum reserve ratio requirement for the DIF to 1.35% of total estimated insured deposits or the comparable percentage of the deposit assessment base. As of June 30, 2020, the DIF reserve ratio fell to 1.30 percent, below the statutory minimum of 1.35 percent. The decline in the ratio was due to extraordinary insured deposit growth, which was resulted mainly from the COVID-19 pandemic, specifically monetary policy action, direct government assistance to the consumers and businesses, and an overall reduction in spending. The FDIC projects that the DIF reserve ratio would return to 1.35 percent without further action by the FDIC and continues to maintain the current schedule assessment rates.

Insured depository institutions fund the DIF through quarterly assessments, which are calculated by multiplying the Bank’s assessment base by the applicable assessment rate. A bank’s deposit insurance assessment base is generally equal to its total assets minus its average tangible equity during the assessment period. For a depository institution that has been insured for more than five years and that has total consolidated assets of less than $10 billion, such as the Bank, the FDIC determines the assessment rate within a range of base assessment rates based on the bank’s CAMELS composite rating, taking into account other factors and adjustments. The CAMELS rating system is a supervisory rating system developed to classify a bank’s overall condition by taking into account capital adequacy, assets, management capability, earnings, liquidity and sensitivity to market and interest rate risk.

Future changes in insurance premiums could have an adverse effect on operating expenses and results of operations and we cannot predict what insurance assessment rates will be in the future.

As insurer of the Bank’s deposits, the FDIC is authorized to conduct examinations of, and to require reporting by, the Bank, and has back-up enforcement authority of the Bank as well. The agency also may prohibit any insured institution from engaging in any activity determined by regulation or order to pose a serious threat to the DIF. The FDIC may terminate the deposit insurance of any insured depository institution, including the Bank, if it determines after a hearing that the institution has engaged or is engaging in unsafe or unsound practices, is in an unsafe or unsound condition to continue operations, or has violated any applicable law, regulation, order or any condition imposed by an agreement with the FDIC. It also may suspend deposit insurance temporarily during the hearing process for the permanent termination of insurance, if the institution has no tangible capital. Management is not aware of any existing circumstances that would result in termination of our deposit insurance.

Depositor Preference
The FDIA provides that, in the event of the “liquidation or other resolution” of an insured depository institution, the claims of depositors of the institution (including the claims of the FDIC as subrogee of insured depositors) and certain claims for administrative expenses of the FDIC as a receiver will have priority over other general unsecured claims against the institution. If we invest in or acquire an insured depository institution that fails, insured and uninsured depositors, along with the FDIC, will have priority in payment ahead of unsecured, non-deposit creditors, including Veritex, with respect to any extensions of credit they have made to such insured depository institution.
Anti-Money Laundering and OFAC    
The Bank Secrecy Act (“BSA”), the Uniting and Strengthening America by Providing Appropriate Tools Required to Intercept and Obstruct Terrorism Act of 2001, or the USA PATRIOT Act of 2001, and regulations and policies implementing these statutes require the Bank to maintain a risk-based Anti-Money Laundering (“AML”) program reasonably designed to prevent and detect money laundering and terrorist financing and to comply with the recordkeeping and reporting requirements of the BSA, including the requirement to report suspicious activities. The Federal Reserve expects that we will have an effective governance structure for the program which includes effective oversight by our Board of Directors and management. The program must include, at a minimum, a designated compliance officer, written policies, procedures and internal controls, training of appropriate personnel, and independent testing of the program and risk-based customer due diligence procedures. The U.S. Department of Treasury’s Financial Crimes Enforcement Network (“FinCEN”) and the federal banking agencies continue to issue regulations and guidance with respect to the application and requirements of the BSA and their expectations for effective AML programs.

15



In January 2021, the Anti-Money Laundering Act of 2020 (“AMLA”) was enacted. The AMLA includes extensive and fundamental reforms to BSA and other AML laws. Among other things, the AMLA is intended to 1) improve coordination and information sharing among the agencies administering AML, 2) modernize AML laws, 3) encourage technological innovation and the adoption of new technology by financial institutions, 4) reinforce that the AML shall be risk-based, 5) establish uniform beneficial ownership information reporting requirements, and 6) establish a secure, nonpublish database at FinCEN for beneficial ownership information.

Bank regulators routinely examine institutions for compliance with these obligations, and they must consider an institution’s compliance with such obligations in connection with the regulatory review of applications, including applications for banking mergers and acquisitions. Compliance with these requirements has been a special focus of the Federal Reserve and the other Federal banking agencies in recent years. Any non-compliance is likely to result in an enforcement action, often with substantial monetary penalties and reputational damage.

The U.S. Department of the Treasury’s Office of Foreign Assets Control (“OFAC”) is responsible for helping to ensure that U.S. entities do not engage in transactions with certain prohibited parties, as defined by various Executive Orders and Acts of Congress. OFAC publishes lists of persons, organizations, and countries suspected of aiding, harboring or engaging in terrorist acts, known as Specially Designated Nationals and Blocked Persons. OFAC administers and enforces applicable economic and trade sanctions programs. These sanctions are usually targeted against foreign countries, terrorists, international narcotics traffickers and those believed to be involved in the proliferation of weapons of mass destruction. These regulations generally require either the blocking of accounts or other property of specified entities or individuals, but they may also require the rejection of certain transactions involving specified entities or individuals.

Failure of a financial institution to maintain and implement adequate BSA/AML and OFAC programs, or to comply with all of the relevant laws or regulations, could have serious legal, reputational and financial consequences for the institution. The Company maintains policies, procedures and other internal controls designed to comply with AML requirements and sanctions programs.

Consumer Laws and Regulations
Banking organizations are subject to numerous federal laws intended to protect consumers. These laws include, among others:
Truth in Lending Act;
Truth in Savings Act;
Electronic Funds Transfer Act;
Expedited Funds Availability Act;
Equal Credit Opportunity Act;
Fair and Accurate Credit Transactions Act;
Fair Housing Act;
Fair Credit Reporting Act;
Fair Debt Collection Act;
The GLB Act;
Home Mortgage Disclosure Act;
Right to Financial Privacy Act;
Real Estate Settlement Procedures Act;
16



Section 5 of the Federal Trade Commission Act and section 1031 of the Dodd-Frank Act protecting against unfair, deceptive or abusive acts and practices; and
state usury laws.
Many states and local jurisdictions have consumer protection laws analogous to, and in addition to, those listed above. These federal, state and local laws regulate the manner in which financial institutions deal with customers when taking deposits, making loans, or conducting other types of transactions. Failure to comply with these laws and regulations could give rise to regulatory sanctions, customer rescission rights, action by state and local attorneys general and civil or criminal liability.
Privacy and Cybersecurity

Federal statutes and regulations require insured depository institutions to take certain actions to protect nonpublic consumer financial information. Consumer data privacy and data protection are also the subject of state laws. The Bank has prepared a privacy policy, which it must disclose to consumers annually. In some cases, the Bank must obtain a consumer's consent before sharing information with an unaffiliated third party, and the Bank must allow a consumer to opt out of the Bank’s sharing of information with its affiliates for marketing and certain other purposes. Additional conditions affect the Bank’s information exchanges with credit reporting agencies. The Bank’s privacy practices and the effectiveness of its systems to protect consumer privacy are among the subjects covered in periodic compliance examinations conducted by the TDB and the Federal Reserve.

The Federal banking agencies pay close attention to the cybersecurity practices of banks and their holding companies and affiliates. The interagency council of the agencies, the Federal Financial Institutions Examination Council (“FFIEC”), has issued a number of policy statements and other guidance for banks in light of the growing threat posed by cybersecurity threats. The FFIEC has recently focused on such matters as compromised customer credentials and business continuity planning. Examinations by the banking agencies now include review of an institution’s information technology and its ability to thwart cyber attacks. Additionally, on December 18, 2020, the federal banking agencies released a notice of proposed rulemaking that would require a banking organization to notify its primary federal regulator within 36 hours of a significant cybersecurity incident.

The Community Reinvestment Act
The CRA and related regulations are intended to encourage insured depository institutions to help meet the credit needs of its communities, including low- to moderate-income communities. The CRA does not impose specific lending requirements, and it does not contemplate that an insured depository institution would take any action inconsistent with safety and soundness.

The federal banking agencies evaluate the performance of each of their regulated institutions periodically to determine whether an institution’s performance is “Outstanding,” “Satisfactory,” “Needs to Improve” or “Substantial Noncompliance.” Each rating is made public, together with the public section of the underlying report. Ratings of “Outstanding” or “Satisfactory” may be a condition to qualify for certain regulatory benefits.

The CRA requires the federal bank regulators to take into account an insured depository institution’s record in meeting the convenience and needs of the communities that the institution serves when considering an application by the institution to establish or relocate a branch or to enter into certain mergers or acquisitions. Similarly, the Federal Reserve is required to consider the CRA performance records of a bank holding company’s subsidiary bank (or banks) when considering an application by the bank holding company to acquire a banking organization or to merge with another bank holding company, or to engage in other expansionary transactions. When we or the Bank apply for regulatory approval to engage in certain transactions, the regulators will consider the CRA performance of the Bank and of the target institutions. An evaluation of “Needs to Improve” or “Substantial Noncompliance” may block or impede regulatory approvals of our applications. The Bank received an overall CRA rating of “Satisfactory” on its most recent CRA examination as of August 2019.

17



Changes in Laws, Regulations or Policies
Federal, state and local legislators and regulators regularly introduce measures or take actions that would modify the regulatory requirements applicable to banks, their holding companies and other financial institutions. Changes in laws, regulations or regulatory policies could adversely affect the operating environment for us in substantial and unpredictable ways, increase our cost of doing business, impose new restrictions on the way in which we conduct our operations or add significant operational constraints that might impair our profitability. Whether new legislation will be enacted and, if enacted, the effect that it, or any implementing regulations, would have on our business, financial condition or results of operations cannot be predicted. The full effect that any such changes will have on us remains uncertain at this time and may have a material adverse effect on our business and results of operations.
Effect on Economic Environment
The policies of regulatory authorities, including the monetary policy of the Federal Reserve, have a significant effect on the operating results of bank holding companies and their subsidiaries. Among the means available to the Federal Reserve to affect the money supply are open market operations in U.S. government securities, changes in the discount rate on borrowings and changes in reserve requirements with respect to deposits. These means are used in varying combinations to influence overall growth and distribution of bank loans, investments and deposits, and their use may affect interest rates charged on loans or paid for deposits. Federal Reserve monetary policies have materially affected the operating results of commercial banks in the past and are expected to continue to do so in the future. We cannot predict the nature of future monetary policies and the effect of such policies on its business and earnings.
18



Risk Factor Summary

The risks and uncertainties facing our company include, but are not limited to, the following:

Risks Related to Veritex’s Business

Our business concentration in Texas, and specifically the Dallas-Fort Worth metroplex and the Houston metropolitan area, imposes risks and may magnify the consequences of any regional or local economic downturn affecting the Dallas-Fort Worth metroplex and the Houston metropolitan area, including any downturn in the real estate sector
COVID-19 and the impact of actions to mitigate it could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.
Uncertain market conditions, economic trends, interest rate shifts, and changes in accounting standards and interpretations could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.
A large portion of our loan portfolio consists of commercial loans, the deterioration in value of the security of which which could increase the potential for future losses.
Significant increases of nonperforming assets from the current level, or greater than anticipated costs to resolve these credits, will have an adverse effect on Veritex’s earnings.
The small to medium-sized businesses that we lend to may have fewer resources to weather adverse business developments, which may impair a borrower’s ability to repay a loan, and such impairment could adversely affect our results of operations and financial condition.
Our allowance for credit losses may prove to be insufficient to absorb potential losses in our loan portfolio, which could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.
Our strategy of pursuing acquisitions exposes us to financial, execution and operational risks that could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and growth prospects.
If we grow to over $10 billion in total consolidated assets, we will become subject to increased regulation.
Our ability to retain executive officers, bankers and other key employees and recruit additional successful team members is critical to the success of our business strategy.
The relatively unseasoned nature of a significant portion of our loan portfolio may expose us to increased credit risks.
Our commercial real estate and construction and land loan portfolios expose us to credit risks that could be greater than the risks related to other types of loans.
We may be subject to environmental liabilities in connection with the foreclosure on real estate assets securing our loan portfolio.
We are exposed to increased credit losses and credit related expenses in the event of a major natural disaster, public health crisis, other catastrophic event or significant climate change effects.
We have a concentration of loans outstanding to a limited number of borrowers, which may increase our risk of loss.
We may need to raise additional capital in the future, and if we fail to maintain sufficient capital, whether due to losses, an inability to raise additional capital or otherwise, our financial condition, liquidity and results of operations, as well as the ability to maintain regulatory compliance, could be adversely affected.
We face strong competition from financial services companies and other companies that offer banking services.
Negative public opinion regarding Veritex or our failure to maintain our reputation in the community could adversely affect our business and prevent us from continuing to grow our business.
We may not be able to report our financial results accurately and timely as a publicly listed company if we fail to maintain an effective system of disclosure controls and procedures and internal control over financial reporting.
We are subject to certain operational risks, including, but not limited to, customer or employee fraud, data processing system failures and errors, and threats to data security, such as unauthorized access and cyber-crime.
We have a continuing need for technological change and may not have the resources to effectively implement new technology, or may experience operational challenges when implementing new technology.
Our operations could be interrupted if third-party service providers experience difficulty, terminate their services or fail to comply with banking regulations.
Consumers may decide not to use banks to complete their financial transactions.
If our goodwill becomes impaired, it could require charges to earnings, which would adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

Risks Related to Veritex’s Industry and Regulation

We operate in a highly regulated environment and the laws and regulations that govern our operations, corporate governance, executive compensation and accounting principles, or changes in them, or failure to comply with them, could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.
State and federal banking agencies periodically conduct examinations of our business, including our compliance with laws and regulations, and failure to comply with any supervisory actions to which we are or may become subject as a result of such examinations could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.
19



Many of our new activities and expansion plans require regulatory approvals, and failure to obtain them may restrict future growth.
Financial institutions, such as the Bank, face a risk of noncompliance with and enforcement action under the Bank Secrecy Act and other anti-money laundering statutes and regulations.
We are subject to fair lending laws, and failure to comply with these laws could lead to material penalties.
The FDIC’s restoration plan and the related increased assessment rate could adversely affect our earnings.
We are subject to increased capital requirements, which may adversely impact return on equity or prevent us from paying dividends or repurchasing shares.
The Federal Reserve imposes monetary policies and regulations on our business and may require us to commit capital resources to support the Bank.
We could be adversely affected by the soundness of other financial institutions.

Risks Related to Our Common Stock

The market price of our common stock may fluctuate significantly.
If securities or industry analysts change their recommendations regarding our common stock or if our operating results do not meet their expectations, our stock price could decline.
Future sales or the possibility of future sales of a substantial amount of our common stock may depress the price of the common stock.
The holders of our debt obligations will have priority over our common stock with respect to payment in the event of liquidation, dissolution or winding up of Veritex and with respect to the payment of interest and preferred dividends.
We depend on the Bank for cash flow, and the Bank’s ability to make cash distributions is restricted.
Our dividend policy may change without notice, our future ability to pay dividends is subject to restrictions, and we may not pay dividends in the future.
The requirements of being a public company may strain our resources, increase our costs and distract management.
Shareholders may be deemed to be acting in concert or otherwise in control of us, which could impose notice, approval and ongoing regulatory requirements upon them and result in adverse regulatory consequences for such holders.
An investment in our common stock is not an insured deposit and is not guaranteed by the FDIC, so you could lose some or all of your investment.

20



ITEM 1A.  RISK FACTORS
Investing in our common stock involves a high degree of risk. Before you decide to invest in our common stock, you should carefully consider the risks described below, together with all other information included in this Annual Report on Form 10K, including the disclosures in “Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and our consolidated financial statements and the related notes included in “Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data.” We believe the risks described below are the risks that are material to us as of the date of this Annual Report on Form 10-K. If any of the following risks actually occur, our business, financial condition, results of operations and growth prospects could be adversely affected. In that case, you could experience a partial or complete loss of your investment.
Risks Related to Veritex’s Business
Our business concentration in Texas, and specifically the Dallas-Fort Worth metroplex and the Houston metropolitan area, imposes risks and may magnify the consequences of any regional or local economic downturn affecting the Dallas-Fort Worth metroplex and the Houston metropolitan area, including any downturn in the real estate sector.
We primarily conduct operations in the Dallas-Fort Worth metroplex and the Houston metropolitan area. As of December 31, 2020, the substantial majority of the loans in our loan portfolio were made to borrowers who live and/or conduct business in the Dallas-Fort Worth metroplex and the Houston metropolitan area, and the substantial majority of secured loans were secured by collateral located in the Dallas-Fort Worth metroplex and the Houston metropolitan area. Accordingly, we are significantly exposed to risks associated with a lack of geographic diversification. The economic conditions in the Dallas-Fort Worth metroplex and the Houston metropolitan area are highly dependent on the real estate sector as well as the technology, financial services, insurance, transportation, manufacturing and energy sectors. Any downturn or adverse development in these sectors, particularly the real estate sector, or a decline in the value of single-family homes in the Dallas-Fort Worth metroplex and the Houston metropolitan area, could have an adverse impact on our business, financial condition and results of operations. Any adverse economic developments, among other things, could negatively affect the volume of loan originations, increase the level of nonperforming assets, increase the rate of foreclosure losses on loans and reduce the value of loans in our portfolio. Volatility in oil prices may have an impact on the economic conditions in the markets in which we operate. Any regional or local economic downturn that affects (1) existing or prospective borrowers, (2) the Dallas-Fort Worth metroplex or Houston metropolitan area or (3) property values in its market areas, may affect us and our profitability more significantly and more adversely than our competitors whose operations are less geographically focused.

COVID-19 and the impact of actions to mitigate it could have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations, and such effects will depend on future developments, which are highly uncertain and are difficult to predict.
COVID-19 has led to federal, state and local governments enacting various restrictions in an attempt to limit the spread of the virus, including the declaration of a federal National Emergency; multiple cities’ and states’ declarations of states of emergency; school and business closings; limitations on social or public gatherings and other social distancing measures, such as working remotely, travel restrictions, quarantines and shelter in place orders. Such measures have significantly contributed to rising unemployment and reductions in consumer and business spending. Possible additional waves of COVID-19 and the uncertainty of the timing of a widely available vaccine may adversely affect the re-opening process.

In response to the economic and financial effects of the COVID-19 pandemic, the Federal Reserve has sharply reduced interest rates (which we expect will likely remain low for a considerable period) and instituted quantitative easing measures as well as domestic and global capital market support programs. In addition, the current and prior presidential administrations, Congress, various federal agencies and state governments have taken measures to address the economic and social consequences of the COVID-19 pandemic, including the passage of the CARES Act, the creation of the Main Street Lending Program, and the passage of the Consolidated Appropriations Act, 2021, which was enacted on December 27, 2020. The CARES Act provided wide-ranging economic relief for individuals and businesses impacted by the COVID-19 pandemic, and the Consolidated Appropriations Act, 2021, extended some of these relief provisions in certain respects as well as provided other forms of relief.

The CARES Act established and provided $349 billion in funding for the PPP, a loan program administered by the SBA. Under the PPP, small businesses, sole proprietorships, independent contractors and self-employed individuals may apply for forgivable loans from existing SBA lenders and other approved regulated lenders that enroll in the program, subject to numerous limitations and eligibility criteria. Congress appropriated an additional $310 billion for PPP commitments on April 24, 2020, and amended the PPP on June 5, 2020 to make the terms of the PPP loans and loan forgiveness more flexible. The Consolidated Appropriations Act, 2021, provided additional funding for the PPP of approximately $284 billion and allows
21



eligible borrowers, including certain borrowers who already received a PPP loan, to apply for PPP loans through March 31, 2021. Beginning in early April 2020, we began processing loan applications under the PPP, and in January 2021, we began processing applications under this latest round of the PPP. Other banking regulatory agencies have encouraged lenders to extend additional loans, and the federal government is considering additional stimulus and support legislation focused on providing aid to various sectors, including small businesses.

In addition, the CARES Act and related guidance from the federal banking agencies provide financial institutions the option to temporarily suspend requirements under U.S. generally accepted accounting principles (“GAAP”) related to classification of certain loan modifications as troubled debt restructurings (“TDRs”) to account for the current and anticipated effects of the COVID-19 pandemic. The CARES Act, as amended by the Consolidated Appropriations Act, 2021, specified that COVID-19 related loan modifications executed between March 1, 2020 and the earlier of (i) 60 days after the date of termination of the national emergency declared by the President and (ii) January 1, 2022, on loans that were current as of December 31, 2019 are not TDRs. Additionally, under guidance from the federal banking agencies, other short-term modifications made on a good faith basis in response to the COVID-19 pandemic to borrowers that were current prior to any relief are not TDRs under ASC Subtopic 310-40, “Troubled Debt Restructuring by Creditors.” These modifications include short-term (e.g., up to six months) modifications such as payment deferrals, fee waivers, extensions of repayment terms, or delays in payment that are insignificant.

We are making a substantial level of loan modifications under our deferred payment program. Further, our loan portfolio includes loans that are in forbearance but which are not classified as TDRs because they were current at the time forbearance began. When the forbearance periods end, we may be required to classify a substantial portion of these COVID-19 deferments as TDRs. For the year ended December 31, 2020, the Company had 754 modifications of loans with aggregate principal balances $1.2 billion that qualified for temporary suspension of TDR requirements under Section 4013 of the CARES Act, as amended by the Consolidated Appropriations Act, 2021, and the interagency guidance. As of February 4, 2021, we had $33.7 million in loans with remaining deferments.

The CARES Act and the Consolidated Appropriations Act, 2021, also include a range of other provisions designed to support the U.S. economy and mitigate the impact of the COVID-19 pandemic on financial institutions and their customers, including through the authorization of various programs and measures that the U.S. Department of the Treasury, the Federal Reserve and other federal agencies may or are required to implement. Among other provisions, sections 4022 and 4023 of the CARES Act provide mortgage loan forbearance relief to certain borrowers experiencing financial hardship during the COVID-19 emergency. Further, in response to the COVID-19 pandemic, the Federal Reserve has implemented or announced a number of facilities to provide emergency liquidity to various segments of the U.S. economy and financial markets. Many of these facilities expired on December 31, 2020, or were extended for brief periods into 2021. The expiration of these facilities could have adverse effect on U.S. economy and ultimately on our business.

The full impact on our business activities as a result of new government and regulatory policies, programs and guidelines, as well as regulators’ reactions to such activities, remains uncertain. The Bank’s participation in the PPP could subject us to increased governmental and regulatory scrutiny, negative publicity or increased exposure to litigation, which could increase our operational, legal and compliance costs and damage our reputation. Moreover, if the federal stimulus measures are not effective in mitigating the effect of the COVID-19 pandemic, credit issues for our loan customers may be severe and adversely affect our businesses, results of operations, and financial condition more substantially over a longer period of time.

The continuation of the economic effects of the COVID-19 pandemic has had a destabilizing effect on financial markets, key market indices and overall economic activity. The uncertainty regarding the duration of the COVID-19 pandemic and the resulting economic disruption has caused increased market volatility and may lead to an economic recession and a significant decrease in consumer confidence and business generally. The continuation of these conditions caused by the outbreak, including whether due to a resurgence or a second wave of COVID-19 infections, particularly as the geographic areas in which we operate determine whether, when and how to reopen, and the uncertainty of the timing of a widely available vaccine, as well as the impacts of the CARES Act and other federal and state measures, specifically with respect to loan forbearances, can be expected to adversely impact our businesses and results of operations and the operations of our borrowers, customers and business partners. In particular, these events have had, and can be expected to have, the following effects, among others:

impair the ability of borrowers to repay outstanding loans or other obligations, resulting in increases in delinquencies;
impair the value of collateral securing loans (particularly with respect to real estate);
impair the value of our securities portfolio;
require an increase in our allowance for credit losses or unfunded commitments;
22



adversely affect the stability of our deposit base, or otherwise impair our liquidity;
result in a triggering event that could, under certain circumstances, cause us to perform a goodwill impairment test and result in an impairment charge being recorded;
reduce our wealth management revenues and the demand for our products and services;
result in increased compliance risk as we become subject to new regulatory and other requirements associated with the PPP and other new programs in which we participate;
impair the ability of loan guarantors to honor commitments;
negatively impact our regulatory capital ratios;
negatively impact the productivity and availability of key personnel and other employees necessary to conduct our business, and of third-party service providers who perform critical services for us, or otherwise cause operational failures due to changes in our normal business practices necessitated by the outbreak and related governmental actions;
increase cyber and payment fraud risk, given increased online and remote activity; and
broadly result in lost revenue and income.

Continued measures by health or other governmental authorities encouraging or requiring significant restrictions on travel, assembly or other core business practices could further harm our business and those of our customers, in particular our small to medium-sized business customers. Although we have business continuity plans and other safeguards in place, there is no assurance that they will be effective.

Our results of operations have been adversely affected by the factors described above. For example, in the year ended December 31, 2020, these factors caused a substantial increase in our allowance for credit losses and related provision for credit losses. The ultimate impact of these factors over the longer term is uncertain at this time and we do not yet know the full extent of the impacts on our business, our operations or the global economy as a whole, nor the pace of the economic recovery when the COVID-19 pandemic subsides. However, the decline in economic conditions generally and a prolonged negative impact on small to medium-sized businesses, in particular, due to the COVID-19 pandemic is likely to result in an adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations and may heighten many of our known risks.

Uncertain market conditions and economic trends could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

We operate in an uncertain economic environment, including generally uncertain conditions nationally and locally in our industry and market. Financial institutions continue to be affected by volatility in the real estate market in some parts of the country and uncertain regulatory and interest rate conditions. We retain direct exposure to the residential and commercial real estate market in Texas, particularly in the Dallas-Fort Worth metroplex and Houston metropolitan area, and are affected by these events.
Our ability to assess the creditworthiness of customers and to estimate the losses inherent in our loan portfolio is made more complex by uncertain market and economic conditions. Unfavorable economic trends, sustained high unemployment, and declines in real estate values can cause a reduction in the availability of commercial credit and can negatively impact the credit performance of commercial and consumer loans, resulting in increased write-downs. These negative trends can cause economic pressure on consumers and businesses and diminish confidence in the financial markets, which may adversely affect our business, financial condition, results of operations and ability to access capital. A worsening of these conditions, such as a recession or economic slowdown, would likely exacerbate the adverse effects of these difficult market conditions on us and others in the financial services industry.
Our risk management practices, such as monitoring the concentration of our loans within specific industries and our credit approval practices, may not adequately reduce credit risk, and our credit administration personnel, policies and procedures may not adequately adapt to changes in economic or any other conditions affecting customers and the quality of the loan portfolio. A national economic recession or deterioration of conditions in our market could drive losses beyond that which is provided for in our allowance for credit losses and result in one or more of the following consequences:
increases in loan delinquencies;
increases in nonperforming assets and foreclosures;
decreases in demand for our products and services, which could adversely affect our liquidity position; and
decreases in the value of the collateral securing our loans, especially real estate, which could reduce customers’ borrowing power and repayment ability
23



Declines in real estate values, volume of home sales and financial stress on borrowers as a result of the uncertain economic environment, including job losses, could have an adverse effect on our borrowers and/or their customers, which could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.
Interest rate shifts could reduce net interest income and otherwise negatively impact our financial condition and results of operations.
The majority of our banking assets are monetary in nature and subject to risk from changes in interest rates. Like most financial institutions, our earnings and cash flows depend to a great extent upon the level of net interest income, or the difference between the interest income earned on loans, investments and other interest-earning assets, and the interest paid on interest-bearing liabilities, such as deposits and borrowings. Changes in interest rates can increase or decrease net interest income because different types of assets and liabilities may react differently, and at different times, to market interest rate changes. When interest-bearing liabilities mature or reprice more quickly or to a greater degree than interest-earning assets in a period, an increase in interest rates could reduce net interest income. Similarly, when interest-earning assets mature or reprice more quickly or to a greater degree than interest-bearing liabilities, falling interest rates could reduce net interest income. Our interest sensitivity profile was asset sensitive as of December 31, 2020, meaning that we estimate net interest income would increase more from rising interest rates than from falling interest rates.

An increase in interest rates may also, among other things, reduce the demand for loans and our ability to originate loans and decrease loan repayment rates. A decrease in the general level of interest rates may affect us through, among other things, increased prepayments on our loan portfolio and increased competition for deposits. Accordingly, changes in the level of market interest rates affect our net yield on interest-earning assets, loan origination volume, loan portfolio and overall results. Although our asset-liability management strategy is designed to control and mitigate exposure to the risks related to changes in market interest rates, those rates are affected by many factors outside of our control, including governmental monetary policies, inflation, deflation, recession, changes in unemployment, the money supply, international disorder and instability in domestic and foreign financial markets.
Additionally, interest rate increases often result in larger payment requirements for our borrowers, which increases the potential for default and could result in a decrease in the demand for loans. At the same time, the marketability of the property securing a loan may be adversely affected by any reduced demand resulting from higher interest rates. In a declining interest rate environment, there may be an increase in prepayments on loans as borrowers refinance their loans at lower rates. In addition, in a low interest rate environment, loan customers often pursue long-term fixed rate credits, which could adversely affect our earnings and net interest margin if rates increase. Changes in interest rates also can affect the value of loans, securities and other assets. An increase in interest rates that adversely affects the ability of borrowers to pay the principal or interest on loans may lead to an increase in nonperforming assets and a reduction of income recognized, which could have an adverse effect on our results of operations and cash flows. Further, when we place a loan on nonaccrual status, we reverse any accrued but unpaid interest receivable, which decreases interest income. At the same time, we continue to incur a cost to fund the loan, which is reflected as interest expense on deposits and borrowings, without any interest income to offset the associated funding expense. We would incur a higher cost of funds to retain these deposits in a rising interest rate environment. Our net interest income could be adversely affected if the rates we pay on deposits and borrowings increase more rapidly than the rates we earn on loans and debt securities. Thus, an increase in the amount of nonperforming assets would have an adverse impact on our net interest income.
A large portion of our loan portfolio consists of commercial loans secured by receivables, promissory notes, inventory, equipment or other commercial collateral, the deterioration in value of which could increase the potential for future losses.

As of December 31, 2020, $1.6 billion, or 24.3%, of our total loans held for investment, excluding PPP loans, consisted of commercial loans to businesses. In general, these loans are collateralized by general business assets including, among other things, accounts receivable, promissory notes, inventory and equipment, and most are backed by a personal guaranty of the borrower or principal. These commercial loans are typically larger in amount than loans to individuals and, therefore, have the potential for larger losses on a single loan basis. Additionally, the repayment of commercial loans is subject to the ongoing business operations of the borrower. The collateral securing such loans generally includes moveable property such as equipment and inventory, which may decline in value more rapidly than we anticipate, thereby exposing us to increased credit risk. A significant portion of our commercial loans are secured by promissory notes that evidence loans made by Veritex to borrowers that in turn make loans to others that are secured by real estate. Accordingly, negative changes in the economy affecting real estate values and liquidity could impair the value of the collateral securing these loans. Significant adverse changes in the economy or local market conditions in which our commercial lending customers operate could cause rapid declines in loan collectability and the values associated with general business assets resulting in inadequate collateral coverage that may expose us to credit losses and could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.
24




The phasing out and ultimate replacement of LIBOR with an alternative reference rate and changes in the manner of calculating other reference rates may adversely impact the value of loans and other financial instruments we hold that are linked to LIBOR or other reference rates in ways that are difficult to predict and could adversely impact our financial condition.

In July 2017, the United Kingdom’s Financial Conduct Authority, which regulates LIBOR, announced that it intends to phase out LIBOR by the end of 2021, and for LIBOR to be replaced with an alternative reference rate that will be calculated in a different manner. In November 2020, the ICE Benchmark Administration, which administers LIBOR, announced its intention to extend the publication of most tenors of LIBOR through June 30, 2023. The Federal Reserve has continued to encourage banks to transition away from LIBOR as soon as practicable. Our commercial and consumer businesses issue, trade and hold various products that are currently indexed to LIBOR. As of December 31, 2020, we had a material amount of loans, debt securities, advances from the Federal Home Loan Bank of Dallas (the “FHLB”) and notional value of derivatives indexed to LIBOR that will mature after 2021. At this time, no consensus exists as to what rate or rates may become acceptable alternatives to LIBOR and it is impossible to predict the effect of any such alternatives on the value of LIBOR-based instruments or arrangements. One of the major identified risks is inadequate fallback language in the various instruments’ contracts that may result in issues establishing the alternative index and adjusting the margin as applicable. We have (1) established a cross-functional team to identify, assess and monitor risks associated with the transition of LIBOR and other benchmark rates; (2) developed an inventory of affected products; and (3) implemented more robust fallback contract language.

Uncertainty as to the nature of alternative reference rates and as to potential changes or other reforms to LIBOR may adversely affect LIBOR rates and the value of LIBOR-based loans and securities we have issued. If not sufficiently planned for, the discontinuation of LIBOR could result in financial, operational, legal, reputational or compliance risks to financial markets and institutions, including to Veritex. In addition, we may incur significant expenses in effecting the transition, and may be subject to disputes or litigation with customers over the appropriateness or comparability to LIBOR of the substitute indices, which could have an adverse effect on our financial condition or results of operations.

Significant increases of nonperforming assets from the current level, or greater than anticipated costs to resolve these credits, will have an adverse effect on Veritex’s earnings.
Our nonperforming assets, which consist of nonaccrual loans, accruing loans 90 days or more past due and other real estate owned, adversely affect our net income in various ways. We do not record interest income on nonaccrual loans and assets acquired through foreclosure. We must establish an allowance for credit losses which reserves for losses inherent in our loan portfolio that are both probable and reasonably estimable. From time to time, we also write down the value of properties in our portfolio of assets acquired through foreclosure to reflect changing market values. Additionally, there are legal fees associated with the resolution of problem assets as well as carrying costs such as taxes, insurance and maintenance related to assets acquired through foreclosure. The resolution of nonperforming assets requires the active involvement of management, which can distract management from daily operations and other income producing activities. Finally, if our estimate of the allowance for credit losses is inadequate, we will have to increase the allowance for credit losses accordingly, which will have an adverse effect on our earnings. Significant increases in the level of our nonperforming assets from the current level, or greater than anticipated costs to resolve these credits, will have an adverse effect on our earnings.

The small to medium-sized businesses that we lend to may have fewer resources to weather adverse business developments, which may impair a borrower’s ability to repay a loan, and such impairment could adversely affect our results of operations and financial condition.
We focus our business development and marketing strategy primarily on small to medium-sized businesses. Small to medium-sized businesses frequently have smaller market shares than their competition, may be more vulnerable to economic downturns, often need substantial additional capital to expand or compete and may experience substantial volatility in operating results, any of which characteristics may impair a borrower’s ability to repay a loan. In addition, the success of a small or medium-sized business often depends on the management skills, talents and efforts of a small group of people, and the death, disability or resignation of one or more of these people could have an adverse impact on the business and its ability to repay its loans. If general economic conditions negatively impact the Dallas-Fort Worth metroplex, Houston metropolitan area or Texas generally, and small to medium-sized businesses are adversely affected or our borrowers are otherwise affected by adverse business developments, our business, financial condition and results of operations could be adversely affected.
25



Our allowance for credit losses may prove to be insufficient to absorb potential losses in our loan portfolio, which could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.
We establish an allowance for credit losses and maintain it at a level considered adequate by management to absorb expected credit losses based on our analysis of the loan portfolio and market environment. The allowance for credit losses represents our estimate of expected losses in the portfolio at each balance sheet date and is based upon relevant information available to us. Our allowance for credit losses consists of a general component based upon probable but unidentified losses inherent in the portfolio and a specific component based on individual loans that do not share similar risk characteristics of segmented loan portfolios. The general component is based on a discounted cash flow model driven off forecasted economic indicators, historical loss experience for peer banks and other qualitative factors. The specific component of the allowance for credit losses is calculated based on a review of individual loans that do not share similar risk characteristics of segmented loan portfolios. The specific loan analysis of expected losses may be based on the present value of expected future cash flows discounted at the effective loan rate, an observable market price or the fair value of the underlying collateral on collateral dependent loans. In determining the collectability of certain loans, management also considers the fair value of any underlying collateral. The amount ultimately realized may differ from the carrying value of these assets because of economic, operating or other conditions beyond our control, and any such differences may be material.
As of December 31, 2020, our allowance for credit losses was 1.80% of our total loans held for investment, excluding MW and PPP loans. Loans acquired are initially recorded at fair value, which includes an estimate of credit losses expected to be realized over the remaining lives of the loans. Additional credit losses may occur in the future and may occur at a rate greater than we previously experienced. We may be required to take additional provisions for credit losses in the future to further supplement the allowance for credit losses, either due to management’s decision to do so or requirements by our banking regulators. In addition, bank regulatory agencies will periodically review the allowance for credit losses and the value attributed to nonaccrual loans or to real estate acquired through foreclosure. Such regulatory agencies may require us to recognize future charge-offs. These adjustments could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.
Our financial condition and results of operations may be adversely affected by changes in accounting policies, standards and interpretations.
The Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) and other bodies that establish accounting standards periodically change the financial accounting and reporting standards governing the preparation of our financial statements. Additionally, those bodies that establish and interpret the accounting standards (such as the FASB, SEC and banking regulators) may change prior interpretations or positions on how these standards should be applied. Changes resulting from these new standards may result in materially different financial results and may require that we change how we process, analyze and report financial information and that we change financial reporting controls.
We may be unable to implement aspects of our growth strategy, which may affect our ability to maintain historical earnings trends.
Our business has grown rapidly, with a strategy focused on organic growth, supplemented by acquisitions. Financial institutions that grow rapidly can experience significant difficulties as a result of rapid growth. We may be unable to execute on aspects of our growth strategy to sustain our historical rate of growth or may be unable to grow at all. More specifically, we may be unable to generate sufficient new loans and deposits within acceptable risk and expense tolerances, obtain the personnel or funding necessary for additional growth or find suitable acquisition candidates. Various factors, such as economic conditions and competition, may impede or prohibit the growth of our operations, the opening of new branches and the consummation of acquisitions. Further, we may be unable to attract and retain experienced bankers, which could adversely affect our growth. The success of our strategy also depends on our ability to effectively manage growth, which is dependent upon a number of factors, including the ability to adapt existing credit, operational, technology and governance infrastructure to accommodate expanded operations. If we fail to build infrastructure sufficient to support rapid growth or fails to implement one or more aspects of our strategy, we may be unable to maintain historical earnings trends, which could have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.
Our strategy of pursuing acquisitions exposes us to financial, execution and operational risks that could have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and growth prospects.
We intend to continue pursuing strategic acquisitions. An acquisition strategy involves significant risks, including the following:
finding suitable candidates for acquisition;
26



attracting funding to support additional growth within acceptable risk tolerances;
maintaining asset quality;
retaining customers and key personnel, including bankers;
obtaining necessary regulatory approvals, which we may have difficulty obtaining or be unable to obtain;
conducting adequate due diligence and managing known and unknown risks and uncertainties;
integrating acquired businesses; and
maintaining adequate regulatory capital.
The market for acquisition targets is highly competitive, which may adversely affect our ability to find acquisition candidates that fit our strategy and standards. We face significant competition in pursuing acquisition targets from other banks and financial institutions, many of which possess greater financial, human, technical and other resources. Our ability to compete in acquiring target institutions will depend on the financial resources available to fund acquisitions, including the amount of cash and cash equivalents and the liquidity and market price of our common stock. In addition, increased competition may also drive up the acquisition consideration that we will be required to pay in order to successfully capitalize on attractive acquisition opportunities. To the extent that we are unable to find suitable acquisition targets, an important component of our growth strategy may not be realized.
Acquisitions of financial institutions also involve operational risks and uncertainties, such as unknown or contingent liabilities with no available manner of recourse, exposure to unexpected problems such as asset quality, the retention of key employees and customers and other issues that could negatively affect our business. We may not be able to complete future acquisitions or, if completed, may not be able to successfully integrate the operations, technology platforms, management, products and services of the entities acquired or realize a reduction of redundancies. The integration process may also require significant time and attention from our management that would otherwise be directed toward servicing existing business and developing new business. Failure to successfully integrate the entities we acquire into our existing operations in a timely or effective manner may increase our operating costs significantly and adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations. Further, acquisitions typically involve the payment of a premium over book and market values and, therefore, some dilution of our tangible book value and net income per common share may occur in connection with any future acquisition. In addition, the carrying amount of any goodwill that is currently maintained or that may be acquired may be subject to impairment in future periods.
If we grow to over $10 billion in total consolidated assets, we will become subject to increased regulation

Federal law imposes heightened requirements on bank holding companies and depository institutions that exceed $10 billion in total consolidated assets. An insured depository institution with $10 billion or more in total assets is subject to supervision, examination, and enforcement with respect to consumer protection laws by the CFPB. Under its current policies, the CFPB will assert jurisdiction in the first quarter after the insured depository institution’s call reports show total consolidated assets of $10 billion or more for four consecutive quarters. Additionally, other regulatory requirements apply to insured depository institution holding companies and insured depository institutions with $10 billion or more in total consolidated assets, including the Volcker Rule, management interlocks requirements and inability to comply with capital requirements through the CBLR framework. Further, deposit insurance assessment rates are calculated differently, and may be higher, for insured depository institutions with $10 billion or more in total consolidated assets.

Debit card interchange fee restrictions set forth in section 1075 of the Dodd-Frank Act, known as the Durbin Amendment, as implemented by regulations of the Federal Reserve, cap the maximum debit interchange fee that an issuer may receive per transaction at the sum of 21 cents plus five basis points. An issuer that adopts certain fraud prevention procedures may charge an additional one cent per transaction. Debit card issuers with less than $10 billion in total consolidated assets, currently including the Bank, are exempt from these interchange fee restrictions. The exemption for small issuers ceases to apply as of July 1 of the year following the calendar year in which the issuer has total consolidated assets of $10 billion or more at year-end.

In November 2020, given that many community banking organizations have grown in total assets as a result of the COVID-19 response, the federal banking agencies provided relief for banks and bank holding companies, among other financial institutions, to use asset data as of the lower of December 31, 2019 or the normal measurement date in order to determine the applicability of various regulatory asset thresholds and reporting requirements, including eligibility for the CBLR framework, during the calendar years 2020 and 2021.

27



Our ability to retain bankers and recruit additional successful bankers is critical to the success of our business strategy, and any failure to do so could adversely affect our business, financial condition, results of operations and growth prospects.
Our ability to retain and grow loans, deposits and fee income depends upon the business generation capabilities, reputation and relationship management skills of our bankers. If we were to lose the services of any of our bankers, including successful bankers employed by banks that we may acquire, to a new or existing competitor or otherwise, we may not be able to retain valuable relationships and some of our customers could choose to use the services of a competitor instead.
Our growth strategy also relies on our ability to attract and retain additional profitable bankers. We may face difficulties in recruiting and retaining bankers of the desired caliber, including as a result of competition from other financial institutions. In particular, some of our competitors are significantly larger with greater financial resources, and may be able to offer more attractive compensation packages and broader career opportunities. Additionally, we may incur significant expenses and expend significant time and resources on training, integration and business development before we are able to determine whether a new banker will be profitable or effective. If we are unable to attract and retain successful bankers, or if our bankers fail to meet expectations in terms of customer relationships and profitability, we may be unable to execute our business strategy and our business, financial condition, results of operations and growth prospects may be adversely affected.

Loss of any of our executive officers or other key employees could impair relationships with our customers and adversely affect our business.

Our success depends on the continued service and skills of our executive management team. Our goals, strategies and marketing efforts are closely tied to the banking philosophy and strengths of our executive management team. Our success is also dependent in part on the continued service of our market presidents and relationship managers. The loss of any of these key personnel could adversely affect our business because of their skills, years of industry experience and relationships with customers, and because it may be difficult to promptly find qualified replacement personnel. We cannot guarantee that these executive officers or key employees will continue to be employed with us in the future.
The relatively unseasoned nature of a significant portion of our loan portfolio may expose us to increased credit risks.
The business of lending is inherently risky, including risks that the principal of or interest on any loan will not be repaid timely or at all or that the value of any collateral supporting the loan will be insufficient to cover our outstanding exposure. Our loans held for investments, excluding PPP loans, portfolio has grown to $6.4 billion as of December 31, 2020, from $100.9 million as of December 31, 2010. This growth is related to both organic growth and loans acquired in connection with business acquisitions. The organic portion of this increase is due to increased loan production in the Texas markets in which we operate. It is difficult to assess the future performance of acquired or recently originated loans because our relatively limited experience with such loans does not provide us with a significant payment history from which to judge future collectability. These loans may experience higher delinquency or charge-off levels than our historical loan portfolio experience, which could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

Our commercial real estate and construction and land loan portfolios expose us to credit risks that could be greater than the risks related to other types of loans.
As of December 31, 2020, $2.6 billion, or 40.8% of total loans held for investment, excluding PPP loans, consisted of commercial real estate loans (including owner occupied commercial real estate loans) and $693.0 million, or 10.8% of total loans held for investment, excluding PPP loans, consisted of construction and land loans. These loans typically involve repayment dependent upon income generated, or expected to be generated, by the property securing the loan in amounts sufficient to cover operating expenses and debt service. The availability of such income for repayment may be adversely affected by changes in the economy or local market conditions. These loans expose a lender to greater credit risk than loans secured by other types of collateral because the collateral securing these loans is typically more difficult to liquidate due to the fluctuation of real estate values. Additionally, non-owner occupied commercial real estate loans generally involve relatively large balances to single borrowers or related groups of borrowers. Unexpected deterioration in the credit quality of our non-owner occupied commercial real estate loan portfolio could require us to increase the allowance for credit losses, which would reduce profitability and could have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.
28



Construction and land loans also involve risks attributable to the fact that loan funds are secured by a project under construction, and the project is of uncertain value prior to its completion. It can be difficult to accurately evaluate the total funds required to complete a project, and construction lending often involves the disbursement of substantial funds with repayment dependent, in part, on the success of the ultimate project rather than the ability of a borrower or guarantor to repay the loan. If we are forced to foreclose on a project prior to completion, we may be unable to recover the entire unpaid portion of the loan. In addition, we may be required to fund additional amounts to complete a project and may have to hold the property for an indeterminate period of time, any of which could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.
Because a significant portion of our loan portfolio consists of real estate loans, negative changes in the economy affecting real estate values and liquidity could impair the value of collateral securing our real estate loans and result in loan and other losses.
As of December 31, 2020, $4.3 billion, or 66.6% of total loans held for investment, excluding PPP loans, consisted of loans with real estate as a primary or secondary component of collateral. As a result, adverse developments affecting real estate values in the Texas markets in which we operate could increase the credit risk associated with our real estate loan portfolio. Real estate values in many Texas markets have experienced periods of fluctuation over the last five years, and the market value of real estate can fluctuate significantly in a short period of time. Adverse changes affecting real estate values and the liquidity of real estate in one or more of our markets could increase the credit risk associated with our loan portfolio, and could result in losses that adversely affect credit quality, financial condition and results of operations. Negative changes in the economy affecting real estate values and liquidity in our market areas could significantly impair the value of property pledged as collateral on loans and affect our ability to sell the collateral upon foreclosure without a loss or additional losses. Collateral may need to be sold for less than the outstanding balance of the loan, which could result in losses on such loans. Such declines and losses could have an adverse impact on our business, results of operations and growth prospects. If real estate values decline, it is also more likely that we would be required to increase the allowance for credit losses, which could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.
.
We may be subject to environmental liabilities in connection with the foreclosure on real estate assets securing our loan portfolio.

Hazardous or toxic substances or other environmental hazards may be located on the properties that secure our loans. If we acquire such properties as a result of foreclosure or otherwise, we could become subject to various environmental liabilities. For example, we could be held liable for the cost of cleaning up or otherwise addressing contamination at or from these properties. We could also be held liable to a governmental entity or third party for property damage, personal injury or other claims relating to any environmental contamination at or from these properties. In addition, we may own and operate certain properties that may be subject to similar environmental liability risks during any given fiscal year. Although we have policies and procedures that are designed to mitigate certain environmental risks, we may not detect all environmental hazards associated with these properties. If we were to become subject to significant environmental liabilities, our business, financial condition and results of operations could be adversely affected.

We are exposed to increased credit losses and credit related expenses in the event of a major natural disaster, public health crisis, other catastrophic event or significant climate change effects.

The occurrence of a major natural or environmental disaster, public health crisis or similar catastrophic event, as well as significant climate change effects such as rising sea levels or wildfires, especially in densely populated geographic areas, could increase our credit losses and credit related expenses. A natural disaster, public health crisis or catastrophic event or other significant climate change effect that either damages or destroys residential or multifamily real estate underlying mortgage loans or real estate collateral, or negatively affects the ability of borrowers to continue to make payments on loans, could increase our serious delinquency rates and average credit loss severity in the affected areas. Such events could also cause downturns in economic and market conditions generally, which could have an adverse effect on our business and financial results. We may not have adequate insurance coverage for some of these natural, catastrophic, public health or climate change-related events.

We have a concentration of loans outstanding to a limited number of borrowers, which may increase our risk of loss.

We have extended significant amounts of credit to a limited number of borrowers, and as of December 31, 2020, the aggregate amount of loans to our 10 and 25 largest borrowers (including related entities) amounted to $401.9 million, or 6.3% of total loans held for investment, excluding PPP loans, and $889.1 million, or 13.8% of total loans held for investment, excluding PPP loans, respectively. As of such date, none of these loans were nonperforming loans. Concentration of a significant amount of credit extended to a limited number of borrowers increases the risk in our loan portfolio. If one or more of these borrowers is unable to make payments of interest and principal in respect of such loans, the potential loss to us is more likely to have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.
29




A lack of liquidity could impair our ability to fund operations, adversely affect our operations and jeopardize our business, financial condition and results of operations.

Liquidity is essential to our business. We rely on our ability to generate deposits and effectively manage the repayment and maturity schedules of loans and debt securities, respectively, to ensure that we have adequate liquidity to fund operations. An inability to raise funds through deposits, borrowings, the sale of our debt securities, or the sale of loans and other sources could have a substantial negative effect on our liquidity.

Our most important source of funds is core deposits. Core deposit balances can decrease when customers perceive alternative investments as providing a better risk/return tradeoff. If customers move money out of bank deposits and into other products, such as money market funds, we would lose a relatively low-cost source of funds, increasing funding costs and reducing net interest income and net income.

Other primary sources of funds consist of cash flows from operations, maturities and sales of securities, and proceeds from the issuance and sale of our equity and debt securities to investors. Additional liquidity is provided by the ability to borrow from our brokered deposit network, the FHLB and the Federal Reserve Bank of Dallas ("FRB"). We also may borrow funds from third-party lenders, such as other financial institutions. Access to funding sources in amounts adequate to finance or capitalize our activities, or on acceptable terms, could be impaired by factors that affect us directly or the financial services industry or economy in general, such as disruptions in the financial markets or negative views and expectations about the prospects for the financial services industry. Our access to funding sources could also be affected by a decrease in the level of business activity as a result of a downturn in the Dallas-Fort Worth metroplex or the Houston metropolitan area or by one or more adverse regulatory actions against Veritex.

Any decline in available funding could adversely impact our ability to originate loans, invest in securities, meet our expenses or fulfill obligations such as repaying borrowings or meeting deposit withdrawal demands, any of which could have an adverse impact on liquidity and could, in turn, adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

We have a limited operating history and, accordingly, investors will have little basis on which to evaluate its ability to achieve our business objectives.

We were formed as a bank holding company in 2009 and commenced banking operations in 2010. Accordingly, we have a limited operating history upon which to evaluate our business and future prospects. As a result, it is difficult to predict future operating results and to assess the likelihood of the success of our business. As a relatively young financial institution, Veritex Bank is also subject to risks and levels of risk that are often greater than those encountered by financial institutions with longer established operations and relationships. New financial institutions often require significant capital from sources other than operations.

We may need to raise additional capital in the future, and if we fail to maintain sufficient capital, whether due to losses, an inability to raise additional capital or otherwise, our financial condition, liquidity and results of operations, as well as the ability to maintain regulatory compliance, could be adversely affected.

We face significant capital and other regulatory requirements as a financial institution. We may need to raise additional capital in the future to provide sufficient capital resources and liquidity to meet our commitments and business needs, which could include the possibility of financing acquisitions. In addition, we, on a consolidated basis, and Veritex Bank, on a standalone basis, must meet certain regulatory capital requirements and maintain sufficient liquidity. Importantly, regulatory capital requirements could increase from current levels, which could require us to raise additional capital or reduce our operations. Our ability to raise additional capital depends on conditions in the capital markets, economic conditions and a number of other factors, including investor perceptions regarding the banking industry, market conditions and governmental activities, and on our financial condition and performance. Accordingly, we may be unable to raise additional capital if needed or on acceptable terms. If we fail to maintain capital to meet regulatory requirements, our liquidity, business, financial condition and results of operations could be adversely affected.

30



We could recognize losses on debt securities held in our securities portfolio, particularly if interest rates increase or economic and market conditions deteriorate.

While we attempt to invest a significant percentage of our assets in loans (our loan to deposit ratio, excluding MW, was 89.8% as of December 31, 2020), we also invest a percentage of our total assets in debt securities (12.0% as of December 31, 2020) with the primary objectives of providing a source of liquidity, providing an appropriate return on funds invested, managing interest rate risk, meeting pledging requirements and meeting regulatory capital requirements. As of December 31, 2020, the fair value of our available for sale debt securities portfolio was $1.0 billion, which included a net unrealized gain of $55.0 million. Factors beyond our control can significantly influence the fair value of debt securities in our portfolio and can cause potential adverse changes to the fair value of these securities. For example, fixed-rate debt securities are generally subject to decreases in market value when interest rates rise. Additional factors include, but are not limited to, rating agency downgrades of the securities, defaults by the issuer or individual borrowers with respect to the underlying securities, and continued instability in the credit markets. Any of the foregoing factors could cause other-than-temporary impairment in future periods and result in realized losses. The process for determining whether impairment is other-than-temporary usually requires difficult, subjective judgments about the future financial performance of the issuer and any collateral underlying the security in order to assess the probability of receiving all contractual principal and interest payments on the security. Because of changing economic and market conditions affecting interest rates, the financial condition of issuers of the securities and the performance of the underlying collateral, we may recognize realized and/or unrealized losses in future periods, which could have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

We face strong competition from financial services companies and other companies that offer banking services, which could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

We conduct our operations exclusively in Texas and particularly in the Dallas-Fort Worth metroplex and Houston metropolitan area. Many of our competitors offer the same, or a wider variety of, banking services within the same market area. These competitors include banks with nationwide operations, regional banks and other community banks. We also face competition from many other types of financial institutions, including savings banks, credit unions, finance companies, mutual funds, insurance companies, brokerage and investment banking firms, asset-based non-bank lenders and certain other non-financial entities, such as retail stores which may maintain their own credit programs and certain governmental organizations which may offer more favorable financing or deposit terms than we can. In addition, a number of out-of-state financial intermediaries have opened production offices, or otherwise solicit deposits, in our market area. Increased competition in our market may result in reduced loans and deposits, as well as reduced net interest margin, fee income and profitability. Ultimately, we may not be able to compete successfully against current and future competitors. If we are unable to attract and retain banking customers, we may be unable to continue to grow loan and deposit portfolios, and our business, financial condition and results of operations could be adversely affected.

Our ability to compete successfully depends on a number of factors, including, among other things:

our ability to develop, build and maintain long-term customer relationships based on top quality service, high ethical standards and safe, sound assets;
the scope, relevance and pricing of products and services offered to meet customer needs and demands;
the rate at which we introduce new products and services relative to our competitors;
customer satisfaction with our level of service;
the ability to expand our market position; and
industry and general economic trends.

Failure to perform in any of these areas could significantly weaken our competitive position, which could adversely affect our growth and profitability, which, in turn, could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

Negative public opinion regarding Veritex or our failure to maintain our reputation in the community could adversely affect our business and prevent us from continuing to grow our business.

As a community bank, our reputation within the community we serve is critical to our success. We strive to enhance our reputation by recruiting, hiring and retaining employees who share our core values of being an integral part of the communities Veritex serves and delivering superior service to our customers. If our reputation is negatively affected by the actions of our employees or otherwise, we may be less successful in attracting new customers, and our business, financial condition, results of operations and prospects could be materially and adversely affected. Further, negative public opinion could expose us to litigation and regulatory action as we seek to implement our growth strategy.

31



We may not be able to report our financial results accurately and timely as a publicly listed company if we fail to maintain an effective system of disclosure controls and procedures and internal control over financial reporting.

As a publicly traded company, we are required to file periodic reports containing our consolidated financial statements with the SEC within a specified time following the completion of quarterly and annual periods. Maintaining effective disclosure controls and procedures is necessary to identify information we must disclose in our periodic reports and maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting is necessary to produce reliable financial statements and to prevent fraud. If we fail to maintain effective disclosure controls and procedures or effective internal control over financial reporting, we may experience difficulty in satisfying our SEC reporting obligations. Any failure by us to file our periodic reports with the SEC in a timely manner could harm our reputation and cause investors and potential investors to lose confidence in us and reduce the market price of our common stock, and could result in a suspension or delisting of our common stock.

We must also comply with Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (the “Sarbanes-Oxley Act”), which requires that we perform an annual evaluation of the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting. During the course of our evaluation and testing, we may identify deficiencies, including material weaknesses, which would have to be remediated to satisfy SEC rules for attesting to the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting. A material weakness is defined by the standards issued by the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board as a deficiency, or combination of deficiencies, in internal control over financial reporting that results in a reasonable possibility that a material misstatement of our annual or interim financial statements will not be prevented or detected on a timely basis. If a material weakness is determined to exist, we must disclose this deficiency in periodic reports we file with the SEC. The existence of a material weakness would preclude management from concluding that our internal control over financial reporting is effective and would also preclude our independent auditors from attesting to the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting. In addition, disclosures of this type in our SEC reports could cause investors to lose confidence in our financial reporting and may negatively affect the market price of our common stock.

More generally, if we are unable to meet the demands that have been placed upon us as a public company, including the requirements of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act, we may be unable to accurately report our financial results in future periods, or report them within the timeframes required by law or stock exchange regulations. Failure to comply with the Sarbanes-Oxley Act could also potentially subject us to sanctions or investigations by the SEC or other regulatory authorities. Under such circumstances, we may be unable to implement the necessary internal controls in a timely manner, or at all, and future material weaknesses may exist or may be discovered. If we fail to implement the necessary improvements, or if material weaknesses or other deficiencies occur, our ability to accurately and timely report our financial position could be impaired, which could result in late filings of our annual and quarterly reports with the SEC, restatements of our consolidated financial statements, a decline in our stock price, suspension or delisting of our common stock, and could have an adverse effect on our business, results of operations or financial condition. Even if we are able to report our financial statements accurately and in a timely manner, any failure in our efforts to implement the improvements or disclosure of material weaknesses in our future filings with the SEC could cause our reputation to be harmed and our stock price to decline significantly.

We are subject to certain operational risks, including, but not limited to, customer or employee fraud and data processing system failures and errors.

Employee errors and employee or customer misconduct could subject us to financial losses or regulatory sanctions and seriously harm our reputation. Misconduct by our employees could include hiding unauthorized activities, improper or unauthorized activities on behalf of customers or improper use of confidential information. It is not always possible to prevent employee errors or misconduct, and the precautions we take to prevent and detect these activities may not be effective in all cases. Employee errors could also subject us to financial claims for negligence.

We maintain a system of internal controls to mitigate against operational risks, including data processing system failures and errors and customer or employee fraud, as well as insurance coverage designed to protect us from material losses associated with these risks, including losses resulting from any associated business interruption. If these internal controls fail to prevent or detect an occurrence, or if any resulting loss is not insured or exceeds applicable insurance limits, it could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

In addition, we rely heavily upon information supplied by third parties, including the information contained in credit applications, property appraisals, title information, equipment pricing and valuation and employment and income documentation, in deciding which loans to originate, as well as the terms of those loans. If any of the information upon which Veritex relies is misrepresented, either fraudulently or inadvertently, and the misrepresentation is not detected prior to loan funding, the value of the loan may be significantly lower than expected, or we may fund a loan that it would not have funded or on terms we would not have extended. Whether a misrepresentation is made by the loan applicant or another third party, we will generally bear the risk of loss associated with the misrepresentation. A loan subject to a material misrepresentation is typically unsellable or subject to repurchase if it is sold prior to detection of misrepresentation. The sources of the
32



misrepresentations are often difficult to locate, and recovery of any of the resulting monetary losses we may suffer could be difficult.

We have a continuing need for technological change and may not have the resources to effectively implement new technology, or may experience operational challenges when implementing new technology.

The financial services industry is undergoing rapid technological changes with frequent introductions of new technology-driven products and services. In addition to better serving customers, the effective use of technology increases efficiency and enables financial institutions to reduce costs. Our future success will depend, at least in part, upon our ability to address the needs of customers by using technology to provide products and services that will satisfy customer demands for convenience as well as to create additional efficiencies in operations as we continue to grow and expand the products and services we offer. We may experience operational challenges as we implement these new technology enhancements or products, which could result in an inability to fully realize the anticipated benefits from such new technology or significant costs to remedy any such challenges in a timely manner.

Many of our larger competitors have substantially greater resources to invest in technological improvements. As a result, they may be able to offer additional or superior products compared to those that we will be able to provide, which would put us at a competitive disadvantage. Accordingly, we may lose customers seeking new technology-driven products and services to the extent we are unable to provide such products and services.

Our operations could be interrupted if third-party service providers experience difficulty, terminate their services or fail to comply with banking regulations.

We depend on a number of relationships with third-party service providers. Specifically, we receive certain services from third parties including, but not limited to, core systems processing, essential web hosting and other Internet systems, online banking services, deposit processing and other processing services. Our operations could be interrupted if any of these third-party service providers experiences difficulties, or terminates its services, and we are unable to replace the provider with other service providers, particularly on a timely basis. If an interruption were to continue for a significant period of time, our business, financial condition and results of operations could be adversely affected, perhaps materially. In addition, we may not be insured against all types of losses as a result of third-party failures, and insurance coverage may be inadequate to cover all losses resulting from interruptions of third-party services. Even if we are able to replace third-party service providers, it may be at a higher cost to us, which could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

Unauthorized access, cyber-crime and other threats to data security may require significant resources, harm our reputation, and otherwise cause harm to our business.

We necessarily collect, use and hold personal and financial information concerning individuals and businesses with which we have a banking relationship. This information includes non-public, personally identifiable information that is protected under applicable federal and state laws and regulations. Additionally, certain of these data processing functions are outsourced to third-party providers. Our facilities and systems, and those of our third-party service providers, may be vulnerable to threats to data security, security breaches, acts of vandalism and other physical security threats, computer viruses or compromises, ransomware attacks, misplaced or lost data, programming and/or human errors or other similar events. Any security breach involving the misappropriation, loss or other unauthorized disclosure of our confidential business, employee or customer information, whether originating with us, our vendors or retail businesses, could severely damage our reputation, expose us to the risks of civil litigation and liability, require the payment of regulatory fines or penalties or undertaking of costly remediation efforts with respect to third parties affected by a security breach, disrupt our operations, and have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations. In addition, any damage, failure or security breach that causes breakdowns or disruptions in our general ledger, deposit, loan or other systems could damage our reputation, result in a loss of customer business, subject us to additional regulatory scrutiny, or expose us to civil litigation and possible financial liability, any of which could have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

It is difficult or impossible to defend against every cyber risk and controls employed by our information technology department and our other employees and vendors could prove inadequate. Increasing sophistication of cyber-criminals and terrorists make keeping up with new threats difficult and could result in a breach. Cyber-security risks appear to be growing and, as a result, the cyber-resilience of banking organizations is of increased importance to federal and state banking agencies and other regulators. New or revised laws and regulations may significantly impact our current and planned privacy, data protection and information security-related practices, the collection, use, sharing, retention and safeguarding of consumer and employee information, and current or planned business activities. Compliance with current or future privacy, data protection and information security laws to which we are subject could result in higher compliance and technology costs and could restrict our ability to provide certain products and services, which could materially and adversely affect our profitability. In the last few
33



years, there have been an increasing number of cyber incidents, including several well-publicized cyber-attacks that targeted other U.S. companies, including financial services companies much larger than us. These cyber incidents have been initiated from a variety of sources, including terrorist organizations and hostile foreign governments. As technology advances, the ability to initiate transactions and access data has also become more widely distributed among mobile devices, personal computers, automated teller machines, remote deposit capture sites and similar access points, some of which are not controlled or secured by us. It is possible that we could have exposure to liability and suffer losses as a result of a security breach or cyber-attack that occurred through no fault of Veritex. Further, the probability of a successful cyber-attack against us or one of our third-party service providers cannot be predicted. As cyber threats continue to evolve and increase, we may be required to spend significant additional resources to continue to modify or enhance our protective and preventative measures or to investigate and remediate any information security vulnerabilities. Our systems and those of our third-party vendors may also become vulnerable to damage or disruption due to circumstances beyond our or their control, such as from catastrophic events, power anomalies or outages, natural disasters, network failures, and viruses and malware.

Consumers may decide not to use banks to complete their financial transactions.
 
Technology and other changes are allowing consumers to complete financial transactions that historically have involved banks through alternative methods. For example, consumers can now maintain funds that would have historically been held as bank deposits in brokerage accounts, mutual funds, general-purpose reloadable prepaid cards or other mobile payment services. Consumers can also complete transactions such as paying bills and transferring funds directly without the assistance of banks. The process of eliminating banks as intermediaries, which may increase as consumers become more comfortable with these new technologies and offerings, could result in the loss of fee income, as well as the loss of customer deposits and the related income generated from those deposits. The loss of these revenue streams and the lower cost of deposits as a source of funds could have an adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.

If the goodwill that we have recorded or may record in connection with a business acquisition becomes impaired, it could require charges to earnings, which would adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

Goodwill represents the amount by which the cost of an acquisition exceeded the fair value of net assets acquired in connection with the purchase of another financial institution. We review goodwill for impairment at least annually, or more frequently if a triggering event occurs which indicates that the carrying value of the asset might be impaired. We may first assess qualitative factors to determine whether it is more likely than not (that is, a likelihood of more than 50 percent) that the fair value of a reporting unit is less than its carrying amounts, including goodwill. We have an unconditional option to bypass the qualitative assessment for any reporting unit in any period and proceed directly to performing the first step of the goodwill impairment test, and we may resume performing the qualitative assessment in any subsequent period. If we determine that it is more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit is less than its carrying amount, then the entity shall perform the first step of the two-step goodwill impairment test. Under the first step, the estimation of fair value of the reporting unit is compared to its carrying value including goodwill. If step one indicates a potential impairment, the second step is performed to measure the amount of impairment, if any. If the carrying amount of the reporting goodwill exceeds the implied fair value of that goodwill, an impairment loss is recognized in an amount equal to that excess. Any such adjustments are reflected in the results of operations in the periods in which they become known. As of December 31, 2020, goodwill totaled $370.8 million. Although we have not recorded any impairment charges since the goodwill was initially recorded, future evaluations of existing goodwill or goodwill acquired in the future may result in findings of impairment and related write-downs, which could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

Risks Related to Veritex’s Industry and Regulation
The ongoing changes in regulation could adversely affect our business, financial condition, and results of operations.

In July 2010, the Dodd-Frank Act was signed into law. This statute and its implementing regulations have imposed significant regulatory and compliance changes on financial institutions. The enactment of EGRRCPA in 2018, the CARES Act in 2020 and other legislation or rulemaking by the agencies may impose other costs or provide regulatory relief. The evolving financial services regulatory framework may impact the profitability of our business activities, require changes to certain of our business practices, require the development of new compliance infrastructure, impose upon us more stringent capital, liquidity and leverage requirements or otherwise adversely affect our business. These changes may also require us to invest significant management attention and resources to evaluate and make any changes necessary to comply with new statutory and regulatory requirements. Failure to comply with the new requirements or with any future changes in laws or regulations could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

34



We operate in a highly regulated environment and the laws and regulations that govern our operations, corporate governance, executive compensation and accounting principles, or changes in them, or failure to comply with them, could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

We are subject to extensive regulation, supervision and legal requirements that govern almost all aspects of our operations. These laws and regulations are not intended to protect our shareholders. Rather, these laws and regulations are intended to protect customers, depositors, the DIF, and the overall financial stability of the United States. These laws and regulations, among other matters, prescribe minimum capital requirements, impose limitations on the business activities in which we can engage, limit the dividends or distributions that the Bank can pay to the Holdco and that Veritex can pay to shareholders, restrict the ability of institutions to guarantee our debt, and impose certain specific accounting requirements on us that may be more restrictive and may result in greater or earlier charges to earnings or reductions in our capital than generally accepted accounting principles would require. Compliance with laws and regulations can be difficult and costly, and changes to laws and regulations often impose additional compliance costs. Our failure to comply with these laws and regulations, even if the failure follows good faith effort or reflects a difference in interpretation, could subject us to restrictions on our business activities, fines and other penalties, any of which could adversely affect our results of operations, capital base and the price of our securities. Further, any new laws, rules and regulations could make compliance more difficult or expensive or otherwise adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

State and federal banking agencies periodically conduct examinations of our business, including our compliance with laws and regulations, and failure to comply with any supervisory actions to which we are or may become subject as a result of such examinations could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

The TDB and the Federal Reserve periodically conduct examinations of our business, including our compliance with laws and regulations. If, as a result of an examination, a Texas or federal banking agency were to determine that the financial condition, capital resources, asset quality, earnings prospects, management, liquidity or other aspects of any of our operations had become unsatisfactory, or that Veritex, the Bank or their respective management were in violation of any law or regulation, it may take a number of different remedial actions as it deems appropriate. These actions include the power to prohibit “unsafe or unsound” practices, to require affirmative actions to correct any conditions resulting from any violation or practice, to issue an administrative order that can be judicially enforced, to direct an increase in our capital levels, to restrict our growth, to assess civil monetary penalties against Veritex, the Bank or their respective officers or directors, to remove officers and directors and to terminate the Bank’s deposit insurance upon notice and hearing. If we become subject to such regulatory actions, our business, financial condition, results of operations and reputation could be adversely affected.

Many of our new activities and expansion plans require regulatory approvals, and failure to obtain them may restrict future growth.

We intend to complement and expand our business by pursuing strategic acquisitions of financial institutions and other complementary businesses. Generally, we must receive state and federal regulatory approval before we can acquire a depository institution insured by the FDIC or related business. In determining whether to approve a proposed acquisition, federal banking regulators will consider, among other factors, the effect of the acquisition on competition, our financial condition, our future prospects and the impact of the proposal on U.S. financial stability. The regulators also review current and projected capital ratios and levels, the competence, experience and integrity of management and the parties' record of compliance with laws and regulations, the convenience and needs of the communities to be served (including the parties' record of performance under the CRA) and the effectiveness of the parties' in combating money laundering activities. Such regulatory approvals may not be granted on terms that are acceptable to us, or at all. We may also be required to sell branches as a condition to receiving regulatory approval, which condition may not be acceptable to us or, if acceptable to us, may reduce the benefit of any acquisition.

In addition to the acquisition of existing financial institutions, as opportunities arise, we plan to continue de novo branching as a part of its organic growth strategy. De novo branching and any acquisitions carry with them numerous risks, including the inability to obtain all required regulatory approvals. When evaluating applications to establish a de novo branch in Texas, the Federal Reserve and the TDB consider similar factors to those considered in connection with an expansionary transaction. The failure to obtain these regulatory approvals for potential future strategic acquisitions and de novo branches could impact our business plans and restrict our growth.

35



Financial institutions, such as the Bank, face a risk of noncompliance with and enforcement action under the Bank Secrecy Act and other anti-money laundering statutes and regulations.

The BSA, the USA PATRIOT Act, and other laws and regulations require financial institutions, among other requirements, to institute and maintain an effective AML program and file suspicious activity and currency transaction reports as appropriate. FinCEN, established by the U.S. Department of the Treasury to administer the BSA, is authorized to impose significant civil money penalties for violations of those requirements, and may engage in coordinated enforcement efforts with the individual federal banking regulators, as well as the U.S. Department of Justice, Drug Enforcement Administration, and Internal Revenue Service, among other government and law enforcement agencies. In addition, OFAC may pursue enforcement actions for failure to comply with the sanctions programs it administers.

In order to comply with regulations, guidelines and examination procedures in this area, we have dedicated significant resources to our BSA/AML programs. If our policies, procedures and systems are deemed deficient, we could be subject to liability, including fines and regulatory actions such as restrictions on our ability to pay dividends and the necessity to obtain regulatory approvals to proceed with certain aspects of our business plans, such as acquisitions and de novo branching.

We are subject to fair lending laws, and failure to comply with these laws could lead to material penalties.

The Equal Credit Opportunity Act, the Fair Housing Act and other federal and state fair lending laws and regulations impose nondiscriminatory lending requirements on financial institutions. The Federal Reserve, TDB, U.S. Department of Justice and other federal and state agencies are responsible for enforcing these laws and regulations against us. A successful challenge to our compliance with fair lending laws and regulations could result in a wide variety of sanctions, including the required payment of damages and civil money penalties, injunctive relief, imposition of restrictions on mergers and acquisitions activity, and restrictions on expansion activity. In addition, violations of fair lending laws and regulations may have an adverse effect on our CRA rating, which in turn may affect our ability to obtain regulatory approval for certain expansionary transactions and branching activities. Private parties may also have the ability to challenge an institution’s performance under fair lending laws and regulations in private class action litigation.

The FDIC’s restoration plan and the related increased assessment rate could adversely affect our earnings and results of operations.

As a result of economic conditions and the enactment of the Dodd-Frank Act, the FDIC revised its deposit insurance assessment methodology, which has had the effect of raising deposit premiums for many insured depository institutions. If these increases are insufficient for the DIF to meet its funding requirements, special assessments or increases in deposit insurance premiums may be required. We are generally unable to control the amount of premiums that we are required to pay for FDIC insurance. If there are additional financial institution failures that affect the DIF, we may be required to pay FDIC premiums higher than current levels. Our FDIC insurance related costs were $3.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2020 and $1.2 million for the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018. Any future additional assessments, increases or required prepayments in FDIC insurance premiums could adversely affect our earnings and results of operations.

We are subject to increased capital requirements, which may adversely impact return on equity or prevent us from paying dividends or repurchasing shares.

The Dodd-Frank Act requires the federal banking agencies to establish stricter risk-based and leverage capital requirements to apply to insured depository institutions and their holding companies. In 2013, the federal banking agencies adopted revised risk-based and leverage capital requirements as well as a revised method for calculating risk-weighted assets.

The revised capital rules subjected us to higher required capital levels on January 1, 2015, with the requirements fully phased in as of January 1, 2019. The application of more stringent capital requirements on us could, among other things, result in lower returns on equity, require the raising of additional capital, and result in regulatory actions such as the inability to pay dividends or repurchase shares if we were to be unable to comply with such requirements.

We have elected to use the CBLR framework available to certain banking organizations with less than $10 billion in lieu of the generally applicable capital requirements of the capital rules implementing Basel III. If we and the Bank no longer meet all requirements under this framework, we and the Bank each will be required to comply with risk-based capital requirements.


36



The Federal Reserve may require us to commit capital resources to support the Bank.

A bank holding company is required to act as a source of financial and managerial strength to its subsidiary banks and to commit resources to support its subsidiary banks. The Federal Reserve may require a bank holding company to make capital injections into a troubled subsidiary bank at times when the bank holding company may not be inclined to do so and may charge the bank holding company with engaging in unsafe and unsound practices for failing to commit resources to such a subsidiary bank. Accordingly, we could be required to provide financial assistance to the Bank if it experiences financial distress.

Such a capital injection may be required at a time when our resources are limited and we may be required to borrow the funds to make the required capital injection. In the event of a bank holding company’s bankruptcy, the bankruptcy trustee will assume any commitment by the holding company to a federal bank regulatory agency to maintain the capital of a subsidiary bank. Moreover, bankruptcy law provides that claims based on any such commitment will be entitled to a priority of payment over the claims of the holding company’s general unsecured creditors, including the holders of any note obligations.

We could be adversely affected by the soundness of other financial institutions.

Financial services institutions are interrelated as a result of trading, clearing, counterparty or other relationships. We have exposure to many different industries and counterparties, and routinely execute transactions with counterparties in the financial services industry, including commercial banks, brokers and dealers, investment banks and other institutional clients. Many of these transactions expose us to credit risk in the event of a default by a counterparty or client. In addition, our credit risk may be exacerbated when our collateral cannot be foreclosed upon or is liquidated at prices not sufficient to recover the full amount of the credit or derivative exposure due. Any such losses could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

Monetary policies and regulations of the Federal Reserve could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

In addition to being affected by general economic conditions, our earnings and growth are affected by the policies of the Federal Reserve. An important function of the Federal Reserve is to regulate the U.S. money supply and credit conditions. Among the instruments used by the Federal Reserve to implement these objectives are open market operations in U.S. government securities, adjustments of both the discount rate and the federal funds rate and changes in reserve requirements against bank deposits. These instruments are used in varying combinations to influence overall economic growth and the distribution of credit, bank loans, investments and deposits. Their use also affects interest rates charged on loans or paid on deposits.

The monetary policies and regulations of the Federal Reserve have had a significant effect on the operating results of commercial banks in the past and are expected to continue to do so in the future. Although we cannot determine the effects of such policies on us at this time, such policies could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

Risks Related to Our Common Stock

The market price of our common stock may fluctuate significantly.

The market price of our common stock could fluctuate significantly due to a number of factors, including, but not limited to:

our quarterly or annual earnings, or those of other companies in our industry;
actual or anticipated fluctuations in our operating results;
changes in accounting standards, policies, guidance, interpretations or principles;
the public reaction to our press releases, our other public announcements and our filings with the SEC;
announcements by us or our competitors of significant acquisitions, dispositions, innovations or new programs and services;
changes in financial estimates and recommendations by securities analysts that cover our common stock or the failure of securities analysts to cover our common stock;
changes in earnings estimates by securities analysts or our ability to meet those estimates;
the operating and stock price performance of other comparable companies;
general economic conditions and overall market fluctuations;
the trading volume of our common stock;
37



changes in business, legal or regulatory conditions, or other developments affecting participants in our industry, and publicity regarding our business or any of our significant customers or competitors;
changes in governmental monetary policies, including the policies of the Federal Reserve;
future sales of our common stock by us or our directors, executive officers or significant shareholders; and
changes in economic conditions in and political conditions affecting our target markets.

In particular, the realization of any of the risks described in this “Item 1A. Risk Factors” could have an adverse effect on the market price of our common stock and cause the value of your investment to decline. In addition, the stock market in general has experienced extreme volatility that has often been unrelated to the operating performance of particular companies. These broad market fluctuations may adversely affect the trading price of our common stock over the short, medium or long-term, regardless of our actual performance. If the market price of our common stock reaches an elevated level, it may materially and rapidly decline. In the past, following periods of volatility in the market price of a company’s securities, shareholders have often instituted securities class action litigation. If we were to be involved in a class action lawsuit, it could divert the attention of senior management and could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

If securities or industry analysts change their recommendations regarding our common stock or if our operating results do not meet their expectations, our stock price could decline.

The trading market for our common stock could be influenced by the research and reports that industry or securities analysts may publish about Veritex or our business. If one or more of these analysts cease coverage of us or fail to publish reports on us regularly, we could lose visibility in the financial markets, which in turn could cause our stock price or trading volume to decline. Moreover, if one or more of the analysts who cover us downgrade our stock or if our operating results do not meet their expectations, either absolutely or relative to our competitors, our stock price could decline significantly.

Future sales or the possibility of future sales of a substantial amount of our common stock may depress the price of the common stock.

Future sales or the availability for sale of substantial amounts of our common stock in the public market, or the perception that these sales could occur, could adversely affect the prevailing market price of our common stock and could impair our ability to raise capital through future sales of equity securities.

We may issue shares of our common stock or other securities from time to time as consideration for future acquisitions and investments and pursuant to compensation and incentive plans. If any such acquisition or investment is significant, the number of shares of our common stock, or the number or aggregate principal amount, as the case may be, of other securities that we may issue may in turn be substantial. We may also grant registration rights covering those shares of our common stock or other securities in connection with any such acquisitions and investments.

We cannot predict the size of future issuances of our common stock or the effect, if any, that future issuances and sales of its common stock will have on the market price of our common stock. Sales of substantial amounts of our common stock (including shares of our common stock issued in connection with an acquisition or under a compensation or incentive plan), or the perception that such sales could occur, may adversely affect prevailing market prices for our common stock and could impair our ability to raise capital through future sales of its securities.

The holders of our debt obligations will have priority over our common stock with respect to payment in the event of liquidation, dissolution or winding up of Veritex and with respect to the payment of interest and preferred dividends.

As of December 31, 2020, we had approximately $232.5 million outstanding in aggregate principal amount of subordinated notes held by investors, and, in the aggregate, $30.2 million of junior subordinated debentures issued to four statutory trusts that in turn issued $32.9 million in the aggregate of trust preferred securities. In the future, we may incur additional indebtedness. Upon our liquidation, dissolution or winding up, holders of our common stock will not be entitled to receive any payment or other distribution of assets until after all of our obligations to our debt holders have been satisfied and holders of trust preferred securities have received any payment or distribution due to them. In addition, we are required to pay interest on our outstanding indebtedness before we pay any dividends on our common stock. Since any decision to issue debt securities or incur other borrowings in the future will depend on market conditions and other factors beyond our control, the amount, timing, nature or success of our future capital raising efforts is uncertain. Thus, holders of our common stock bear the risk that our future issuances of debt securities or our incurrence of other borrowings will negatively affect the market price of our common stock.

38



We depend on the Bank for cash flow, and the Bank’s ability to make cash distributions is restricted, which could impact our ability to satisfy its obligations.

Our primary asset is the Bank. As such, we depend on cash flow through dividends from the Bank to pay our operating expenses and satisfy our obligations, including debt obligations. There are numerous laws and regulations that limit the Bank’s ability to pay dividends to Holdco. If the Bank is unable to pay dividends to Holdco, we will not be able to satisfy our obligations. These statutes and regulations require, among other things, that the Bank maintain certain levels of capital in order to pay a dividend. Further, federal and state banking authorities have the ability to restrict the Bank’s payment of dividends through supervisory action. See also “Item 1. Business—Regulation and Supervision—Regulatory Limits on Dividends and Distributions.”

Our dividend policy may change without notice, our future ability to pay dividends is subject to restrictions, and we may not pay dividends in the future.

In January 2019, we initiated a quarterly cash dividend on our common stock. Holders of our common stock are entitled to receive only such cash dividends as our board of directors may declare out of funds legally available for the payment of dividends. The timing, declaration, amount and payment of future cash dividends, if any, will be within the discretion of our board of directors and will depend upon then-existing conditions, including our results of operations, financial condition, capital requirements, investment opportunities, growth opportunities, any legal, regulatory, contractual or other limitations on our ability to pay dividends and other factors our board of directors may deem relevant. As a bank holding company, our ability to pay dividends is also affected by the policies and enforcement powers of the Federal Reserve and any future payment of dividends will depend on the Bank’s ability to make distributions and payments to Holdco, as these distributions and payments are our principal source of funds to pay dividends. The Bank is also subject to various legal, regulatory and other restrictions on its ability to make distributions and payments to Holdco. In addition, in the future, we may enter into borrowing or other contractual arrangements that restrict our ability to pay dividends. As a consequence of these various limitations and restrictions, we may not be able to make, or may have to reduce or eliminate, the payment of dividends on our common stock. Any change in the level of our dividends or the suspension of the payment thereof could have an adverse effect on the market price of our common stock. See also “Item 1. Business—Regulation and Supervision—Regulatory Limits on Dividends and Distributions.”

The requirements of being a public company, including compliance with the reporting requirements of the Exchange Act and the requirements of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act, may strain our resources, increase our costs and distract management.

We completed our initial public offering in October 2014. As a public company, we incur significant legal, accounting and other expenses that we did not incur as a private company. We also incur costs associated with our public company reporting requirements and with corporate governance requirements, including requirements under the Sarbanes-Oxley Act, stock exchange rules and the rules implemented by the SEC. These rules and regulations have increased our legal and financial compliance costs and make some activities more time-consuming and costly. These rules and regulations also make it more difficult and more expensive for us to obtain director and officer liability insurance. As a result, it may be more difficult for us to attract and retain qualified individuals to serve on our board of directors or as executive officers.

Shareholders may be deemed to be acting in concert or otherwise in control of us, which could impose notice, approval and ongoing regulatory requirements upon them and result in adverse regulatory consequences for such holders.

Veritex is a bank holding company regulated by the Federal Reserve. Banking laws impose notice, approval and ongoing regulatory requirements on any shareholder or other party that seeks to acquire direct or indirect “control” of an FDIC-insured depository institution or a company that controls an FDIC-insured depository institution, such as a bank holding company. These laws include the BHC Act and the Change in Bank Control Act and, for Texas chartered-banks such as the Bank, change of control requirements established by the Texas Finance Code. The determination as to whether an investor “controls” a depository institution or holding company is based on all of the facts and circumstances surrounding the investment.

As a general matter, a party is deemed to control a depository institution or other company if the party (1) owns or controls 25.0% or more of any class of voting stock of the bank or other company, (2) controls the election of a majority of the directors of the bank or other company, or (3) has the power to exercise a controlling influence over the management or policies of the bank or other company. In addition, subject to rebuttal, a party may be presumed to control a depository institution or other company if the investor owns or controls 10.0% or more of any class of voting stock. Ownership by affiliated parties, or parties acting in concert, is typically aggregated for these purposes. “Acting in concert” generally means knowing participation in a joint activity or parallel action towards the common goal of acquiring control of a bank or a parent company, whether or not pursuant to an express agreement. The manner in which this definition is applied in individual circumstances can vary and cannot always be predicted with certainty.
39




Any shareholder that is deemed to “control” us for regulatory purposes would become subject to notice, approval and ongoing regulatory requirements and may be subject to adverse regulatory consequences. Investors are responsible for ensuring that they do not, directly or indirectly, acquire shares of our stock in excess of the amount that can be acquired without regulatory approval under applicable law. These regulatory constraints on acquisition of our stock could inhibit transactions that would increase the price of our stock.

An investment in our common stock is not an insured deposit and is not guaranteed by the FDIC, so you could lose some or all of your investment.

An investment in our common stock is not a bank deposit and, therefore, is not insured against loss or guaranteed by the FDIC, any other deposit insurance fund or by any other public or private entity. An investment in our common stock is inherently risky for the reasons described herein. As a result, if you acquire our common stock, you could lose some or all of your investment.

ITEM 1B.  UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS
None.

ITEM 2.  PROPERTIES
At December 31, 2020, our executive offices were located at 8214 Westchester Drive, Suite 800, Dallas, Texas 75225. In addition to our executive offices, at December 31, 2020, we had 25 full-service branches and one mortgage office located in the Dallas-Fort Worth metroplex, 12 full-service branches in the Houston metropolitan area, and one branch in Louisville, Kentucky. We own the building in which our executive offices are located and lease the majority of the space in which our other administrative offices are located. As of December 31, 2020, we owned 19 of our branch locations and leased the remaining 20 branch and office locations. The remaining terms of our leases on our full-services branches range from one to seven years and give us the option to renew for subsequent terms of equal duration or otherwise extend the lease term subject to price adjustment based on market conditions at the time of renewal. We believe that our current facilities are adequate to meet our present and immediately foreseeable needs.
For more information about our bank premises and equipment and operating leases, please see Note 7 and Note 8 of our consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this report.

ITEM 3.  LEGAL PROCEEDINGS
We are from time to time subject to claims and litigation arising in the ordinary course of business. These claims and litigation may include, among other things, allegations of violation of banking and other applicable regulations, competition laws, labor laws and consumer protection laws, as well as claims or litigation relating to intellectual property, securities, breach of contract and tort. We intend to defend ourselves vigorously against any pending or future claims and litigation.
At this time, in the opinion of management, the likelihood is remote that the impact of such proceedings, either individually or in the aggregate, would have a material adverse effect on our consolidated results of operations, financial condition or cash flows. However, one or more unfavorable outcomes in any claim or litigation against us could have a material adverse effect for the period in which they are resolved. In addition, regardless of their merits or their ultimate outcomes, such matters are costly, divert management’s attention and may materially adversely affect our reputation, even if resolved in our favor.

ITEM 4.  MINE AND SAFETY DISCLOSURES
Not applicable.
PART II

40



ITEM 5.  MARKET FOR REGISTRANT’S COMMON EQUITY, RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS AND ISSUER PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES
Market Information for Common Stock
Shares of our common stock are traded on the Nasdaq Global Market under the symbol “VBTX”. Our shares have been traded on the Nasdaq Global Market since October 9, 2014. Prior to that date, there was no public trading market for our common stock.
Holders of Record
As of February 25, 2021, there were 49,423,873 holders of record of our common stock.
Dividend Policy
On January 26, 2021, Veritex Holdings, Inc. announced that its Board of Directors declared a quarterly cash dividend of $0.17 per share on our outstanding common stock. The dividend was paid on February 18, 2021 to shareholders of record as of February 4, 2021. For the year ended December 31, 2020, we declared and paid $34.1 million in cash dividends.
The timing, declaration, amount and payment of any future cash dividends are at the discretion of our board of directors and will depend on many factors, including our results of operations, financial condition, capital requirements, investment opportunities, growth opportunities, any legal, regulatory, contractual or other limitations on our ability to pay dividends and other factors our board of directors may deem relevant. In addition, there are regulatory restrictions on our ability and the ability of the Bank to pay dividends. See “Item 1A. Risk Factors—Our dividend policy may change without notice, our future ability to pay dividends is subject to restrictions, and we may not pay dividends in the future” and “Item 1. Business—Regulation and Supervision—Regulatory Limits on Dividends and Distributions.”
Unregistered Sales of Equity Securities
None.

Equity Compensation Plan Information
See “Item 12. Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters”. The information regarding the securities authorized for issuance under equity compensation plans called for by this item is set forth in our 2021 Proxy Statement, and is incorporated herein by reference.
41



Stock Performance Graph
The following table and graph compares the cumulative total shareholder return on our common stock to the cumulative total return of our peer group and the Nasdaq Bank Index for the period beginning on October 9, 2014, the first day of trading of our common stock on the Nasdaq Global Market through December 31, 2020. The following information reflects index values as of close of trading, assumes $100 invested on October 9, 2014 in our common stock, the peer group and the Nasdaq Bank Index, and assumes the reinvestment of dividends, if any. The historical stock price performance for our common stock shown below is not necessarily indicative of future stock performance.
 October 9, 2014December 31, 2016December 31, 2017December 31, 2018December 31, 2019December 31, 2020
Veritex Holdings, Inc.$100.00 $191.47 $197.79 $153.26 $208.82 $183.94 
Peer Group(1)
100.00 173.83 171.13 138.20 152.67 144.32 
Nasdaq Bank Index100.00 158.44 164.00 134.64 163.23 145.84 
(1) Our peer group includes Allegiance Bancshares, Inc., Bancfirst Corporation, Cadence Bancorp LLC, CBTX, Inc., CVB Financial Corp., Eagle Bancorp, Inc., First Financial Bankshares, Inc., Origin Bancorp, Inc., Hilltop Holdings, Inc., Independent Bank Group, Inc.., Servisfirst Bancshares, Inc., Simmons First National Corporation, Southside Bancshares, Inc. Pacific Premier Bancorp, Inc and Independent Bank Corporation.

Comparison of Cumulative Total Return
vbtx-20201231_g1.gif
Stock Repurchases
On January 28, 2019, our board of directors authorized a stock buyback program pursuant to which we may, from time to time, purchase up to $50.0 million of our outstanding common stock (the “Stock Buyback Program”). Our board of directors authorized increases of $50.0 million in September 2019 and $75.0 million in December 2019, resulting in an aggregate authorization to purchase of up to $175.0 million of our common stock. Our board of directors also authorized an extension of the original expiration date from December 31, 2019 to December 31, 2020 and then to March 31, 2021. The shares may be repurchased in the open market or in privately negotiated transactions from time to time, depending upon market conditions and other factors, and in accordance with applicable regulations of the SEC. The Stock Buyback Program does not obligate the Company to purchase any shares. The Stock Buyback Program may be terminated or amended by the board of directors at any time prior to its expiration. During the fourth quarter of 2020, the Company repurchased the following shares of its common stock:
42



(a)(b)(c)(d)
PeriodTotal number of shares purchasedAverage price paid per shareTotal number of shares purchased as part of publicly announced plans or programsApproximate dollar value of shares that may yet be purchased under the plans or programs
October 1, 2020 - October 31, 2020— $— — 30,850,066 
November 1, 2020 - November 30, 2020100,883 19.83 100,883 28,849,913 
December 1, 2020 - December 31, 2020246,545 24.20 246,545 22,884,679 
6,152,350 $24.51 6,152,350 22,884,679 

43



ITEM 6.  SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA
 As of and For the Years Ended December 31,
 20202019201820172016
 (Dollars in thousands, except per share data)
Selected Period-end Balance Sheet Data:                    
Total assets$8,820,871 $7,954,937 $3,208,550 $2,945,583 $1,408,507 
Cash and cash equivalents230,825 251,550 84,449 149,044 234,791 
Debt securities1,055,201 997,330 262,695 228,117 102,559 
Total loans(1)
6,427,924 5,921,071 2,555,509 2,233,518 991,897 
Allowance for credit losses105,084 29,834 19,255 12,808 8,524 
Goodwill370,840 370,840 161,447 159,452 26,865 
Intangibles61,733 72,263 15,896 20,441 2,181 
Noninterest-bearing deposits2,097,099 1,556,500 626,283 612,830 327,614 
Interest-bearing deposits2,958,456 2,654,972 1,996,145 1,665,800 792,016 
Total deposits6,512,846 5,894,350 2,622,428 2,278,630 1,119,630 
Advances from FHLB777,718 677,870 28,019 71,164 38,306 
Other borrowings262,778 145,571 16,691 31,689 8,035 
Total stockholders’ equity1,203,376 1,190,797 530,638 488,929 239,088 
Selected Income Statement Data:     
Net interest income$265,798 $285,097 $114,189 $68,508 $40,955 
Provision for credit losses and unfunded commitments65,669 21,514 6,603 5,114 2,050 
Net interest income after provision for credit losses200,129 263,583 107,586 63,394 38,905 
Noninterest income47,344 30,080 11,910 7,576 6,503 
Noninterest expense159,387 177,803 69,259 42,789 26,390 
Income before income tax88,086 115,860 50,237 28,181 19,018 
Income tax expense14,203 25,121 10,896 13,029 6,467 
Net income73,883 90,739 39,341 15,152 12,551 
Preferred dividends— — — 42 — 
Net income available to common stockholders$73,883 $90,739 $39,341 $15,110 $12,551 
Share Data:     
Basic earnings per common share$1.48 $1.71 $1.63 $0.82 $1.16 
Diluted earnings per common share1.48 1.68 1.60 0.80 1.13 
Book value per common share24.39 23.32 21.88 20.28 15.73 
Tangible book value per common share(2)
15.70 14.73 12.75 12.75 13.82 
Basic weighted average common shares outstanding49,884 53,154 24,169 18,404 10,849 
Diluted weighted average common shares outstanding50,036 53,978 24,590 18,810 11,058 
Performance Ratios:     
Return on average assets(3)
0.87 %1.14 %1.26 %0.76 %0.76 %
Return on average equity(3)
6.34 7.57 7.73 4.54 4.54 
Net interest margin(4)
3.39 3.97 4.09 3.77 3.77 
Efficiency ratio(5)
50.90 56.41 54.92 56.24 56.24 
Loans to deposits ratio104.2 100.5 97.4 98.0 98.0 
Loans to deposits ratio, excluding MW89.8 97.3 97.5 98.0 98.0 
Summary Credit Quality Ratios:     
Nonperforming assets to total assets0.99 %0.50 %0.77 %0.03 %0.17 %
Nonperforming loans to total loans1.46 0.56 0.97 0.02 0.18 
Allowance for credit losses to nonperforming loans123.19 89.22 77.81 2,651.76 479.95 
Allowance for credit losses to total loans, excluding MW and PPP1.80 0.52 0.75 0.57 0.86 
Net charge-offs to average loans outstanding0.36 0.19 0.01 0.06 0.03 
Capital Ratios:     
Total stockholders’ equity to total assets13.64 %14.97 %16.54 %16.60 %16.97 %
Tangible common equity to tangible assets(6)
9.23 10.01 11.66 11.12 15.23 
Tier 1 capital to average assets(3)
9.43 10.17 12.04 12.92 16.82 
Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets9.66 11.02 12.18 12.48 20.72 
Common equity tier 1 (to risk-weighted assets)9.30 10.60 11.8 12.03 20.42 
Total capital to risk-weighted assets13.57 13.10 12.98 13.16 22.02 
 
44



(1)Total loans does not include loans held for sale and deferred fees. Loans held for sale were $21.4 million as of December 31, 2020, $14.1 million as of December 31, 2019,  $1.3 million as of December 31, 2018, $0.8 million as of December 31, 2017 and $5.2 million as of December 31, 2016. Deferred fees were $2.5 million as of December 31, 2020, $134 thousand as of December 31, 2019, $15 thousand as of December 31, 2018, $28 thousand as of December 31, 2017 and $55 thousand as of December 31, 2016. Total loans also excludes $358.0 million of PPP loans held for investment.
(2)We calculate tangible book value per common share as total stockholders’ equity less goodwill and core deposit intangibles, net of accumulated amortization, divided by the number of common shares outstanding at the end of the relevant period. Tangible book value per common share is a non-GAAP financial measure and the most directly comparable financial measure calculated in accordance with GAAP is book value per common share. See our reconciliation of non-GAAP financial measures to their most directly comparable GAAP financial measures in “Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Non-GAAP Financial Measures.”
(3)Except as otherwise indicated in this footnote, we calculate our average assets and average equity for a period by dividing the sum of our total assets or total stockholders’ equity, as the case may be, as of the close of business on each day in the relevant period, by the number of days in the period. We have calculated our return on average assets and return on average equity for a period by dividing net income for that period by our average assets and average equity, as the case may be, for that period.
(4)Net interest margin represents net interest income, annualized, divided by average interest-earning assets.
(5)Efficiency ratio represents noninterest expense divided by the sum of net interest income and noninterest income.
(6)We calculate tangible common equity as total stockholders’ equity less goodwill and core deposit intangibles, net of accumulated amortization, and we calculate tangible assets as total assets less goodwill and core deposit intangibles, net of accumulated amortization. We calculate tangible common equity to tangible assets as tangible common equity divided by tangible assets. Tangible common equity to tangible assets is a non-GAAP financial measure and the most directly comparable financial measure calculated in accordance with GAAP is total stockholders’ equity to total assets. See our reconciliation of non-GAAP financial measures to their most directly comparable GAAP financial measures in “Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Non-GAAP Financial Measures.”
45




ITEM 7.  MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS.
Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations
The following discussion and analysis of our financial condition and results of operations should be read in conjunction with “Item 6. Selected Financial Data” and our consolidated financial statements and the accompanying notes included Item 8 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K. This discussion and analysis contains forward-looking statements that are subject to certain risks and uncertainties and are based on certain assumptions that we believe are reasonable but may prove to be inaccurate. Certain risks, uncertainties and other factors, including those set forth in “Item 1A. Risk Factors” and elsewhere in this Annual Report on Form 10-K, may cause actual results to differ materially from those projected results discussed in the forward-looking statements appearing in this discussion and analysis. We assume no obligation to update any of these forward-looking statements.
Overview
We are a Texas state banking organization with corporate offices in Dallas, Texas. Through our wholly owned subsidiary, Veritex Community Bank, a Texas state chartered bank, we provide relationship-driven commercial banking products and services tailored to meet the needs of small to medium-sized businesses and professionals. Beginning at our inception in 2010, we initially targeted customers and focused our acquisitions primarily in the Dallas metropolitan area, which we consider to be Dallas and the adjacent communities in North Dallas. Our current primary market includes the broader Dallas-Fort Worth metroplex and the Houston metropolitan area. As we continue to grow, we may expand to other metropolitan banking markets in Texas.
Our business is conducted through one reportable segment, community banking, which generates the majority of our revenues from interest income on loans, customer service and loan fees, gains on sale of government guaranteed loans and mortgage loans and interest income from securities. We incur interest expense on deposits and other borrowed funds and noninterest expense, such as salaries and employee benefits and occupancy expenses. We analyze our ability to maximize income generated from interest earning assets and interest expense of our interest-bearing liabilities through net interest margin. Net interest margin is a ratio calculated as net interest income divided by average interest earning assets. Net interest income is the difference between interest income on interest-earning assets, such as loans and securities, and interest expense on interest-bearing liabilities, such as deposits and borrowings, which are used to fund those assets.
Changes in the market interest rates and interest rates we earn on interest-earning assets and pay on interest-bearing liabilities, as well as the volume and types of interest-earning assets, and interest-bearing and noninterest-bearing liabilities, are usually the largest drivers of periodic changes in net interest spread, net interest margin and net interest income. Fluctuations in market interest rates are driven by many factors, including governmental monetary policies, inflation, deflation, macroeconomic developments, changes in unemployment, the money supply, political and international conditions and conditions in domestic and foreign financial markets. Periodic changes in the volume and types of loans in our loan portfolio are affected by, among other factors, economic and competitive conditions in Texas and, specifically, in the Dallas-Fort Worth metroplex and Houston metropolitan area, as well as developments affecting the real estate, technology, financial services, insurance, transportation, manufacturing and energy sectors within our target market and throughout the state of Texas.

Recent Developments

Impact of COVID-19

The COVID-19 pandemic has created a global public health crisis that has resulted in unprecedented uncertainty, volatility and disruption in financial markets and in governmental, commercial and consumer activity in the United States and globally, including the markets that we serve. Governmental responses to the pandemic have included orders closing businesses not deemed essential and directing individuals to observe social distancing and shelter in place. These actions, together with responses to the pandemic by businesses and individuals, have resulted in rapid decreases in commercial and consumer activity, temporary closures of many businesses that have led to a loss of revenues and a rapid increase in unemployment, material decreases in business valuations, disrupted global supply chains, market downturns and volatility, changes in consumer behavior related to pandemic fears, related emergency response legislation and an expectation that the policy of the Federal Reserve will maintain a low interest rate environment for the foreseeable future. Possible additional waves of COVID-19 and the uncertainty of the timing of a widely-available vaccine may adversely affect the re-opening process.

46



We have taken deliberate actions to ensure that we have the balance sheet strength to serve our clients and communities during the COVID-19 pandemic, including increasing our liquidity and reserves supported by a strong capital position. Our commercial and consumer customers are experiencing varying degrees of financial distress due to the pandemic and related governmental actions taken in response to the pandemic. In order to protect the health of our customers and employees, and to comply with applicable governmental directives, we have implemented our operational response and preparedness plan, which includes, among other things, dispersion of critical operation processes, increased monitoring focused on higher risk operations, enhanced remote access security and further restricted internet access, enhanced security around wire transfer execution and flexible scheduling provided to employees who are unable to work from home.

On March 27, 2020, the CARES Act was enacted. The CARES Act contains substantial tax and spending provisions intended to address the impact of the COVID-19 pandemic, including the SBA PPP, a loan program administered by the SBA. Under the PPP, small businesses, sole proprietorships, independent contractors and self-employed individuals may apply for forgivable loans from existing SBA lenders and other approved regulated lenders that enroll in the program, subject to numerous limitations and eligibility criteria. Congress appropriated an additional $310 billion for PPP commitments on April 24, 2020, and amended the PPP on June 5, 2020 to make the terms of the PPP loans and loan forgiveness more flexible. The Consolidated Appropriations Act, 2021, provided additional funding for the PPP of approximately $284.0 billion and allows eligible borrowers, including certain borrowers who already received a PPP loan, to apply for PPP loans through March 31, 2021. Additionally, in the Consolidated Appropriations Act, 2021, Congress appropriated $25.0 billion for existing PPP borrowers to obtain a second round of PPP funding. The SBA began accepting applications for these "second draw" PPP loans on January 13, 2021.Beginning in early April 2020, we began processing loan applications under the PPP, and in January 2021 we began processing applications under this latest round of the SBA’s PPP. The Company believes that the majority of these loans will ultimately be forgiven by the SBA in accordance with the terms of the program. If a loan is fully forgiven, SBA will repay the lending bank in full. If a loan is partially forgiven or not forgiven at all, a bank must look to the borrower for repayment of unforgiven principal and interest. If the borrower defaults, the loan is guaranteed by SBA. In order to obtain loan forgiveness, a PPP borrower must submit a forgiveness application to us, which we must review and forward to the SBA. The SBA began approving forgiveness applications on October 2, 2020. As of December 31, 2020, we had funded approvals for approximately 2,114 clients totaling approximately $358.0 million in PPP loans carried at fair value.

In response to the COVID-19 pandemic, we have also implemented a loan deferment program to provide temporary payment relief to certain of our borrowers who meet the program's qualifications. This program allows for a deferral of principal and/or interest payments for 90 days (“Round 1 Deferments”), which we may extend for an additional 90 days (“Round 2 Deferments”), for a maximum of 180 days on a cumulative basis. The deferred payments along with interest accrued during the deferral period are due and payable on the maturity date of the existing loan. The CARES Act, as amended by the Consolidated Appropriations Act, 2021, specified that COVID-19 related loan modifications executed between March 1, 2020 and the earlier of (i) 60 days after the date of termination of the national emergency declared by the President and (ii) January 1, 2022, on loans that were current as of December 31, 2019 are not TDRs. Additionally, under guidance from the federal banking agencies, other short-term modifications made on a good faith basis in response to the COVID-19 pandemic to borrowers that were current prior to any relief are not TDRs under ASC Subtopic 310-40, “Troubled Debt Restructuring by Creditors.” These modifications include short-term (e.g., up to six months) modifications such as payment deferrals, fee waivers, extensions of repayment terms, or delays in payment that are insignificant. For the year ended December 31, 2020, the Company had 754 modifications of loans with aggregate principal balances $1.1 billion that qualified for temporary suspension of TDR requirements under Section 4013 of the CARES Act, as amended by the Consolidated Appropriations Act, 2021, and the interagency guidance. As of February 18, 2021, we had $26.1 million in loans with remaining deferments.

Significant uncertainties as to future economic conditions exist, and we have taken deliberate actions in response to these uncertainties, including increased levels of on balance sheet liquidity and increased capital ratio levels. Additionally, the economic pressures, coupled with our implementation in January 2020 of the current expected credit loss (“CECL”) methodology for determining our provision for credit losses, have contributed to an increased provision for credit losses for the year ended December 31, 2020 compared to the same period in 2019. We continue to monitor the impact of COVID-19 closely, as well as any effects that may result from the CARES Act; however, the extent to which the COVID-19 pandemic will impact our operations and financial results during 2021 is highly uncertain.
47




Financial position and results of operations

The COVID-19 pandemic had a material impact on our allowance for credit losses during 2020. Given that forecasted economic scenarios have deteriorated significantly since the pandemic was declared in early March of 2020, our need for additional reserve for credit loss increased significantly. Refer to our further discussion of the allowance for credit losses below as well as in Note 1, “Summary of Significant Accounting Policies,” and Note 6, “Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses,” in the accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements. Should economic conditions worsen, we could experience further increases in our allowance for credit losses and record additional credit loss expense. We could also see an increase in our ratio of past due loans to total loans, although the execution of our loan deferment program might temporarily improve this ratio. It is possible that our asset quality measures could worsen at future measurement periods if the effects of the COVID-19 pandemic are further prolonged.

Our fee income could be reduced due to the COVID-19 pandemic. In keeping with guidance from regulators, we are working with customers affected by the COVID-19 pandemic to waive fees from a variety of sources, including, but not limited to, insufficient funds and overdraft fees, ATM fees and account maintenance fees. These reductions in fees are thought, at this time, to be temporary in conjunction with the length of the expected economic crisis related to the COVID-19 pandemic. At this time, we are unable to project the materiality of such an impact, but recognize the breadth of the economic impact is likely to impact our fee income in future periods.

Our interest income could also be reduced due to the COVID-19 pandemic. In keeping with guidance from regulators, we are actively working with borrowers affected by the COVID-19 pandemic to defer their payments, interest, and fees. While interest and fees will still accrue to income, should eventual credit losses on these deferred payments emerge, our interest income and fees accrued would need to be reversed. In such a scenario, interest income in future periods could be negatively impacted. At this time, we are unable to project the materiality of such an impact, but recognize the breadth of the economic impact may affect our borrowers’ ability to repay in future periods.

Capital and liquidity

As of December 31, 2020, all of our and the Bank's capital ratios were in excess of all regulatory requirements. While we believe that we have sufficient capital to withstand an extended economic recession brought about by the COVID-19 pandemic, our reported and regulatory capital ratios could be adversely impacted by further credit losses. We rely on cash on hand as well as dividends from the Bank to service our debt. If our capital deteriorates such that the Bank is unable to pay dividends to us for an extended period of time, we may not be able to service our debt.

We maintain access to multiple sources of liquidity, including the Paycheck Protection Program Liquidity Facility (“PPPLF”) which is a lending facility offered by the Federal Reserve to extend credit to financial institutions that originate PPP loans, while taking the PPP loans as collateral. As of December 31, 2020, we have not utilized the PPPLF. Wholesale funding markets have remained open to us with stable and low rates for short term funding. If funding costs are elevated for an extended period of time, it could have an adverse effect on our net interest margin. If an economic recession caused large numbers of our deposit customers to withdraw their funds, we might become more reliant on volatile or more expensive sources of funding.

Asset valuation

Currently, we do not expect the COVID-19 pandemic to affect our ability to account timely for the assets on our balance sheet; however, this could change in future periods. While certain valuation assumptions and judgments will change to account for pandemic-related circumstances such as widening credit spreads, we do not anticipate significant changes in methodology used to determine the fair value of assets measured in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles in the United States (“GAAP”).
48




Credit

The following loan portfolios represent our material at-risk portfolios identified by management impacted by the COVID-19 pandemic as of December 31, 2020:

Hospitality Exposure

The Company’s exposure to hospitality at December 31, 2020 was $369.6 million, or 6.3% of total loans held for investment, excluding MW and PPP loans. The weighted average loan to value for this portfolio was 60.0% at origination date.

Retail Commercial Real Estate (“CRE”) Exposure

The Company’s exposure to retail CRE at December 31, 2020 was $533.9 million, or 9.1% of total loans held for investment, excluding MW and PPP loans. The weighted average loan to value for this portfolio was 58.0% at origination date.

Restaurant Exposure

The Company’s exposure to restaurants at December 31, 2020 was $122.8 million, or 2.1% of total loans held for investment, excluding MW and PPP loans. 61% of the Company’s restaurant borrowers are quick service restaurants and 39% are full service restaurants. A total of 80% of the portfolio is secured by real estate assets with an average loan to value of 60.0% at origination date.

Adoption of New Accounting Standard for Allowance for Credit Losses

On January 1, 2020, the Company adopted Accounting Standards Update 2016-13, Financial Instruments - Credit Losses (Topic 326): Measurement of Credit Losses on Financial Instruments (“ASU 2016-13”), which replaces the incurred loss methodology with an expected loss methodology that is referred to as CECL. The measurement of expected credit losses under the CECL methodology is applicable to financial assets measured at amortized cost, including loan receivables and held-to-maturity debt securities. It also applies to off-balance sheet (“OBS”) credit exposures not accounted for as insurance (loan commitments, standby letters of credit, financial guarantees, and other similar instruments) and net investments in leases recognized by a lessor. In addition, ASU 2016-13 made changes to the accounting for available-for-sale debt securities. One such change is to require credit losses to be presented as an allowance rather than as a write-down on available-for-sale debt securities management does not intend to sell or believes that it is more likely than not they will be required to sell.

A summary of the impact of the adoption of ASU 2016-13 on our financial statements is as follows:

Net decrease in retained earnings of $15.5 million as of January 1, 2020 for the cumulative effect of adopting ASC 326.

On January 1, 2020, the amortized cost basis of assets purchased with credit deterioration were adjusted to reflect the addition of $19.7 million to the allowance for credit losses. The remaining noncredit discount (based on the adjusted amortized cost basis) will be accreted into interest income at the effective interest rate as of January 1, 2020.

Increase in the allowance for credit losses of $39.1 million as of January 1, 2020.

Increase in our allowance for credit losses on unfunded commitments of $840 thousand as of January 1, 2020. The allowance for credit losses on unfunded commitments is recorded in accounts payable and other liabilities in the condensed consolidated balance sheets.
49




Anticipated 2021 Trends

This discussion of trends expected to impact our business in 2021 is based on information presently available and reflects certain assumptions, including the current economic and interest rate environment. Differences in actual economic conditions compared with our assumptions could have an adverse impact on our results. See “Special Cautionary Notice Regarding Forward-Looking Statements” and Part I, Item 1A, “Risk Factors” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K for additional factors that could cause results to differ materially from those contemplated by the following forward-looking statements. We anticipate the following trends or events related to our business in fiscal year 2021:

Continued return of capital through quarterly dividends and share repurchases.
Continued emphasis on credit quality and relationship banking.
Continued focus on net interest margin and the impact of interest rates on loans and deposit repricing
Continued leverage of our strong capital through accretive organic growth and possible strategic acquisition opportunities.
Expected improvement in economic forecasts, specifically Texas unemployment and year over year Texas GDP growth, which are significant inputs into our CECL model driving the allowance for credit loss.
Potential branch restructures, consolidations or closures to continue with our branch-light business model.
Results of Operations for the Fiscal Years Ended December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019
General
Net income available to common stockholders for the year ended December 31, 2020 was $73.9 million, a decrease of $16.9 million, or 18.6%, from net income available to common stockholders of $90.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2019.
Basic earnings per share (“EPS”) for the year ended December 31, 2020 was $1.48, a decrease of $0.23 from $1.71 for the year ended December 31, 2019. Diluted earnings per share for the year ended December 31, 2020 was $1.48, a decrease of $0.20 from $1.68 for the year ended December 31, 2019.
Net Interest Income
Our operating results depend primarily on our net interest income, calculated as the difference between interest income on interest-earning assets, such as loans and securities, and interest expense on interest-bearing liabilities, such as deposits and borrowings. Fluctuations in market interest rates impact the yield and rates paid on interest sensitive assets and liabilities. Changes in the amount and type of interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities also impact net interest income. The variance driven by the changes in the amount and mix of interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities is referred to as a “volume change.” Changes in yields earned on interest-earning assets and rates paid on interest-bearing deposits and other borrowed funds are referred to as “rate changes.”
To evaluate net interest income, we measure and monitor (1) yields on our loans and other interest-earning assets, (2) the costs of our deposits and other funding sources, (3) our net interest spread and (4) our net interest margin. Net interest spread is the difference between rates earned on interest-earning assets and rates paid on interest-bearing liabilities. Net interest margin is a ratio calculated as net interest income divided by average interest-earning assets. Because noninterest-bearing sources of funds, such as noninterest-bearing deposits and stockholders’ equity, also fund interest-earning assets, net interest margin includes the benefit of these noninterest-bearing sources.
For the year ended December 31, 2020, net interest income totaled $265.8 million compared to net interest income of $285.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2019, a decrease of $19.3 million, or 6.8%. This decrease was due to a $56.9 million, or 15.0%, decrease in interest income offset by a $37.6 million decrease in interest expense. Interest income was $321.9 million, compared to $378.8 million for the years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively. The primary drivers of decreased interest income was a $54.2 million decrease in interest income on loans held for investment, including MW and PPP. Interest earned on average loans outstanding for the year ended December 31, 2020 decreased $54.2 million, or 15.9%. The decline in interest earned on average loans was the result of a decrease in yields earned on loan balances. Average loan balances, excluding PPP loans, grew from $5.9 billion for the year ended December 31, 2019 to $6.1 billion for the year ended December 31, 2020, an increase of $204.5 million, or 3.5%. In the Consolidated Appropriations Act, 2021, Congress appropriated $25.0 billion for existing PPP borrowers to obtain a second round of PPP funding. The SBA began accepting applications for these "second draw" PPP loans on January 13, 2021.
50



Interest expense for the year ended December 31, 2020 was $56.1 million, compared to $93.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2019, a decrease of $37.6 million, or 40.2%. The year-over-year decrease was due to decreases in the averages rates paid on interest-bearing demand and savings deposits and certificates and other time deposits and a change in deposit mix.
Net interest margin and net interest spread were 3.39% and 3.08%, respectively, for the year ended December 31, 2020 compared to 3.97% and 3.48%, respectively, for the year ended December 31, 2019. The decrease in net interest margin by 58 basis points and decrease in net interest spread by 40 basis points were due to a decrease in the average yield earned on interest-bearing assets by 117 basis points, offset by a decrease in the average yield paid on interest-bearing liabilities by 77 basis points. The average interest earned on interest-bearing assets decreased to 4.10% during the year ended December 31, 2020 from 5.27% for the year ended December 31, 2019 primarily due to a decrease in yields earned on loan balances. The average interest paid on interest-bearing liabilities decreased to 1.02% during the year ended December 31, 2020 from 1.79% for the year ended December 31, 2019.
The following table presents, for the periods indicated, an analysis of net interest income by each major category of interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities, the average amounts outstanding and the interest earned or paid on such amounts. The table also sets forth the average rate earned on interest-earning assets, the average rate paid on interest-bearing liabilities, and the net interest margin on average total interest-earning assets for the same periods. Interest earned on loans that are classified as nonaccrual is not recognized in income; however, the balances are reflected in average outstanding balances for the period. For the year ended December 31, 2020 and 2019, interest income not recognized on nonaccrual loans, excluding purchased credit deteriorated (“PCD”) loans, was $3.4 million and $1.7 million, respectively. Any nonaccrual loans have been included in the table as loans carrying a zero yield.

51



 For the Year Ended December 31,
 20202019
Average
Outstanding
Balance
Interest
Earned/
Interest
Paid
Average
Yield/
Rate
Average
Outstanding
Balance
Interest
Earned/
Interest
Paid
Average
Yield/
Rate
(Dollars in thousands)
Assets      
Interest-earning assets:      
Loans(1)
$5,770,228 $273,999 4.75 %$5,722,039 $334,025 5.84 %
Loans held for investment, MW318,657 9,672 3.04 162,325 6,788 4.18 
PPP Loans290,851 2,912 1.00 — — — 
Debt securities1,083,633 30,726 2.84 977,621 29,484 3.02 
Interest-earning deposits in other banks276,970 1,221 0.44 259,866 5,540 2.13 
Equity securities and other investments100,556 3,320 3.30 60,308 2,949 4.89 
Total interest-earning assets7,840,895 321,850 4.10 7,182,159 378,786 5.27 
Allowance for credit losses(98,527)(23,533)
Noninterest-earning assets782,907 799,257 
Total assets$8,525,275 $7,957,883 
Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity
Interest-bearing liabilities:
Interest-bearing demand and savings deposits$2,726,462 13,233 0.49 $2,648,113 40,355 1.52 
Certificates and other time deposits1,550,995 23,678 1.53 1,997,090 38,675 1.94 
Advances from FHLB1,024,142 10,609 1.04 502,681 9,984 1.99 
Subordinated debentures and subordinated notes172,594 8,532 4.94 86,110 4,675 5.43 
Total interest-bearing liabilities5,474,193 56,052 1.02 5,233,994 93,689 1.79 
Noninterest-bearing liabilities:
Noninterest-bearing deposits1,825,806 1,480,207 
Other liabilities60,303 44,809 
Total noninterest-bearing liabilities7,360,302 6,759,010 
Stockholders’ equity1,164,973 1,198,873 
Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity$8,525,275 $7,957,883 
Net interest spread(2)
3.08 %3.48 %
Net interest income$265,798 $285,097 
Net interest margin(3)
3.39 %3.97 %

(1) Includes average outstanding balances of loans held for sale of $15,315 and $8,762 for the twelve months ended December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively.
(2) Net interest rate spread is the average yield on interest-earning assets minus the average rate on interest-bearing liabilities.
(3) Net interest margin is equal to net interest income divided by average interest-earning assets.


52



The following table presents the changes in interest income and interest expense for the periods indicated for each major component of interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities and distinguishes between the changes attributable to changes in volume and changes attributable to changes in interest rates. For purposes of this table, changes attributable to both rate and volume that cannot be segregated have been allocated to rate.
 For the Year Ended December 31, 2020
 Compared to 2019
 Increase (Decrease) Due To Change in 
 VolumeRateTotal
 (Dollars in thousands)
Interest-earning assets:            
Loans$2,289 $(62,315)$(60,026)
Loans held for investment, MW4,752 (1,868)2,884 
PPP loans2,912 — 2,912 
Debt securities3,011 (1,769)1,242 
Interest-earning deposits in other banks75 (4,394)(4,319)
Equity securities and other investments1,328 (957)371 
Total increase (decrease) in interest income$14,367 $(71,303)$(56,936)
Interest-bearing liabilities:   
Interest-bearing demand and savings deposits$384 $(27,506)$(27,122)
Certificates and other time deposits(6,825)(8,172)(14,997)
Advances from FHLB5,423 (4,798)625 
Subordinated debentures and subordinated notes4,272 (415)3,857 
Total increase (decrease) in interest expense3,254 (40,891)(37,637)
Increase (decrease) in net interest income$11,113 $(30,412)$(19,299)
Provision for Credit Losses
Our provision for credit losses is a charge to income in order to bring our allowance for credit losses to a level deemed appropriate by management. For a description of the factors taken into account by management in determining the allowance for credit losses see “—Financial Condition—Allowance for Credit Losses on Loans Held for Investment.” The provision for credit losses was $56.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2020, compared to $21.5 million for the same period in 2019, an increase of $35.1 million, or 163.3%. The increase in provision expense was primarily attributable to changes in the Texas economic forecasts used in the CECL model during the year ended December 31, 2020 to reflect the expected impact of the COVID-19 pandemic. For the year ended December 31, 2020, we also recorded a $9.0 million provision for credit losses on unfunded commitments, which was attributable to an increase in unfunded balances and the change in the economic forecasts as a result of the COVID-19 pandemic. Allowance for credit losses as a percentage of loans held for investments, excluding MW and PPP loans, was 1.80% and 0.52% at December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively.
Noninterest Income
Our primary sources of recurring noninterest income are service charges and fees on deposit accounts, loan fees, gain (loss) on the sale of investment securities, gains on the sale of mortgage loans, government guaranteed loan income, net and other income. Noninterest income does not include loan origination fees, which are generally recognized over the life of the related loan as an adjustment to yield using the interest method.
53



The following table presents, for the periods indicated, the major categories of noninterest income:
 For the Year Ended 
 December 31,Increase
 20202019(Decrease)
 (Dollars in thousands)
Noninterest income:            
Service charges and fees on deposit accounts$13,703 $14,334 $(631)
Loan fees4,556 7,782 (3,226)
Gain (loss) on sales of securities2,615 (1,852)4,467 
Gain on sales of mortgage loans1,239 475 764 
Government guaranteed loan income, net14,150 4,709 9,441 
Rental income2,179 2,172 
Other8,902 2,460 6,442 
Total noninterest income$47,344 $30,080 $17,264 
Noninterest income for the year ended December 31, 2020 increased $17.2 million, or 57.4%, to $47.3 million compared to noninterest income of $30.1 million for the same period in 2019. The primary components of the increase were as follows:
Service charges and fees on deposit accounts. We earn service charges and fees from our customers for deposit-related activities. The income from these deposit activities constitutes a significant and predictable component of our noninterest income. Service charges and fees on deposit accounts were $13.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2020, a decrease of $631.0 thousand, or 4.4%, over the same period in 2019. This decrease was primarily due a decrease in certain specialty finance lending relationships with corresponding deposit accounts, resulting in lower service charges for the year ended December 31, 2020 compared to 2019.
Loan fees. We earn certain loan fees in connection with funding and servicing loans. Loan fees were $4.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2020 compared to $7.8 million for the same period in 2019. The decrease of $3.2 million was primarily attributable to a decrease in late charges and prepayment fees as a result of the Company's deferment program in response to the COVID-19 pandemic.
Gain (loss) on sales of securities. During the year ended December 31, 2020, we incurred a gain on sales of securities of $2.6 million during the year ended December 31, 2020 as compared to a $1.9 million loss on sales of securities during the same period in 2019. The increase in net gain from sales of securities was primarily due to a decrease in market interest rates on debt securities during the year ended December 31, 2020.
Gain on sales of mortgage loans. We realized gains on loans sold of $1.2 million during the year ended December 31, 2020 compared to $475.0 thousand for the year ended December 31, 2019. The increase was primarily due to an increase in the volume of mortgage loans sold in 2020 compared 2019.
Government guaranteed loan income, net. Government guaranteed loan income, net includes non-interest income earned on PPP loans as well as income related to the sales of government guaranteed loans. The increase in government guaranteed loan income, net of $9.4 million was primarily due to the increase in PPP loans originated and the impact of the fair value option election on these loans during the year ended December 31, 2020. The Company earned fee income of 5%, or $7.0 million, on PPP loans with balances under $350 thousand, 3%, or $4.4 million, on PPP loans with balances between $350 thousand and $2 million and 1%, or $1.1 million, on PPP loans with balances greater than $2 million. This income was recognized upon origination as the Company elected the fair value option for PPP loan income. The increase in government guaranteed loan income, net was partially offset by a $2.3 million fair value remeasurement adjustment for government guaranteed and PPP loans elected to be accounted for under the fair value option and a decrease on gains on sale of non-PPP SBA loans of $1.0 million.
54



Other. Other noninterest income was $8.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2020, an increase of $6.4 million, or 261.9%, compared to the same period in 2019. The increase was primarily due to increases in derivative income of $2.1 million, gain on sale of bank premises, furniture and equipment of $358 thousand, service fee income of $204 thousand and changes in the market value of equity method investments of $157 thousand.
Noninterest Expense
Noninterest expense is composed of all employee expenses and costs associated with operating our facilities, acquiring and retaining customer relationships and providing bank services. The major component of noninterest expense is salaries and employee benefits. Noninterest expense also includes operational expenses, such as occupancy expenses, depreciation and amortization of office equipment, professional fees and regulatory fees, data processing expenses, merger and acquisition expenses and marketing expenses.
The following table presents, for the periods indicated, the major categories of noninterest expense:
  
 For the Year Ended 
 December 31,Increase
 20202019(Decrease)
 (Dollars in thousands)
Salaries and employee benefits$79,453 $72,791 $6,662 
Non-staff expenses:   
Occupancy and equipment16,363 16,385 (22)
Professional and regulatory fees11,729 11,597 132 
Data processing and software expense9,213 8,365 848 
Marketing3,651 3,259 392 
Amortization of intangibles10,790 10,887 (97)
Telephone and communications1,312 1,847 (535)
Merger and acquisition expense— 38,960 (38,960)
COVID Expenses1,377 — 1,377 
Debt extinguishment costs11,307 — 11,307 
Other 14,192 13,712 480 
Total noninterest expense$159,387 $177,803 $(18,416)
Noninterest expense for the year ended December 31, 2020 decreased $18.4 million, or 10.4%, to $159.4 million compared to noninterest expense of $177.8 million for the same period in 2019. The most significant components of the increase were as follows:
Salaries and employee benefits. Salaries and employee benefits include payroll expenses, the cost of incentive compensation, benefit plans, health insurance and payroll taxes. These expenses are impacted by the amount of direct loan origination costs, which are required to be deferred in accordance with ASC 310-20 (formerly FAS91). Salaries and employee benefits were $79.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2020, an increase of $6.7 million, or 9.2%, compared to the same period in 2019. The increase was primarily attributable to increases in compensation costs of $2.4 million, stock based compensation of $2.3 million, payroll taxes of $832 thousand, severance of $771 thousand and 401(k) contribution match of $314 thousand for the year ended December 31, 2020.
Merger and acquisition expense. Merger and acquisition expense includes legal, professional, audit, regulatory and other expenses incurred in connections with a merger or acquisition. No merger and acquisition expenses were incurred for the year ended December 31, 2020, as our acquisition of Green was completed in 2019. These expenses incurred in 2019 were primarily driven by a $17.1 million increase in stock-based compensation due to the accelerated vesting of outstanding restricted stock units and stock options related to the Green acquisition, a $9.0 million increase in severance and change-in-control payments, a $3.1 million increase in professional services expenses and a $1.6 million increase in data processing expense as a result of our system conversions in connection with our acquisition of Green.

55



COVID expenses. This category of expenses includes expenses related to the COVID-19 pandemic such as PPP incentive compensation of $500 thousand, CRA donations of $471 thousand, employee salaries of $273 thousand for employees impacted by the COVID-19 pandemic and increased cleaning expenses of $30 thousand.

Debt extinguishment costs. This category includes pre-payment fees as a result of structured FHLB advances paid off early in the amount of $11.3 million during the year ended December 31, 2020 with no corresponding pre-payments of FHLB advances made during the year ended December 31, 2019.

Income tax expense

Income tax expense is a function of our pre-tax income, tax-exempt income and other nondeductible expenses. Deferred tax assets and liabilities reflect current statutory income tax rates in effect for the period in which the deferred tax assets and liabilities are expected to be realized or settled. As changes in tax laws or rates are enacted, deferred tax assets and liabilities are adjusted through the provision for income taxes. Valuation allowances are established when necessary to reduce deferred tax assets to the amount expected to be realized. As of December 31, 2020 and 2019, the Company did not believe a valuation allowance was necessary.
For the year ended December 31, 2020, income tax expense totaled $14.2 million, a decrease of $10.9 million, or 43.5%, compared to $25.1 million for the same period in 2019. The effective tax rate for the year ended December 31, 2020 was 16.1%, a decrease as compared to the effective tax rate of 21.7% for the same period in 2019. The decrease in the effective tax rate was primarily driven by (i) a net tax benefit of $1.8 million as a result of the Company amending a prior year Green tax return to carry back a net operating loss ("NOL") incurred by Green Bancorp, Inc. on January 1, 2019, (ii) a net tax benefit of $1.4 million primarily associated with the recognition of excess tax benefit realized on share-based payment awards during the year ended December 31, 2020 compared to a $205 thousand excess tax expense realized on share-based payment award during the year ended December 31, 2019 and (iii) a $1.2 million tax benefit as a result of a deferred tax liability true-up during the year ended December 31, 2020 with no corresponding true-up in 2019.
Results of Operations for the Fiscal Years Ended December 31, 2019 and December 31, 2018
Discussion of the results of operations for the fiscal years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018 are included in our Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2019, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on February 28, 2020.

Financial Condition
Our total assets were $8.8 billion and $8.0 billion as of December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively. Assets increased $865.9 million, or 10.9%, from December 31, 2019 to December 31, 2020.  Our asset growth was due to the continued execution of our strategy to establish deep relationships in the Dallas-Fort Worth metroplex and the Houston metropolitan area as well as our PPP loan portfolio, with which we serve small businesses impacted by the COVID-19 pandemic. We believe these relationships will continue to bring in new customer accounts and grow balances from existing loan and deposit customers.
Loan Portfolio
Our primary source of income is interest on loans to individuals, professionals, small to medium-sized businesses and commercial companies located in the Dallas-Fort Worth metroplex and Houston metropolitan area. Our loan portfolio consists primarily of commercial loans and real estate loans secured by commercial real estate ("CRE") properties located in our primary market areas. Our loan portfolio represents the highest yielding component of our interest-earning asset base.
As of December 31, 2020, total loans held for investment were $6.8 billion, an increase of $864.9 million, or 14.6%, compared to $5.9 billion as of December 31, 2019. This increase was the result of the continued execution and success of our loan growth strategy as well as our PPP loan portfolio, with which we serve our small businesses impacted by the COVID-19 pandemic. In addition to these amounts, loans classified as held for sale were $21.4 million and $14.1 million as of December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively.
Total loans held for investment, excluding MW and PPP loans, as a percentage of deposits were 89.8% and 97.3% as of December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019, respectively. Total loans held for investment, excluding MW and PPP loans, as a percentage of total assets were 66.3% and 72.1% as of December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019, respectively.
56



The following table summarizes our loan portfolio by type of loan as of the dates indicated:
 As of December 31,
 20202019201820172016
 AmountPercentAmountPercentAmountPercentAmountPercentAmountPercent
 (Dollars in thousands)
Commercial$1,559,546 24.3 %$1,712,838 28.9 %$684,551 30.7 %$291,416 29.4 %$246,124 30.0 %
MW577,594 9.0 183,628 3.1 — — — — — — 
Real estate:          
Owner Occupied CRE (“OOCRE”)717,472 11.2 706,782 11.9 — — — — — — 
Non-owner Occupied CRE (“NOOCRE”)1,904,132 29.6 1,784,201 30.1 909,292 40.7 370,696 37.4 284,622 34.7 
Construction and land693,030 10.8 629,374 10.6 277,825 12.4 162,614 16.4 126,422 15.4 
Farmland13,844 0.2 16,939 0.3 9,385 0.4 8,262 0.8 11,696 1.4 
1 - 4 family residential524,344 8.2 549,811 9.3 251,665 11.3 140,137 14.1 137,704 16.8 
Multi-family residential424,962 6.6 320,041 5.4 91,152 4.1 14,683 1.5 8,695 1.1 
Consumer13,000 0.1 17,457 0.3 9,648 0.4 4,089 0.4 5,304 0.6 
Total loans held for investment, carried at amortized cost$6,427,924 100 %$5,921,071 100 %$2,233,518 100 %$991,897 100 %$820,567 100 %
Held for investment PPP loans, carried at fair value$358,042 $— $— $— $— 
Total loans held for sale$21,414  $14,080  $1,258  $841  $5,208  
Commercial. Our commercial loans are underwritten after evaluating and understanding the borrower’s ability to operate profitably and effectively. These loans are primarily made based on the identified cash flows of the borrower, and secondarily, on the underlying collateral provided by the borrower. Most commercial loans are secured by the assets being financed or other business assets, such as accounts receivable or inventory, and generally include personal guarantees.
Commercial loans decreased $153.3 million, or 8.9%, to $1.6 billion as of December 31, 2020 from $1.7 billion as of December 31, 2019. The decrease was primarily due to normal fluctuations in the commercial loan portfolio and to elevated early payoffs during the year ended December 31, 2020 compared to the year ended December 31, 2019.
Mortgage warehouse. Our MW loans consist of ownership interests purchased in single-family residential mortgages funded through our warehouse lending group. These loans are typically on our balance sheet for 10 to 25 days or less. We have agreements with mortgage lenders and purchase legal ownership interests in individual loans they originate. All loans are underwritten consistent with established programs for permanent financing with financially sound investors. Substantially all loans are conforming loans or loans eligible for sale to federal agencies or government sponsored entities. However, for accounting purposes, these loans are deemed to be loans to the originator and, as such, are classified as loans held for investment.
We acquired the MW line of business as part of the acquisition of Green in 2019 and as of December 31, 2020 we had $577.6 million of MW loans, accounting for approximately 9.0% of our total funded loans. The growth is due to bringing on more mortgage originators and a decrease in mortgage rates, which has resulted in more originations and refinancings of MW loans.
Commercial Real Estate.  Our CRE loans include owner occupied and non-owner occupied properties, and are underwritten primarily based on projected cash flows and, secondarily, as loans secured by real estate. These loans may be more adversely affected by conditions in the real estate markets or in the general economy. The properties securing the portfolio are located throughout Texas and are generally diverse in terms of type. This diversity helps reduce the exposure to adverse economic events that affect any single industry.
OOCRE loans increased $10.7 million, or 1.5%, to $717.5 million as of December 31, 2020 from $706.8 million as of December 31, 2019. NOOCRE loans increased $119.9 million, or 6.7%, to $1.9 billion as of December 31, 2020 from $1.8 billion as of December 31, 2019. The increases are due to continued demand within our primary market areas.
57



Construction and land.  Our construction and land development loans consist of loans to fund construction, land acquisition and land development construction. The properties securing the portfolio are primarily located throughout Texas and are generally diverse in terms of type.
Construction and land loans increased $63.7 million, or 10.1%, to $693.0 million as of December 31, 2020 from $629.4 million as of December 31, 2019. This increase was due to the robust business environment in the Dallas-Fort Worth metroplex and the Houston metropolitan area, even amidst the COVID-19 pandemic disruption.
1-4 family residential.  Our 1-4 family residential loans consist of loans secured by single family homes, which are both owner-occupied and investor owned. Our 1-4 family residential loans have a relatively small balance spread between many individual borrowers.
1-4 family residential loans decreased $25.5 million, or 4.6%, to $524.3 million as of December 31, 2020 from $549.8 million as of December 31, 2019. This decrease is a result of normal fluctuations in the 1-4 family residential loan portfolio.
PPP loans. PPP loans increased $358.0 million, or 100.0%, as of December 31, 2020. These PPP loans were originated through the SBA as a result of the CARES Act, are 100% forgivable if certain criteria are met by the borrowers, and are 100% guaranteed by the SBA. As of December 31, 2020, we have no reason to believe that any of the Company’s PPP loans would not qualify for loan forgiveness or the SBA guarantee.
Other loan categories.  Other categories of loans in our loan portfolio include farmland and agricultural loans made to farmers and ranchers relating to their operations, multi-family residential loans, consumer loans and purchased receivables financing. None of these categories of loans represents a significant portion of our total loan portfolio.
The contractual maturity ranges of loans in our loan portfolio, excluding MW and PPP loans, and the amount of such loans with fixed and floating interest rates in each maturity range as of date indicated are summarized in the following tables:
 As of December 31, 2020
 One YearOne ThroughAfter 
 or LessFive YearsFive YearsTotal
 (Dollars in thousands)
Commercial$692,690 $730,683 $136,173 $1,559,546 
Real estate:
Construction and land228,649 383,369 81,012 693,030 
Farmland726 12,357 761 13,844 
1 - 4 family residential14,242 94,933 415,169 524,344 
Multi-family residential40,448 319,322 65,192 424,962 
OOCRE72,243 333,235 311,994 717,472 
NOOCRE442,184 1,181,896 280,052 1,904,132 
Consumer2,874 6,395 3,731 13,000 
Total loans held for investment, excluding MW and PPP1,494,056 3,062,190 1,294,084 5,850,330 
Loans held for investments, MW— — — 577,594 
PPP loans, carried at fair value137 357,905 — 358,042 
Total loans held for investment$1,494,193 $3,420,095 $1,294,084 $6,785,966 
Amounts with fixed rates, excluding MW and PPP$249,351 $1,644,237 $393,070 $2,286,658 
Amounts with floating rates, excluding MW and PPP$1,244,705 $1,417,953 $901,014 $3,563,672 
 
58



 As of December 31, 2019
 One YearOne ThroughAfter 
 or LessFive YearsFive YearsTotal
 (Dollars in thousands)
Commercial$685,784 $599,704 $427,350 $1,712,838 
Real estate:    
Construction and land172,569 219,877 236,928 629,374 
Farmland1,680 12,662 2,597 16,939 
1 - 4 family residential27,843 89,884 432,084 549,811 
Multi-family residential11,484 214,075 94,482 320,041 
Commercial real estate369,142 1,203,646 918,195 2,490,983 
Consumer6,681 4,785 5,991 17,457 
Total loans$1,275,183 $2,344,633 $2,117,627 $5,737,443 
Loans held for investment, MW$— $— $— $183,628 
Amounts with fixed rates$193,225 $462,277 $1,124,254 $1,779,756 
Amounts with floating rates$1,081,958 $1,882,356 $993,373 $3,957,687 
Nonperforming Assets
The following table presents information regarding nonperforming loans at the dates indicated:
 As of December 31,
 20202019201820172016
 (Dollars in thousands)
Nonaccrual loans(1)
$81,096 $29,779 $24,745 $465 $941 
Accruing loans 90 or more days past due4,204 3,660 — 18 835 
Total nonperforming loans85,300 33,439 24,745 483 1,776 
Other real estate owned:     
Commercial and industrial— 4,242 — — — 
Commercial real estate, construction, land and land development2,337 1,087 — 449 493 
Residential real estate— 666 — — 169 
Total other real estate owned2,337 5,995 — 449 662 
Total nonperforming assets$87,637 $39,434 $24,745 $932 $2,438 
Troubled debt restructured loans—nonaccrual$23,225 $686 $227 $15 $170 
Troubled debt restructured loans—accruing$5,932 $1,457 $944 $603 $652 
Ratio of nonperforming loans to total loans1.46 %0.56 %0.97 %0.02 %0.18 %
Ratio of nonperforming assets to total assets0.99 %0.50 %0.77 %0.03 %0.17 %
(1) At December 31, 2020, nonaccrual loans included PCD loans of $1,508 not accounted for on a pooled basis. At December 31, 2018, nonaccrual loans included performing and non-pooled purchased credit impaired ("PCI") loans of $16,902 for which discount accretion have been suspended because the extent and timing of cash flows from these PCI loans could no longer be reasonably estimated. There were no PCI loans classified as nonaccrual at December 31, 2019, 2017, or 2016.
 
Loans are considered past due if the required principal and interest payments have not been received as of the date such payments were due. Loans are placed on nonaccrual status when, in management’s opinion, the borrower may be unable to meet payment obligations as they become due, as well as when required by regulatory provisions. Loans may be placed on nonaccrual status regardless of whether or not such loans are considered past due. When interest accrual is discontinued, all unpaid accrued interest is reversed. Interest income is subsequently recognized only to the extent cash payments are received in excess of principal due. Loans are returned to accrual status when all principal and interest amounts contractually due are brought current and future payments are reasonably assured.
59



We have several procedures in place to assist us in maintaining the overall quality of our loan portfolio. We have established underwriting guidelines to be followed by our bankers, and we also monitor our delinquency levels for any negative or adverse trends. Nevertheless, our loan portfolio could become subject to increasing pressures from deteriorating borrower credit due to general economic conditions.
We believe our conservative lending approach and focused management of nonperforming assets, which consist of nonaccrual loans, accruing loans 90 or more days past due excluding pooled PCD loans and other real estate owned, has resulted in sound asset quality and timely resolution of problem assets. We had $87.6 million in nonperforming assets as of December 31, 2020 compared to $39.4 million in nonperforming assets as of December 31, 2019. We had $85.3 million in nonperforming loans as of December 31, 2020 compared to $33.4 million as of December 31, 2019. The increase of $48.2 million in nonperforming assets compared to December 31, 2019 was primarily due to the a $51.3 million increase in nonaccrual loans offset by $199 thousand decrease in other real estate owned. One NOOCRE loan relationship in amount of $16.1 million along with an overall $23.6 million increase in commercial loans account for the majority of new nonaccrual loans. 
The following table presents nonaccrual loans by category at the dates indicated:
 As of December 31,
 20202019201820172016
 (Dollars in thousands)
Real estate:     
Construction and land$— $567 $2,399 $— $— 
Farmland— — — — — 
1 - 4 family residential3,308 1,581 — — — 
Multi-family residential— — — — — 
OOCRE6,266 3,029 — — — 
NOOCRE40,830 18,876 2,575 61 — 
Commercial29,318 5,672 19,769 398 930 
Consumer1,374 54 11 
Total$81,096 $29,779 $24,745 $465 $941 

Potential Problem Loans
From a credit risk standpoint, we classify loans in one of four categories: pass, special mention, substandard or doubtful. Loans classified as loss are charged-off. Loans not rated special mention, substandard, doubtful, or loss are classified as pass loans. The classifications of loans reflect a judgment about the risks of default and loss associated with the loan. We review the ratings on credits monthly. Ratings are adjusted to reflect the degree of risk and loss that is felt to be inherent in each credit as of each monthly reporting period. All classified credits are evaluated for impairments. If impairment is determined to exist, a specific reserve is established. Our methodology is structured so that specific allocations are increased in accordance with deterioration in credit quality (and a corresponding increase in risk and loss) or decreased in accordance with improvement in credit quality (and a corresponding decrease in risk and loss).
Credits rated special mention show clear signs of financial weaknesses or deterioration in credit worthiness, however, such concerns are not so pronounced that we generally expect to experience significant loss within the short-term. Such credits typically maintain the ability to perform within standard credit terms and credit exposure is not as prominent as credits with a lower rating.
Credits rated substandard are those in which the normal repayment of principal and interest may be, or has been, jeopardized by reason of adverse trends or developments of a financial, managerial, economic or political nature, or important weaknesses which exist in collateral. A protracted workout on these credits is a distinct possibility. Prompt corrective action is therefore required to strengthen our position, and/or to reduce exposure and to assure that adequate remedial measures are taken by the borrower. Credit exposure becomes more likely in such credits and a serious evaluation of the secondary support to the credit is performed.
60



Credits rated doubtful are those in which full collection of principal appears highly questionable, and in which some degree of loss is anticipated, even though the ultimate amount of loss may not yet be certain and/or other factors exist which could affect collection of debt. Based upon available information, positive action by the Company is required to avert or minimize loss. Credits rated doubtful are generally also placed on nonaccrual.
Credits classified as PCD, previously called PCI loans prior to the adoption of ASU 2016-13, are those that, at acquisition date prior to adoption of ASU 2016-13, had credit deterioration and it was probable that all contractually required principal and interest payments would not be collected. The Company evaluates these loans on a projected cash flow basis with this evaluation performed quarterly.
The following table summarizes our internal loan ratings, including PCD loans, as of the dates indicated.
 As of December 31, 2020
  Special    
 PassMentionSubstandardDoubtfulPCDTotal
 (Dollars in thousands)
Real estate:                        
Construction and land$687,169 $2,666 $510 $— $2,685 $693,030 
Farmland13,844 — — — — 13,844 
1 - 4 family residential511,191 2,678 1,734 — 8,741 524,344 
Multi-family residential412,282 12,680 — — — 424,962 
OOCRE595,598 44,560 39,323 — 37,991 717,472 
NOOCRE1,650,917 153,090 56,949 — 43,176 1,904,132 
Commercial1,406,766 56,060 77,260 — 19,460 1,559,546 
MW577,594 — — — — 577,594 
Consumer11,357 252 1,189 — 202 13,000 
Total$5,866,718 $271,986 $176,965 $— $112,255 $6,427,924 
 
 As of December 31, 2019
  Special   
 PassMentionSubstandardDoubtfulPCDTotal
 (Dollars in thousands)
Real estate:                    
Construction and land$618,773 $3,965 $2,689 $— $3,947 $629,374 
Farmland16,939 — — — — 16,939 
1 - 4 family residential541,787 795 3,460 — 3,769 549,811 
Multi-family residential320,041 — — — — 320,041 
Commercial Real Estate2,332,357 23,494 38,278 — 96,854 2,490,983 
Commercial1,610,150 51,999 28,670 — 22,019 1,712,838 
MW183,628 — — — — 183,628 
Consumer17,106 40 182 — 129 17,457 
Total$5,640,781 $80,293 $73,279 $— $126,718 $5,921,071 
Allowance for credit losses on loans held for investment
We maintain an ACL that represents management’s best estimate of the credit losses and risks inherent in the loan portfolio. In determining the ACL, we estimate losses on specific loans, or groups of loans, where the probable loss can be identified and reasonably determined. The balance of the ACL is based on internally assigned risk classifications of loans, historical loan loss rates, changes in the nature of the loan portfolio, overall portfolio quality, industry concentrations, delinquency trends, current economic factors and the estimated impact of current economic conditions on certain historical loan loss rates. For additional discussion of our methodology, please refer to “—Critical Accounting Policies—Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses.”
61



In connection with our review of the loan portfolio, we consider risk elements attributable to particular loan types or categories in assessing the quality of individual loans. Some of the risk elements we consider include:
for commercial and industrial loans, the operating results of the commercial, industrial or professional enterprise, the borrower’s business, professional and financial ability and expertise, the specific risks and volatility of income and operating results typical for businesses in that category and the value, nature and marketability of collateral;
for commercial mortgage loans and multifamily residential loans, the debt service coverage ratio (income from the property in excess of operating expenses compared to loan payment requirements), operating results of the owner in the case of owner occupied properties, the loan to value ratio, the age and condition of the collateral and the volatility of income, property value and future operating results typical of properties of that type;
for 1-4 family residential mortgage loans, the borrower’s ability to repay the loan, including a consideration of the debt to income ratio and employment and income stability, the loan to value ratio, and the age, condition and marketability of the collateral; and
for construction, land development and other land loans, the perceived feasibility of the project, including the ability to sell developed lots or improvements constructed for resale or the ability to lease property constructed for lease, the quality and nature of contracts for presale or prelease, if any, experience and ability of the developer and loan to value ratio.
As of December 31, 2020, the ACL totaled $105.1 million, or 1.80%, of total loans, excluding MW and PPP loans. As of December 31, 2019, the ACL totaled $29.8 million, or 0.52%, of total loans, excluding MW loans. The increase in the percentage of ACL to total loans compared to December 31, 2019 was attributable to the adoption of ASU 2016-13 which on January 1, 2020, adoption date, the Company recorded an increase of $39.1 million to the ACL. Additionally, the increase in the required ACL was due to significant deterioration in projected Texas economic forecasts during 2020 to calculate expected losses. This deterioration was brought on by the projected economic impact of the COVID-19 pandemic on the Company’s loss drivers over the reasonable and supportable forecast period and resulted in the need for additional ACL.
62



The following table presents, as of and for the periods indicated, an analysis of the ACL and other related data:
 For the Years Ended December 31,
 20202019201820172016
Average loans outstanding(1)
$6,379,736 $5,884,364 $2,382,946 $1,441,295 $919,387 
Amortized costs of loans outstanding at end of period excluding MW and PPP loans(1)
5,847,862 5,737,577 2,555,524 2,233,546 991,952 
Amortized cost of loans outstanding at end of period(1)
6,425,456 5,921,071 2,555,509 2,233,518 991,897 
Allowance for credit losses at beginning of period29,834 19,255 12,808 8,524 6,772 
Impact of adopting ASC 32639,137 — — — — 
Provision for credit losses56,640 21,514 6,603 5,114 2,050 
Charge-offs:     
Real estate:     
Construction, land and farmland— — — — — 
Residential(18)(157)— (11)— 
OOCRE(2,421)— — — — 
NOOCRE(2,865)— — — — 
Commercial(15,507)(10,898)(175)(828)(314)
Consumer(162)(265)(22)— (19)
Total charge-offs(20,973)(11,320)(197)(839)(333)
Recoveries:     
Real estate:     
Residential57 — — — — 
NOOCRE— 67 — — — 
Commercial102 226 41 32 
Consumer287 92 — — 
Total recoveries446 385 41 35 
Net charge-offs(20,527)(10,935)(156)(830)(298)
Allowance for credit losses at end of period$105,084 $29,834 $19,255 $12,808 $8,524 
Ratio of allowance to end of period loans excluding MW and PPP loans1.80 %0.52 %0.75 %0.57 %0.86 %
Ratio of net charge-offs to average loans0.36 %0.19 %0.01 %0.06 %0.03 %
 
(1)Excluding loans held for sale.
Although we believe that we have established our allowance for credit losses in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States (“GAAP”) and that the allowance for credit losses was adequate to provide for known and inherent losses in the portfolio at all times shown above, future provisions will be subject to ongoing evaluations of the risks in our loan portfolio. If we experience economic declines or if asset quality deteriorates, material additional provisions could be required.
63



The following table shows the allocation of the allowance for credit losses among our loan categories and certain other information as of the dates indicated. The allocation of the allowance for credit losses as shown in the table should neither be interpreted as an indication of future charge-offs, nor as an indication that charge-offs in future periods will necessarily occur in these amounts or in the indicated proportions. The total allowance is available to absorb losses from any loan category.
 As of December 31,
 20202019201820172016
  Percent Percent Percent Percent Percent
 Amountto TotalAmountto TotalAmountto TotalAmountto TotalAmountto Total
 (Dollars in thousands)
Real estate:                                        
Construction and land$7,768 7.4 %$3,822 12.8 %$2,186 11.4 %$1,269 9.9 %$1,346 15.8 %
Farmland56 0.1 61 0.2 58 0.3 46 0.4 69 0.8 
1 - 4 family residential8,148 7.8 1,378 4.6 1,613 8.4 1,192 9.3 999 11.7 
Multi-family residential6,231 5.9 1,965 6.6 362 1.9 281 2.2 117 1.4 
Commercial Real Estate44,956 42.8 10,117 33.9 6,463 33.6 4,410 34.4 3,003 35.2 
Total real estate67,159 64.0 17,343 58.1 10,682 55.5 7,198 56.2 5,534 64.9 
Commercial37,554 35.7 12,369 41.5 8,554 44.4 5,588 43.6 2,955 34.7 
Consumer371 0.3 122 0.4 19 0.1 22 0.2 35 0.4 
Total allowance for credit losses$105,084 100 %$29,834 100 %$19,255 100 %$12,808 100 %$8,524 100 %
 

Equity Securities
As of December 31, 2020, we held equity securities with a readily determinable fair value of $11.4 million compared to $11.1 million. as of December 31, 2019. These equity securities represent investments in a publicly traded Community Reinvestment Act fund and are subject to market pricing volatility, with changes in fair value recorded in earnings.
The Company held equity securities without a readily determinable fair values and measured at cost of $3.6 million at December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively. The Company measures equity securities that do not have readily determinable fair values at cost minus impairment, if any, plus or minus changes resulting from observable price changes in orderly transactions for the identical or a similar investment of the same issuer.
FHLB Stock and FRB Stock
As of December 31, 2020, we held FHLB stock and FRB stock of $71.2 million compared to $68.3 million as of December 31, 2019. The Bank is a member of its regional Federal Reserve Bank and of the FHLB system. FHLB members are required to own a certain amount of stock based on the level of borrowings and other factors, and may invest in additional amounts. Both FRB and FHLB stock are carried at cost, restricted for sale, and periodically evaluated for impairment based on ultimate recovery of par value. Both cash and stock dividends are reported as income. Other non-marketable equity securities are carried at their cost, which approximates fair value.

Debt Securities

We use our debt securities portfolio to provide a source of liquidity, provide an appropriate return on funds invested, manage interest rate risk, meet collateral requirements and meet regulatory capital requirements. As of December 31, 2020, the carrying amount of debt securities totaled $1.1 billion, an increase of $57.9 million, or 5.8%, compared to $997.3 million as of December 31, 2019. The increase in our debt securities in 2020 were primarily due to purchases of debt securities of $1.2 billion and net unrealized gains $32.8 million, offset by maturities, calls and paydowns of $1.0 billion, and sales of $113.8 million. Debt securities represented 12.0% and 12.1% of total assets as of December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively.
64



Our investment portfolio consists of debt securities classified as available for sale and held to maturity. As a result, the carrying values of our available for sale debt securities are adjusted for unrealized gain or loss, and any gain or loss is reported on an after-tax basis as a component of other comprehensive income in stockholders’ equity. Our held to maturity debt securities are recorded at their amortized cost. The following table summarizes the amortized cost and estimated fair value of our available for sale debt securities, excluding held-to-maturity debt securities, as of the dates shown:

 As of December 31, 2020
  GrossGrossAllowance 
 AmortizedUnrealizedUnrealizedfor Credit 
 CostGainsLossesLossesFair Value
 (Dollars in thousands)
Corporate bonds$173,050 $6,417 $1,297 $— $178,170 
Municipal securities115,533 10,129 — 125,656 
Mortgage-backed securities240,320 16,047 42 — 256,325 
Collateralized mortgage obligations388,080 20,895 66 — 408,909 
Asset-backed securities52,335 2,934 — — 55,269 
Total$969,318 $56,422 $1,411 $— $1,024,329 
 
 As of December 31, 2019
  GrossGross 
 AmortizedUnrealizedUnrealized 
 CostGainsLossesFair Value
 (Dollars in thousands)
Corporate bonds$76,997 $1,974 $— $78,971 
Municipal securities74,956 3,724 — 78,680 
Mortgage-backed securities288,938 9,512 260 298,190 
Collateralized mortgage obligations431,276 6,465 1,503 436,238 
Asset-backed securities69,964 2,322 — 72,286 
Total$942,131 $23,997 $1,763 $964,365 
 
All of our mortgage-backed securities and collateralized mortgage obligations are issued and/or guaranteed by U.S. government agencies or U.S. government-sponsored entities. We do not hold any Fannie Mae or Freddie Mac preferred stock, corporate equity, collateralized debt obligations, collateralized loan obligations, structured investment vehicles, private label collateralized mortgage obligations, subprime, Alt-A or second lien elements in our investment portfolio. As of December 31, 2020, our investment portfolio did not contain any securities that are directly backed by subprime or Alt-A mortgages.
Management evaluates available for sale debt securities in unrealized loss positions to determine whether the impairment is due to credit-related factors or noncredit-related factors. Consideration is given to (1) the extent to which the fair value is less than cost, (2) the financial condition and near-term prospects of the issuer, and (3) the intent and ability of the Company to retain its investment in the security for a period of time sufficient to allow for any anticipated recovery in fair value. As of December 31, 2020, management believes that available for sale debt securities in a unrealized loss position are due to noncredit-related factors, including changes in interest rates and other market conditions, and therefore no allowance for credit losses have been recognized in the Company’s condensed consolidated balance sheets. The Company also recorded no allowance for credit losses for its held to maturity debt securities as of December 31, 2020.
The following table sets forth the fair value and amortized cost for available for sale debt securities and held to maturity debt securities, respectively, maturities and approximated weighted average yield based on estimated annual income divided by the average fair value of available for sale debt securities and amortized cost of held to maturity debt securities as of the dates indicated. The contractual maturity of a mortgage-backed security is the date at which the last underlying mortgage matures.
65



 As of December 31, 2020
  After One YearAfter Five Years    
 Withinbut Withinbut Within    
 One YearFive YearsTen YearsAfter Ten YearsTotal
 AmountYieldAmountYieldAmountYieldAmountYieldTotalYield
 (Dollars in thousands) 
Corporate bonds$— — %$5,139 3.64 %$156,992 4.76 %$16,039 6.13 %$178,170 4.85 %
Municipal securities— — — — 4,853 2.38 143,072 2.82 147,925 2.81 
Mortgage-backed securities— — 13,931 2.91 61,237 2.98 188,140 2.85 263,308 2.88 
Collateralized mortgage obligations— — 59,044 2.83 206,159 2.35 145,326 2.64 410,529 2.52 
Asset-backed securities— — — — 25,741 2.84 29,528 2.48 55,269 2.65 
Total$— — %$78,114 2.90 %$454,982 3.29 %$522,105 2.87 %$1,055,201 3.05 %
 
 As of December 31, 2019
   After One YearAfter Five Years    
 Withinbut Withinbut Within    
 One YearFive YearsTen YearsAfter Ten YearsTotal
 AmountYieldAmountYieldAmountYieldAmountYieldTotalYield
 (Dollars in thousands)
Corporate bonds— — 5,099 3.64 73,872 4.93 — — 78,971 4.85 
Municipal securities— — — — 3,735 2.59 97,480 2.97 101,215 2.96 
Mortgage-backed securities— — — — 70,738 2.99 236,073 2.92 306,811 2.94 
Collateralized mortgage obligations— — 57,075 2.83 162,724 2.53 218,247 2.91 438,046 2.76 
Asset-backed securities— — — — 22,486 3.11 49,800 3.25 72,286 3.21 
Total$— — %$62,174 2.90 %$333,555 3.20 %$601,600 2.95 %$997,329 3.03 %
The contractual maturity of mortgage-backed securities, collateralized mortgage obligations and asset-backed securities is not a reliable indicator of their expected life because borrowers have the right to prepay their obligations at any time. Mortgage-backed securities, collateralized mortgage obligations and asset-backed securities are typically issued with stated principal amounts and are backed by pools of mortgage loans and other loans with varying maturities. The term of the underlying mortgages and loans may vary significantly due to the ability of a borrower to prepay amounts outstanding. Monthly pay downs on mortgage-backed securities tend to cause the average life of the securities to be much different than the stated contractual maturity. During a period of increasing interest rates, fixed-rate mortgage-backed securities do not tend to experience heavy prepayments of principal, and consequently, the average life of this security will be lengthened. If interest rates begin to fall, prepayments may increase, thereby shortening the estimated life of these securities. The weighted average life of our investment portfolio was 5.83 years with an estimated effective duration of 4.1 years as of December 31, 2020.  The average yield of the securities portfolio was 2.84% during 2020 compared to 3.02% during 2019.
As of December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019, we did not own securities of any one issuer other than U.S. government agency securities, for which aggregate adjusted cost exceeded 10.0% of the consolidated stockholders’ equity as of such respective dates.
Intangible Assets and Goodwill
Intangible assets and goodwill as of December 31, 2020 were $61.7 million and $370.8 million, respectively, a decrease of intangible assets of $10.5 million compared to December 31, 2019. The decrease in intangible assets was primarily due to amortization of $9.8 million on core deposit intangibles.
December 31, 2020December 31, 2019
(Dollars in thousands)
Intangible assets$61,733 $72,263 
Goodwill370,840 370,840 

66



Deposits
We offer a variety of deposit products having a wide range of interest rates and terms, including demand, savings, money market and time accounts. We rely primarily on competitive pricing policies, convenient locations and personalized service to attract and retain these deposits.
Total deposits as of December 31, 2020 were $6.5 billion, an increase of $618.5 million, or 10.5%, compared to $5.9 billion as of December 31, 2019, due primarily to increases of $218.5 million and $540.6 million in money market accounts and noninterest-bearing deposit accounts, offset by a decrease of $225.6 million in certificates of deposit, respectively. Our deposit growth was primarily related to our continued penetration in our primary market areas, the increase in commercial lending relationships for which we also seek deposit balances and increases in our financial institution money market accounts.
Average deposits for the year ended December 31, 2020 were $6.1 billion, a decrease of $22.1 million, or 0.4% over average deposits of $6.1 billion for the year ended December 31, 2019. The average rate paid on total interest-bearing deposits decreased from 1.70% for the year ended December 31, 2019 to 0.86% for the year ended December 31, 2020. The decrease in the average rate paid on interest-bearing deposits was due to the overall market condition, and a decrease in the prime rate during 2020.
The following table presents the daily average balances and weighted average rates paid on deposits for the periods indicated:
 For Year Ended December 31,
 20202019
 AverageAverageAverageAverage
 BalanceRateBalanceRate
 (Dollars in thousands)
Interest-bearing demand accounts$394,713 0.19 %$378,884 0.47 %
Savings accounts96,142 0.15 97,710 0.34 
Money market accounts2,235,607 0.55 2,171,519 1.76 
Certificates and other time deposits > $100,000702,642 1.22 1,089,368 1.37 
Certificates and other time deposits < $100,000848,353 1.78 907,722 2.62 
Total interest-bearing deposits4,277,457 0.86 4,645,203 1.70 
Noninterest-bearing demand accounts1,825,806 1,480,207  
Total deposits$6,103,263 0.60 %$6,125,410 1.29 %
Our ratio of average noninterest-bearing deposits to average total deposits was 29.9% and 24.2% for the years ended December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019, respectively.
Factors affecting the cost of funding of our interest-bearing assets include the volume of noninterest- and interest-bearing deposits, changes in market interest rates (including increases in fed fund rates) and economic conditions in our target markets and their impact on interest paid on our deposits, change in deposit mix, as well as the ongoing execution of our balance sheet management strategy. Our cost of funds was 0.60% in 2020 and 1.29% in 2019. Average rates on interest-bearing deposits were 0.86% in 2020 and 1.70% in 2019.
Borrowings
We utilize short-term and long-term borrowings to supplement deposits to fund our lending and investment activities, each of which is discussed below.
67



FHLB Advance
The FHLB allows us to borrow on a blanket floating lien status collateralized by certain securities and loans. As of December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018, total borrowing capacity of $766.4 million, $752.7 million and $1.0 billion, respectively, was available under this arrangement and $777.7 million, $677.9 million and $28.0 million, respectively, was outstanding, with an average interest rate of 1.04% as of December 31, 2020, 1.99% as of December 31, 2019 and 1.95% as of December 31, 2018. We utilize these borrowings to meet liquidity needs and to fund certain fixed rate loans in our portfolio. The following table presents our current FHLB advances based on year of maturity as of December 31, 2020.
Maturity YearFHLB Advances
(Dollars in thousands)
2022$27,718 
202950,000 
2034250,000 
2035450,000 
Total$777,718 
The following table presents our FHLB borrowings at the dates indicated. Other than FHLB borrowings, we had no other short-term borrowings at the dates indicated.
 FHLB Advances
 (Dollars in thousands)
December 31, 2020 
Amount outstanding at period end$777,718 
Weighted average interest rate at period end0.94 %
Maximum month-end balance during the period$1,377,767 
Average balance outstanding during the period1,024,142 
Weighted average interest rate during the period1.04 %
December 31, 2019
Amount outstanding at period end$677,870 
Weighted average interest rate at period end1.48 %
Maximum month-end balance during the period$752,827 
Average balance outstanding during the period502,681 
Weighted average interest rate during the period1.99 %
FRB.  The FRB has an available borrower in custody arrangement, which allows us to borrow on a collateralized basis. Certain commercial and consumer loans are pledged under this arrangement. We maintain this borrowing arrangement to meet liquidity needs pursuant to our contingency funding plan. As of December 31, 2020 and 2019, $871.5 million and $1.0 billion, respectively, were available under this arrangement based on collateral values of pledged commercial and consumer loans. As of December 31, 2020, approximately $94.2 million in commercial loans were pledged as collateral. As of December 31, 2020 and 2019, no borrowings were outstanding under this arrangement.
Junior subordinated debentures and subordinated notes.
The table below details our junior subordinated debentures and subordinated notes. Refer to Note 14 "Borrowed Funds" for further discussion on the details of our junior subordinated debentures and subordinated notes.
68



 As of December 31, 2020
 BalanceRate
Junior subordinated debentures
Parkway Trust Securities3,093 2.07 %
SovDallas Trust Securities8,609 4.23 %
Patriot I Capital Trust I5,155 2.09 %
Patriot II Capital Trust II17,011 2.02 %
Total33,868 
Subordinated notes
8.50% Fixed-to-Floating Rate Subordinated Notes35,000 8.50 %
4.75% Fixed-to-Floating Rate Subordinated Notes 75,000 4.75 %
4.125% Fixed-to-Floating Rate Subordinated Notes125,000 4.13 %
Total235,000 

Liquidity and Capital Resources
Liquidity
Liquidity management involves our ability to raise funds to support asset growth and acquisitions or reduce assets to meet deposit withdrawals and other payment obligations, to maintain reserve requirements and otherwise to operate on an ongoing basis and manage unexpected events. For the years ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018, our liquidity needs were primarily met by core deposits, wholesale borrowings, security and loan maturities and amortizing investment and loan portfolios. Use of brokered deposits, purchased funds from correspondent banks and overnight advances from the FHLB and the FRB are available and have been utilized to take advantage of the cost of these funding sources. We maintained five lines of credit with commercial banks that provide for extensions of credit with an availability to borrow up to an aggregate amount of $175.0 million as of December 31, 2020, three lines of credit with commercial banks with an availability to borrow up to an aggregate amount of $150.0 million as of December 31, 2019 and two lines of credit with commercial banks with an availability to borrow up to an aggregate of $75.0 million as of December 31, 2018. There were no advances under these lines of credit outstanding as of December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018.

In addition, $359.8 million was available in conjunction with the Paycheck Protection Program Liquidity Facility (“PPPLF”) which is a lending facility offered by the Federal Reserve to extend credit to financial institutions that originate PPP loans, while taking the PPP loans as collateral. As of December 31, 2020, we have not utilized the PPPLF.

The following table illustrates, during the periods presented, the mix of our funding sources and the average assets in which those funds are invested as a percentage of our average total assets for the period indicated. Average assets totaled $8.5 billion for the year ended December 31, 2020, $8.0 billion for the year ended December 31, 2019 and $3.1 billion for the year ended December 31, 2018.
69



 For the Years Ended
 December 31,
 202020192018
Sources of Funds:            
Deposits:   
Noninterest-bearing21.4 %18.6 %19.8 %
Interest-bearing32.0 33.3 40.8 
Certificates and other time deposits18.2 25.1 19.4 
Advances from FHLB12.0 6.3 2.8 
Other borrowings2.0 1.1 0.5 
Other liabilities0.7 0.6 0.4 
Stockholders’ equity13.7 15.0 16.3 
Total100 %100 %100 %
Uses of Funds:  
Loans72.7 %73.6 %75.6 %
Securities available for sale13.2 12.3 7.9 
Interest-bearing deposits in other banks1.2 0.8 — 
Other noninterest-earning assets12.9 13.3 16.5 
Total100 %100 %100 %
Average noninterest-bearing deposits to average deposits29.9 %35.9 %32.7 %
Average loans, excluding MW and PPP, to average deposits94.5 %96.1 %124.7 %

Our primary source of funds is deposits, and our primary use of funds is loans. We do not expect a change in the primary source or use of our funds in the foreseeable future. Our average loans, including MW and PPP, net of allowance for credit loss increased 7.2% for the year ended December 31, 2020 compared to the same period in 2019 and an increase of 147.5% for the year ended December 31, 2019 due to the acquisition of Green compared to the same period in 2018. We invest excess deposits in interest-bearing deposits at other banks, the FRB or liquid investments securities until these monies are needed to fund loan growth.
As of December 31, 2020, we had $2.7 billion in outstanding commitments to extend credit, $354.6 million in MW commitments and $44.4 million in commitments associated with outstanding standby and commercial letters of credit. As of December 31, 2019, we had $1.6 billion in outstanding commitments to extend credit, $347.5 million in MW commitments and $27.2 million in commitments associated with outstanding standby and commercial letters of credit. Since commitments associated with letters of credit and commitments to extend credit may expire unused, the total outstanding may not necessarily reflect the actual future cash funding requirements.
As of December 31, 2020, we had cash and cash equivalents of $230.8 million, compared to $251.6 million at December 31, 2019.
Analysis of Cash Flows
 For the Years Ended
 December 31,
 20202019
Net cash provided by operating activities$107,650 $103,960 
Net cash used in investing activities(874,555)(46,339)
Net cash provided by financing activities746,180 109,480 
Net change in cash and cash equivalents$(20,725)$167,101 

70



Cash Flows Provided by Operating Activities
For the year ended December 31, 2020, net cash provided by operating activities increased by $3.7 million from $104.0 million to $107.7 million representing a minimal change in operating cash flows year over year
Cash Flows Used in Investing Activities
For the year ended December 31, 2020, net cash used in investing activities increased by $828.2 million compared to the same period in 2019. The increase in cash used in investing activities was primarily attributable to an increase in net originations of loans held for investment of $745.9 million and $112.7 million of cash received in excess of cash paid for the acquisition of Green in 2019 with no corresponding cash received in excess of cash paid in 2020.
Cash Flows Provided by Financing Activities
For the year ended December 31, 2020, net cash provided by financing activities increased by $636.7 million compared to the same period in 2019. The increase in cash provided by financing activities was primarily attributable to a $815.1 million increase in deposits, a $48.0 million increase in issuance of subordinated notes, net of debt issuance costs paid and a decrease in share repurchases of $37.1 million, slightly offset by a $250.0 million decrease in advances from the FHLB for the year ending December 31, 2019.
For the years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019, the Company had no exposure to future cash requirements associated with known uncertainties or capital expenditures of a material nature.
Share Repurchases
On January 28, 2019, our Board of Directors originally authorized a stock buyback program (the "Stock Buyback Program") pursuant to which we could, from time to time, purchase up to $50.0 million of our outstanding common stock in the aggregate. Our Board of Directors authorized increases of $50.0 million in September 2019 and $75.0 million in December 2019, resulting in authorization to purchase an aggregate of up to $175.0 million of shares. Our Board of Directors also authorized an extension of the original expiration date of the Stock Buyback Program from December 31, 2019 to December 31, 2020, and a further extension to March 31, 2021. The shares may be repurchased in the open market or in privately negotiated transactions from time to time, depending upon market conditions and other factors, and in accordance with applicable regulations of the SEC and capital and dividend guidelines of the Federal Reserve. The Stock Buyback Program does not obligate us to purchase any shares and may be terminated or amended by our Board of Directors at any time prior to its expiration date. During the year ended December 31, 2020, 2,349,639 shares of our common stock were repurchased through the Stock Buyback Program and held as treasury stock at an average price of $24.51 per share. During the year ended December 31, 2019, 3,802,711 shares were repurchased through the Stock Buyback Program and held as treasury stock at an average price of $24.86 per share.
Capital Resources

Total stockholders’ equity was $1.20 billion as of December 31, 2020, compared to $1.19 billion as of December 31, 2019, an increase of $12.6 million, or 1.1%. The increase from December 31, 2019 was primarily the result of $73.9 million in net income, $37.2 million of other comprehensive income, and $8.0 of stock based compensation offset by $57.5 million in stock buybacks, $34.1 million in dividends declared and paid and $15.5 million in CECL transition during the year ended December 31, 2020.
For the year ended December 31, 2020, we declared and paid $34.1 million in cash dividends. For the year ended December 31, 2019, we declared and paid $26.8 million in cash dividends. For the year ended December 31, 2018, we neither declared nor paid dividends. For the year ended December 31, 2020 and 2019, we purchased 2.3 million and 3.8 million shares of our common stock under the Stock Buyback Program, respectively. We did not purchase any of our common stock during the year ended December 31, 2018.
Capital management consists of providing equity to support our current and future operations. Our regulators view capital levels as important indicators of an institution’s financial soundness. As a general matter, FDIC-insured depository institutions and their holding companies are required to maintain minimum capital relative to the amount and types of assets they hold. We are subject to regulatory capital requirements at the bank holding company and bank levels. See “Item 1. Business—Regulation and Supervision—Regulatory Capital Requirements and Capital Adequacy” and “Item 1. Business—Regulation and Supervision—Prompt Corrective Action” for additional discussion regarding the regulatory capital requirements
71



applicable to us and the Bank. As of December 31, 2020 and 2019, we and the Bank were in compliance with all applicable regulatory capital requirements, and the Bank was classified as “well capitalized” for purposes of the prompt corrective action regulations. As we employ our capital and continue to grow our operations, our regulatory capital levels may decrease depending on our level of earnings. However, we expect to monitor and control our growth in order to remain in compliance with all regulatory capital standards applicable to us.

The following table presents the actual capital amounts and regulatory capital ratios for us and the Bank as of the dates indicated.
 As of December 31,As of December 31,
 20202019
 AmountRatioAmountRatio
 (Dollars in thousands)
Veritex Holdings, Inc.                
Total capital (to risk-weighted assets)$1,099,031 13.57 %$917,939 13.10 %
Tier 1 capital (to risk-weighted assets)782,487 9.66 771,679 11.02 
Common equity tier 1 (to risk-weighted assets)753,261 9.30 742,675 10.60 
Tier 1 capital (to average assets)782,487 9.43 771,679 10.17 
Veritex Community Bank    
Total capital (to risk-weighted assets)$968,481 11.96 %$870,838 12.44 %
Tier 1 capital (to risk-weighted assets)884,471 10.92 840,126 12.00 
Common equity tier 1 (to risk-weighted assets)884,471 10.92 840,126 12.00 
Tier 1 capital (to average assets)884,471 10.66 840,126 11.07 
Contractual Obligations
The following tables summarize our contractual obligations and other commitments to make future payments as of December 31, 2020 and 2019, which consist of our non-cancelable future operating leases, time deposits, future cash payments associated with our contractual obligations pursuant to our FHLB advances, junior subordinated debentures, subordinated debt, securities sold under agreements to repurchase and qualified affordable housing investments. Future payments for FHLB advances will include interest in addition to the principal amount of the advances in the table below that will be paid over future periods. Payments related to leases are based on actual payments specified in underlying contracts. Advances from the FHLB totaled approximately $777.7 million and $677.9 million as of December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively. As of December 31, 2020, the advances are collateralized by a blanket floating lien on certain securities and loans, had a weighted average rate of 0.94% and mature on various dates during 2021 and 2025.
In 2017, we began investing in two qualified housing projects. At December 31, 2020 and 2019, the balance of the investment for qualified affordable housing projects was $2.9 million and $3.3 million, respectively. This balance is reflected in other assets on our consolidated balance sheets. The total unfunded commitment related to the investment in a qualified housing project totaled $362 thousand and $1.1 million at December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively. We expect to fulfill these commitments during the year ending December 31, 2034.

72



 As of December 31, 2020
  More than3 years or  
 1 year1 year but lessmore but less5 years 
 or lessthan 3 yearsthan 5 yearsor moreTotal
 (Dollars in thousands)
Non-cancelable future operating leases$3,637 $6,569 $4,866 $1,325 $16,397 
Time deposits1,194,780 241,967 20,544 — 1,457,291 
Advances from FHLB— 29,258 — 835,095 864,353 
Junior subordinated debentures— — — 30,244 30,244 
Subordinated debt— — — 232,534 232,534 
Securities sold under agreement to repurchase— — — 2,225 2,225 
Qualified affordable housing agreements132 51 89 90 362 
Total$1,198,549 $277,845 $25,499 $1,101,513 $2,603,406 

Off-Balance Sheet Items
In the normal course of business, we enter into various transactions which, in accordance with GAAP, are not included in our consolidated balance sheets. However, we have has only limited off-balance sheet arrangements that have, or are reasonably likely to have, a current or future material effect on our financial condition, revenues, expenses, results of operations, liquidity, capital expenditures or capital resources. We enter into these transactions to meet the financing needs of our customers. These transactions include commitments to extend credit and standby and commercial letters of credit, which involve, to varying degrees, elements of credit risk and interest rate risk in excess of the amounts recognized in the consolidated balance sheets.
Our commitments associated with outstanding standby and commercial letters of credit and commitments to extend credit expiring by the period as of the date indicated are summarized below. Since commitments associated with letters of credit and commitments to extend credit may expire unused, the amounts shown do not necessarily reflect the actual future cash funding requirements.

 As of December 31, 2020
  More than3 years or  
 1 year1 year but lessmore but less5 years 
 or lessthan 3 yearsthan 5 yearsor moreTotal
(Dollars in thousands)
Commitments to extend credit$803,277 $1,229,917 $612,857 $97,520 $2,743,571 
MW commitments113,745 240,858 — — 354,603 
Standby and commercial letters of credit32,293 11,406 268 460 44,427 
Total$949,315 $1,482,181 $613,125 $97,980 $3,142,601 

Standby and commercial letters of credit are written conditional commitments that we issue to guarantee the performance of a customer to a third party. In the event the customer does not perform in accordance with the terms of the agreement with the third party, we would be required to fund the commitment. The maximum potential amount of future payments we could be required to make is represented by the contractual amount of the commitment. If the commitment is funded, the customer is obligated to reimburse us for the amount paid under this standby letter of credit.
Commitments to extend credit are agreements to lend to a customer as long as there is no violation of any condition established in the contract. Commitments generally have fixed expiration dates or other termination clauses and may require payment of a fee. Since many of the commitments are expected to expire without being fully drawn, the total commitment
73



amounts disclosed above do not necessarily represent future cash requirements. Management evaluates each customer’s creditworthiness on a case-by-case basis. The amount of collateral obtained, if considered necessary by us, upon extension of credit, is based on management’s credit evaluation of the borrower.
MW commitments are unconditionally cancellable and represent the unused capacity on MW facilities the Company has approved. The Company reserves the right to refuse to buy any mortgage loans offered for sale by a customer, for any reason, at the Company’s sole and absolute discretion.
Impact of Inflation
Our consolidated financial statements and related notes included elsewhere in this Annual Report on Form 10-K have been prepared in accordance with GAAP. These require the measurement of financial position and operating results in terms of historical dollars, without considering changes in the relative value of money over time due to inflation or recession.
Unlike many industrial companies, substantially all of our assets and liabilities are monetary in nature. As a result, interest rates have a more significant impact on our performance than the effects of general levels of inflation. Interest rates may not necessarily move in the same direction or in the same magnitude as the prices of goods and services. However, other operating expenses do reflect general levels of inflation.

Non-GAAP Financial Measures
Our accounting and reporting policies conform to GAAP and the prevailing practices in the financial services industry. However, we also evaluate our performance by reference to certain additional financial measures discussed in this Annual Report on Form 10-K that we identify as being “non-GAAP financial measures.” In accordance with SEC rules, we classify a financial measure as being a non-GAAP financial measure if that financial measure excludes or includes amounts, or is subject to adjustments that have the effect of excluding or including amounts, that are included or excluded, as the case may be, in the most directly comparable measure calculated and presented in accordance with GAAP as in effect from time to time in the United States in our statements of income, balance sheets or statements of cash flows. Non-GAAP financial measures do not include operating and other statistical measures or ratios or statistical measures calculated using exclusively either financial measures calculated in accordance with GAAP, operating measures or other measures that are not non-GAAP financial measures or both.
The non-GAAP financial measures that we discuss in this Annual Report on Form 10-K should not be considered in isolation or as a substitute for the most directly comparable or other financial measures calculated in accordance with GAAP. Moreover, the manner in which we calculate the non-GAAP financial measures that we discuss in this Annual Report on Form 10-K may differ from that of other companies reporting measures with similar names. You should understand how such other banking organizations calculate their financial measures similar or with names similar to the non-GAAP financial measures we have discussed in this Annual Report on Form 10-K when comparing such non-GAAP financial measures.
Tangible Book Value Per Common Share. Tangible book value is a non-GAAP measure generally used by financial analysts and investment bankers to evaluate financial institutions. We calculate: (a) tangible common equity as total stockholders’ equity less goodwill and core deposit intangibles, net of accumulated amortization; and (b) tangible book value per common share as tangible common equity (as described in clause (a)) divided by the number of common shares outstanding at the end of the relevant period. The most directly comparable financial measure calculated in accordance with GAAP is our book value per common share.

We believe that this measure is important to many investors who are interested in changes from period to period in book value per common share exclusive of changes in intangible assets. Goodwill and core deposit intangibles have the effect of increasing total book value while not increasing our tangible book value.

74



The following table reconciles, as of the dates set forth below, total stockholders’ equity to tangible common equity and presents our tangible book value per common share compared with our book value per common share:

 For the Year Ended December 31,
20202019201820172016
(Dollars in thousands, except per share data)
Tangible Common Equity   
Total stockholders' equity$1,203,376 $1,190,797 $530,638 $488,929 $239,088 
Adjustments:
Goodwill(370,840)(370,840)(161,447)(159,452)(26,865)
Core deposit intangibles(57,758)(67,546)(11,675)(14,313)(1,545)
Tangible common equity$774,778 $752,411 $357,516 $315,164 $210,678 
Common shares outstanding49,340 51,064 24,254 24,110 15,195 
Book value per common share$24.39 $23.32 $21.88 $20.28 $15.73 
Tangible book value per common share$15.70 $14.73 $14.74 $13.07 $13.86 

Tangible Common Equity to Tangible Assets. Tangible common equity to tangible assets is a non-GAAP measure generally used by financial analysts and investment bankers to evaluate financial institutions. We calculate: (a) tangible common equity as total stockholders’ equity, less goodwill and core deposit intangibles, net of accumulated amortization; (b) tangible assets as total assets less goodwill and core deposit intangibles, net of accumulated amortization; and (c) tangible common equity to tangible assets as tangible common equity (as described in clause (a)) divided by tangible assets (as described in clause (b)). The most directly comparable financial measure calculated in accordance with GAAP is total stockholders’ equity to total assets.

We believe that this measure is important to many investors who are interested in the relative changes from period to period in common equity and total assets, in each case, exclusive of changes in intangible assets. Goodwill and core deposit intangibles have the effect of increasing both total stockholders’ equity and assets while not increasing our tangible common equity or tangible assets.

The following table reconciles, as of the dates set forth below, total stockholders’ equity to tangible common equity and total assets to tangible assets and presents our tangible common equity to tangible assets:

 For the Year Ended December 31,
20202019201820172016
(Dollars in thousands)
Tangible Common Equity   
Total stockholders' equity$1,203,376 $1,190,797 $530,638 $488,929 $239,088 
Adjustments:
Goodwill(370,840)(370,840)(161,447)(159,452)(26,865)
Core deposit intangibles(57,758)(67,546)(11,675)(14,313)(1,545)
Tangible common equity$774,778 $752,411 $357,516 $315,164 $210,678 
Tangible Assets
Total assets$8,820,871 $7,954,937 $3,208,550 $2,945,583 $1,408,507 
Adjustments:
Goodwill(370,840)(370,840)(161,447)(159,452)(26,865)
Core deposit intangibles)
(57,758)(67,546)(11,675)(14,313)(1,545)
Tangible assets$8,392,273 $7,516,551 $3,035,428 $2,771,818 $1,380,097 
Tangible Common Equity to Tangible Assets9.23 %10.01 %11.78 %11.37 %15.27 %
.

75



Critical Accounting Policies
Our consolidated financial statements are prepared in accordance with GAAP and with general practices within the financial services industry. Application of these principles requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the amounts reported in the financial statements and accompanying notes. We base our estimates on historical experience and on various other assumptions that we believe to be reasonable under current circumstances. These assumptions form the basis for our judgments about the carrying values of assets and liabilities that are not readily available from independent, objective sources. We evaluate our estimates on an ongoing basis. Use of alternative assumptions may have resulted in significantly different estimates. Actual results may differ from these estimates.
We have identified the following accounting policies and estimates that, due to the difficult, subjective or complex judgments and assumptions inherent in those policies and estimates and the potential sensitivity of our financial statements to those judgments and assumptions, are critical to an understanding of our financial condition and results of operations. We believe that the judgments, estimates and assumptions used in the preparation of our financial statements are appropriate.
Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses
Management considers the policies related to the allowance for credit losses as the most critical to the financial statement presentation. The total allowance for credit losses includes activity related to allowances calculated in accordance with ASC 310, "Receivables", and ASC 450, "Contingencies". On January 1, 2020, we adopted ASU 2016-13, Financial Instruments-Credit Losses (Topic 326): Measurement of Credit Losses on Financial Instruments (“ASU 2016-13”). The impact of adopting this standard resulted in an increase in our allowance for credit losses of $39.1 million. The allowance for credit losses is established through a provision for loan losses charged to current earnings. The amount maintained in the allowance reflects management’s estimate of expected credit losses in the loan portfolio at the report date. The allowance for credit losses is comprised of specific reserves assigned to certain impaired loans and general reserves. Factors contributing to the determination of specific reserves include the creditworthiness of the borrower, and more specifically, changes in the expected future receipt of principal and interest payments and/or in the value of pledged collateral. A reserve is recorded when the carrying amount of the loan exceeds the discounted estimated cash flows using the loan’s initial effective interest rate or the fair value of the collateral for certain collateral dependent loans. For purposes of establishing the general reserve, we stratify the loan portfolio into homogeneous groups of loans that possess similar loss potential characteristics and apply a loss ratio to these groups of loans to estimate the credit losses in the loan portfolio. We use both historical loss ratios and qualitative loss factors assigned to major loan collateral types to establish general component loss allocations. Refer to “Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses” in Note 1 of the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements contained in Item 8 of this report for further discussion of the factors considered by management in establishing the allowance for credit loss.
Business Combinations 
We apply the acquisition method of accounting for business combinations. Under the acquisition method, the acquiring entity in a business combination recognizes 100% of the assets acquired and liabilities assumed at their acquisition date fair values. We use valuation techniques appropriate for the asset or liability being measured in determining these fair values. Any excess of the purchase price over amounts allocated to assets acquired, including identifiable intangible assets and liabilities assumed, is recorded as goodwill. Where amounts allocated to assets acquired and liabilities assumed is greater than the purchase price, a bargain purchase gain is recognized. Acquisition-related costs are expensed as incurred. 
Debt Securities
Securities are classified as held to maturity and carried at amortized cost when we have the positive intent and ability to hold them until maturity. Securities to be held for indefinite periods of time are classified as available for sale and carried at fair value, with the unrealized holding gains and losses reported in other comprehensive income, net of tax. We determine the appropriate classification of securities at the time of purchase.
Interest income includes amortization of purchase premiums and discounts. Realized gains and losses are derived from the amortized cost of the security sold. Credit related declines in the fair value of held to maturity and available for sale debt securities below their cost that are deemed to be other than temporary are reflected in earnings as realized losses, with the remaining unrealized loss recognized as a component of other comprehensive income. In estimating allowance for credit losses, we consider, among other things, (1) the length of time and the extent to which the fair value has been less than cost, (2) the financial condition and near-term prospects of the issuer, and (3) the intent and our ability to retain the investment in the issuer for a period of time sufficient to allow for any anticipated recovery in fair value.
76



Goodwill
Goodwill resulting from a business combination represents the excess of the fair value of the consideration transferred over the fair value of the net assets acquired and liabilities assumed as of the acquisition date. Goodwill is not amortized but is reviewed for potential impairment annually on October 31 of each fiscal year or when a triggering event occurs.

We may first assess qualitative factors to determine whether it is more likely than not (that is, a likelihood of more than 50%) that the fair value of a reporting unit is less than its carrying amount, including goodwill. We have an unconditional option to bypass the qualitative assessment for any reporting unit in any period and proceed directly to performing the quantitative goodwill impairment test, and we may resume performing the qualitative assessment in any subsequent period. If we determine that it is more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit is less than its carrying amount, then we perform the quantitative goodwill impairment test. The quantitative goodwill impairment test, used to identify both the existence of potential impairment and the amount of impairment loss, involves estimating the fair value of a reporting unit with its carrying amount, including goodwill. If the carrying amount of a reporting unit exceeds its fair value, an impairment loss shall be recognized in an amount equal to that excess, limited to the total amount of goodwill allocated to that reporting unit. Any such adjustments to goodwill are reflected in the results of operations in the periods in which they become known.

Estimating the fair values of a reporting unit involves the use of significant assumptions, estimates and judgments with respect to a variety of factors, including revenues, capital expenditures, cash flows and the selection and use of an appropriate discount rate and market values and multiples of earnings and revenues of similar public companies. Projected sales and capital expenditures are based on our annual business plan or other forecasted results. Discount rates reflect market-based estimates of the risks associated with the projected cash flows of the reporting unit.

The use of different assumptions, estimates or judgments in the goodwill impairment testing process, including with respect to the estimated future cash flows of our reporting unit, the discount rate used to discount such estimated cash flows to their net present value, and the reasonableness of the resultant implied control premium relative to our market capitalization, could materially increase or decrease the fair value of the reporting unit and/or its net assets and, accordingly, could materially increase or decrease any related impairment charge.

During the second quarter of 2020, the Company observed a sustained decline in the market valuation of the Company’s common stock as a result of continued economic disruption occurring after the first quarter of 2020 primarily due to the COVID-19 pandemic. As a result, the Company determined that it was more likely than not that the fair value of the Company’s sole reporting unit was below its carrying value and proceeded to perform an interim quantitative impairment test. The Company determined the fair value of its reporting unit using a combination of a market and an income approach. Upon completion of quantitative evaluation, the Company determined that, as of June 30, 2020, the fair value of the Company's reporting unit exceeded its related carrying value, and therefore goodwill was not impaired.

The Company performed its annual goodwill impairment test as of October 31, 2020 using a qualitative impairment assessment and determined that it was not more likely than not that the fair value of our reporting unit was less than its carrying amount. The Company also did not identify any potential impairment indicators subsequent to our annual assessment.

Recent Accounting Pronouncements
Refer to “Recent Accounting Pronouncements” in Note 3 of the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements contained in Item 8 of this report for further discussion.

77



Special Cautionary Notice Regarding Forward-Looking Statements
This Annual Report on Form 10-K contains certain “forward-looking statements” within the meaning of the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995. Forward-looking statements are based on various facts and derived utilizing assumptions, current expectations, estimates and projections and are subject to known and unknown risks, uncertainties and other factors that may cause actual results, performance or achievements to be materially different from any future results, performance or achievements expressed or implied by such forward-looking statements. Forward-looking statements include, without limitation, statements relating to the expected payment date of our quarterly cash dividend, impact of certain changes in our accounting policies, standards and interpretations, the effects of the COVID-19 pandemic and actions taken in response thereto, our future financial performance, business and growth strategy, projected plans and objectives, as well as other projections based on macroeconomic and industry trends, which are inherently unreliable due to the multiple factors that impact broader economic and industry trends, and any such variations may be material. Statements preceded by, followed by or that otherwise include the words “believes,” “expects,” “anticipates,” “intends,” “projects,” “estimates,” “plans” and similar expressions or future or conditional verbs such as “will,” “should,” “would,” “may” and “could” are generally forward-looking in nature and not historical facts, although not all forward-looking statements include the foregoing words. You should understand that the following important factors could affect our future results and cause actual results to differ materially from those expressed in the forward-looking statements:

risks related to the concentration of our business in Texas, and specifically within the Dallas-Fort Worth metroplex and the Houston metropolitan area, including risks associated with any downturn in the real estate sector and risks associated with a decline in the values of single family homes in the Dallas-Fort Worth metroplex and the Houston metropolitan area;
uncertain market conditions and economic trends nationally, regionally and particularly in the Dallas-Fort Worth metroplex and Texas, including as a result of the COVID-19 pandemic;
risks related to the impact of the COVID-19 pandemic on our business and operations;
possible additional loan losses and impairment of the collectibility of loans, particularly as a result of the COVID-19 pandemic and the programs implemented by the CARES Act, including its automatic loan forbearance provisions, and our PPP lending activities;
the effects of regional or national civil unrest;
changes in market interest rates that affect the pricing of our loans and deposits and our net interest income;
risks related to our strategic focus on lending to small to medium-sized businesses;
the sufficiency of the assumptions and estimates we make in establishing reserves for potential loan losses;
our ability to implement our growth strategy, including identifying and consummating suitable acquisitions;
our ability to recruit and retain successful bankers that meet our expectations in terms of customer relationships and profitability;
changes in our accounting policies, standards and interpretations;
our ability to retain executive officers and key employees and their customer and community relationships;
risks associated with our commercial real estate and construction loan portfolios, including the risks inherent in the valuation of the collateral securing such loans;
risks associated with our commercial loan portfolio, including the risk of deterioration in value of the general business assets that generally secure such loans;
our level of nonperforming assets and the costs associated with resolving problem loans, if any, and complying with government-imposed foreclosure moratoriums;
potential changes in the prices, values and sales volumes of commercial and residential real estate securing our real estate loans;
risks related to the significant amount of credit that we have extended to a limited number of borrowers and in a limited geographic area;
our ability to maintain adequate liquidity (including in compliance with CBLR standards and the effect of the transition to the CECL methodology for allowances and related adjustments) and to raise necessary capital to fund our acquisition strategy and operations or to meet increased minimum regulatory capital levels;
potential fluctuations in the market value and liquidity of our debt securities;
the effects of competition from a wide variety of local, regional, national and other providers of financial, investment and insurance services;
our ability to maintain an effective system of disclosure controls and procedures and internal control over financial reporting;
risks associated with fraudulent and negligent acts by our customers, employees or vendors;
our ability to keep pace with technological change or difficulties when implementing new technologies;
risks associated with difficulties and/or terminations with third-party service providers and the services they provide;
risks associated with unauthorized access, cyber-crime and other threats to data security;
78



potential impairment on the goodwill we have recorded or may record in connection with business acquisitions;
our ability to comply with various governmental and regulatory requirements applicable to financial institutions;
the impact of recent and future legislative and regulatory changes, including changes in banking, securities and tax laws and regulations and their application by our regulators, and economic stimulus programs;
uncertainty regarding the future of LIBOR and any replacement alternatives on our business;
governmental monetary and fiscal policies, including the policies of the Federal Reserve;
our ability to comply with supervisory actions by federal and state banking agencies;
changes in the scope and cost of FDIC, insurance and other coverage; and
systemic risks associated with the soundness of other financial institutions

Other factors not identified above, including those described under the headings “Risk Factors” and “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” in this Annual Report on Form 10-K, may also cause actual results to differ materially from those described in our forward-looking statements. Most of these factors are difficult to anticipate and are generally beyond our control. You should consider these factors in connection with considering any forward-looking statements that may be made by us. We undertake no obligation to release publicly any revisions to any forward-looking statements, to report events or to report the occurrence of unanticipated events unless we are required to do so by law.
79




ITEM 7A.  QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK
Interest Rate Sensitivity and Market Risk
As a financial institution, our primary component of market risk is interest rate volatility. Our asset, liability and funds management policy provides management with the guidelines for effective funds management, and we have established a measurement system for monitoring our net interest rate sensitivity position. We manage our sensitivity position within our established guidelines.
Fluctuations in interest rates will ultimately impact both the level of income and expense recorded on most of our assets and liabilities, and the market value of all interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities, other than those which have a short term to maturity. Interest rate risk is the potential of economic losses due to future interest rate changes. These economic losses can be reflected as a loss of future net interest income and/or a loss of current fair market values. The objective is to measure the effect on net interest income and to adjust the balance sheet to minimize the inherent risk while at the same time maximizing income.
We manage our exposure to interest rates by structuring our balance sheet in the ordinary course of business. With exception of an interest rate floor, which is designated as a hedging instrument, for a notional amount of $275.0 million, we do not enter into instruments such as leveraged derivatives, interest rate swaps, financial options, financial future contracts or forward delivery contracts for the purpose of reducing interest rate risk. We enter into interest rate swaps, caps and collars as an accommodation to our customers in connection with our interest rate swap program. Based upon the nature of our operations, we are not subject to foreign exchange or commodity price risk. We do not own any trading assets.
Our exposure to interest rate risk is managed by the Asset-Liability Committee of the Bank in accordance with policies approved by its board of directors. The committee formulates strategies based on appropriate levels of interest rate risk. In determining the appropriate level of interest rate risk, the committee considers the impact on earnings and capital of the current outlook on interest rates, potential changes in interest rates, regional economies, liquidity, business strategies and other factors. The committee meets regularly to review, among other things, the sensitivity of assets and liabilities to interest rate changes, the book and market values of assets and liabilities, unrealized gains and losses, purchase and sale activities, commitments to originate loans and the maturities of investments and borrowings. Additionally, the committee reviews liquidity, cash flow flexibility, maturities of deposits and consumer and commercial deposit activity. Management employs methodologies to manage interest rate risk, which include an analysis of relationships between interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities, and an interest rate shock simulation model.
We use an interest rate risk simulation model and shock analysis to test the interest rate sensitivity of net interest income and the balance sheet, respectively. Contractual maturities and repricing opportunities of loans are incorporated in the model as are prepayment assumptions, maturity data and call options within the investment portfolio.
We utilize static balance sheet rate shocks to estimate the potential impact on net interest income of changes in interest
rates under various rate scenarios. This analysis estimates a percentage of change in the metric from the stable rate base scenario versus alternative scenarios of rising and falling market interest rates by instantaneously shocking a static balance sheet.  Internal policy regarding internal rate risk simulations currently specifies that for instantaneous parallel shifts of the yield curve, estimated net income at risk for the subsequent one-year period should not decline by more than 5.0% for a 100 basis point shift, 10.0% for a 200 basis point shift, and 15.0% for a 300 basis point shift.

80



The following table summarizes the simulated change in net interest income and fair value of equity over a 12-month horizon as of the dates indicated:
 As of December 31, 2020As of December 31, 2019
 Percent ChangePercent ChangePercent ChangePercent Change
Change in Interestin Net Interestin Fair Valuein Net Interestin Fair Value
Rates (Basis Points)Incomeof EquityIncomeof Equity
+30018.91 %29.38 %14.51 %12.01 %
+20012.06 19.93 9.89 9.42 
+1005.37 9.64 5.17 5.76 
Base— — — — 
−100(1.77)(10.87)(3.99)(8.03)
The results are primarily due to behavior of demand, money market and savings deposits during such rate fluctuations. We have found that, historically, interest rates on these deposits change more slowly than changes in the discount and federal funds rates. This assumption is incorporated into the simulation model and is generally not fully reflected in a gap analysis. The assumptions incorporated into the model are inherently uncertain and, as a result, the model cannot precisely measure future net interest income or precisely predict the impact of fluctuations in market interest rates on net interest income. Actual results will differ from the model’s simulated results due to timing, magnitude and frequency of interest rate changes as well as changes in market conditions and the application and timing of various strategies.

ITEM 8.  FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA
The financial statements, the reports thereon, the notes thereto and supplementary data commence on page F-1 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K. See Item 15.  Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules.

ITEM 9.  CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON ACCOUNT AND FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE
None.
81




ITEM 9A.  CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES
Evaluation of Disclosure Controls and Procedures
Our management, with the supervision and participation of our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, has evaluated the effectiveness of the design and operation of our disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “Exchange Act”)) as of the end of the period covered by this report. Management recognizes that any controls and procedures, no matter how well designed and operated, can provide only reasonable assurance of achieving their objectives and management necessarily applies its judgment in evaluating the cost-benefit relationship of possible controls and procedures. Based upon that evaluation, our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer have concluded that, as of the end of such period, our disclosure controls and procedures were effective in recording, processing, summarizing and reporting, on a timely basis, information required to be disclosed by us in the reports that we file or submit under the Exchange Act and were effective in ensuring that information required to be disclosed by us in the reports that we file or submit under the Exchange Act is accumulated and communicated to the Company’s management, including our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, as appropriate to allow timely decisions regarding required disclosure. In making this determination, our management, with the supervision and participation of our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, considered a reportable event on a Current Report on Form 8-K that occurred after the end of the period covered by this report, which was untimely but eventually filed with the SEC, and which management believes does not change the effectiveness of our disclosure controls as of the end of the period covered by this report.

Changes in Internal Control over Financial Reporting
There were no changes in our internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(f) under the Exchange Act) during the fourth quarter of 2020 that have materially affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal control over financial reporting.
Management’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting
Our management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting. Our internal control over financial reporting is a process designed under the supervision of our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of our financial statements for external purposes in accordance with GAAP.
As of December 31, 2020, management assessed the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting based on the criteria for effective internal control over financial reporting established in “Internal Control—Integrated Framework (2013),” issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations (COSO) of the Treadway Commission. Based on the assessment, management determined that we maintained effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2020.
Grant Thornton LLP, the independent registered public accounting firm that audited the consolidated financial statements of Veritex included in this Annual Report on Form 10-K, has issued an attestation report on the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2020. The report, which expresses an unqualified opinion on the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2020, is included in this Item under the heading “Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm.”
82




Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
Board of Directors and Stockholders
Veritex Holdings, Inc.

Opinion on internal control over financial reporting
We have audited the internal control over financial reporting of Veritex Holdings, Inc. (a Texas corporation) and subsidiaries (collectively, the “Company”) as of December 31, 2020, based on criteria established in the 2013 Internal Control—Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (“COSO”). In our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2020, based on criteria established in the 2013 Internal Control—Integrated Framework issued by COSO.

We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (“PCAOB”), the consolidated financial statements of the Company as of and for the year ended December 31, 2020, and our report dated February 26, 2021, expressed an unqualified opinion on those financial statements.

Basis for opinion

The Company’s management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying Management’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audit. We are a public accounting firm registered with the PCAOB and are required to be independent with respect to the Company in accordance with the U.S. federal securities laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.

We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk, and performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.

Definition and limitations of internal control over financial reporting

A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

/s/ GRANT THORNTON LLP
Dallas, Texas
February 26, 2021
83




ITEM 9B.  OTHER INFORMATION
None.
84



PART III

ITEM 10.  DIRECTORS, EXECUTIVE OFFICERS AND CORPORATE GOVERNANCE.
The information called for by this item is set forth in our Definitive Proxy Statement relating to the 2021 Annual Meeting of Shareholders (the “2021 Proxy Statement”), to be filed with the SEC within 120 days of the end of the fiscal year ended December 31, 2020, and is incorporated herein by reference.

ITEM 11.  EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION.
The information called for by this item is set forth in our 2021 Proxy Statement, and is incorporated herein by reference.

ITEM 12.  SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT AND RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS.
The information called for by this item is set forth in our 2021 Proxy Statement, and is incorporated herein by reference.

ITEM 13.  CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS, AND DIRECTOR INDEPENDENCE.
The information called for by this item is set forth in our 2021 Proxy Statement, and is incorporated herein by reference.

ITEM 14.  PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTANT FEES AND SERVICES.
The information called for by this item is set forth in our 2021 Proxy Statement, and is incorporated herein by reference.

PART IV
ITEM 15.  EXHIBITS AND FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES
(a)The following documents are filed as part of this report:
1.Financial Statements:
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2020 and 2019
Consolidated Statements of Income for the years ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018
Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income for the years ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018
Consolidated Statements of Changes in Stockholders’ Equity for the years ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the years ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements
2.Financial Statement Schedules: All supplemental schedules to the consolidated financial statements have been omitted as inapplicable or because the required information is included in our consolidated financial statements or the notes thereto included in this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
3.Exhibits.
85



REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM



Board of Directors and Stockholders
Veritex Holdings, Inc.

Opinion on the financial statements

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Veritex Holdings, Inc. (a Texas corporation) and subsidiaries (collectively, the “Company”) as of December 31, 2020 and 2019, the related consolidated statements of income, comprehensive income, changes in stockholders’ equity, and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2020, and the related notes (collectively referred to as the “financial statements”). In our opinion, the financial statements present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the Company as of December 31, 2020 and 2019, and the results of its operations and its cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2020, in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America.

We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (“PCAOB”), the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2020, based on criteria established in the 2013 Internal Control—Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (“COSO”), and our report dated February 26, 2021 expressed an unqualified opinion.

Change in accounting principle

As discussed in Note 1 of the financial statements, the Company changed its method of accounting for credit losses effective January 1, 2020 due to the adoption of Accounting Standards Codification (“ASC”) 326, Financial Instruments – Credit Losses.

Basis for opinion

These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s financial statements based on our audits. We are a public accounting firm registered with the PCAOB and are required to be independent with respect to the Company in accordance with the U.S. federal securities laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement, whether due to error or fraud. Our audits included performing procedures to assess the risks of material misstatement of the financial statements, whether due to error or fraud, and performing procedures that respond to those risks. Such procedures included examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. Our audits also included evaluating the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the financial statements. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

Critical audit matter

The critical audit matter communicated below is a matter arising from the current period audit of the financial statements that was communicated or required to be communicated to the audit committee and that: (1) relates to accounts or disclosures that are material to the financial statements and (2) involved our especially challenging, subjective, or complex judgments. The communication of critical audit matters does not alter in any way our opinion on the financial statements, taken as a whole, and we are not, by communicating the critical audit matter below, providing a separate opinion on the critical audit matter or on the accounts or disclosures to which it relates.

F-1



Allowance for credit losses on the loan portfolio

As described further in Notes 1 and 6 to the consolidated financial statements, the Company adopted ASU 2016-13, Financial Instruments – Credit Losses (“ASC 326”) on January 1, 2020. The Company measures expected credit losses of financial assets on a collective (pooled) basis, when the financial assets share similar risk characteristics. The Company’s discounted cash flow model for estimating the allowance for credit losses (“ACL”) on the loan portfolio considers available relevant information about the collectability of cash flows, including information about past events, current conditions, and reasonable and supportable forecasts. The discounted cash flow method applies historical loss information, adjusted for asset-specific characteristics, economic conditions at the measurement date, and forecasts about future economic conditions expected to exist through the contractual lives of the loans that are reasonable and supportable. The Company uses regression analyses of historical internal and peer data to determine suitable loss drivers to utilize when modeling the lifetime probability of default and loss given default, which are inputs into the discounted cash flow analysis. Loans that do not share risk characteristics are evaluated individually, which may be based on the fair value of the collateral or a discounted cash flow model of expected cash flows. We identified the implementation and year-end estimate of the allowance for credit losses on the loan portfolio as a critical audit matter.

The principal consideration for our determination that the allowance for credit losses on the loan portfolio represents a critical audit matter is that management made significant judgements in estimating the ACL, specifically regarding key assumptions such as the applicable loss drivers for collectively evaluated segments of the loan portfolio and the timing and amount of cash flows for individually analyzed loans. Due to the significant judgment involved and related measurement uncertainty in calculating the ACL, there was a high degree of auditor judgment in identifying the significant assumptions and evaluating their reasonableness. This resulted in an increased extent of audit effort, including the involvement of specialists, when performing audit procedures to evaluate the ACL.

Our audit procedures related to the ACL included the following, among others:

We tested the design and operating effectiveness of management’s review controls over the ACL relating to the initial adoption of ASC 326 and as of the year end measurement date, which included committee oversight and approval of the Company’s ACL methodology and key assumptions used, model selection and validation, segmentation of the loan portfolio, assessing the necessity and application of qualitative factors, and computation of reserves for loans that were individually analyzed.
We tested management’s process for estimating the ACL on loans evaluated collectively at implementation and as of the year end measurement date, which included concluding on the segmentation of the loan portfolio into pools of shared risk characteristics, obtaining complete and accurate information to determine suitable loss drivers, and consideration of the reasonableness of qualitative factors applied or not applied.
We reperformed the calculation within the models utilized for the discount cash flow methods used to estimate expected credit losses on loans evaluated collectively for an ACL.
For a sample of loans that were individually analyzed, we evaluated management’s assumptions for those reserves, including the review of collateral valuations by our specialists.
With the assistance of our specialists, for loans evaluated collectively, we assessed the suitability of the loss driver analysis and the conceptual soundness and design of the model used by the Company.

/s/ GRANT THORNTON LLP

We have served as the Company’s auditor since 2014.


Dallas, Texas
February 26, 2021
F-2



VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
Consolidated Balance Sheets
December 31, 2020 and 2019
(Dollars in thousands, except par value information)
 December 31,December 31,
 20202019
ASSETS        
Cash and due from banks$44,337 $65,151 
Interest bearing deposits in other banks186,488 186,399 
Total cash and cash equivalents230,825 251,550 
Debt securities available-for-sale, at fair value1,024,329 964,365 
Debt securities held-to-maturity (fair value of $34,283 and $34,810 at December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively)
30,872 32,965 
Equity securities14,938 14,697 
Investment in unconsolidated subsidiaries 1,018 1,018 
Federal Home Loan Bank ("FHLB") and Federal Reserve Bank ("FRB") stock 71,236 68,348 
Total investments1,142,393 1,081,393 
Loans held for sale21,414 14,080 
Loans held for investment, Paycheck Protection Program ("PPP") loans, carried at fair value358,042 — 
Loans held for investment, mortgage warehouse ("MW")577,594 183,628 
Loans held for investment, excluding MW and PPP5,847,862 5,737,577 
Less: Allowance for credit losses ("ACL")(105,084)(29,834)
Total loans held for investment, net6,678,414 5,891,371 
Bank-owned life insurance82,855 80,915 
Bank premises, furniture and equipment, net115,063 118,536 
Other real estate owned2,337 5,995 
Intangible assets, net of accumulated amortization61,733 72,263 
Goodwill370,840 370,840 
Other assets114,997 67,994 
Total assets$8,820,871 $7,954,937 
LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY  
Deposits:  
Noninterest-bearing deposits$2,097,099 $1,556,500 
Interest-bearing transaction and savings deposits2,958,456 2,654,972 
Certificates and other time deposits1,457,291 1,682,878 
Total deposits6,512,846 5,894,350 
Accounts payable and other liabilities61,928 43,996 
Advances from FHLB777,718 677,870 
Subordinated debentures and subordinated notes262,778 145,571 
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase2,225 2,353 
Total liabilities7,617,495 6,764,140 
Commitments and contingencies (Note 16)
Stockholders’ equity:  
Common stock, $0.01 par value; 75,000,000 shares authorized at December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019; 55,500,118 and 54,876,580 shares issued at December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019, respectively; 49,337,768 and 51,063,869 shares outstanding at December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019, respectively.
555 549 
Additional paid-in capital1,126,437 1,117,879 
Retained earnings172,232 147,911 
Accumulated other comprehensive income56,225 19,061 
Treasury stock, 6,162,350 and 3,812,711 shares at cost at December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively
(152,073)(94,603)
Total stockholders’ equity1,203,376 1,190,797 
Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity$8,820,871 $7,954,937 
 See accompanying Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
F-3



VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
Consolidated Statements of Income
Years Ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018
(Dollars in thousands, except per share amounts)
 Year Ended December 31,
 202020192018
Interest income:            
Loans, including fees$286,583 $340,813 $134,460 
Debt securities30,726 29,484 6,605 
Deposits in financial institutions and Fed Funds sold1,221 5,540 3,149 
Equity securities and other investments3,320 2,949 855 
Total interest and dividend income321,850 378,786 145,069 
Interest expense:   
Transaction and savings deposits13,233 40,355 17,599 
Certificates and other time deposits23,678 38,675 9,714 
Advances from FHLB10,609 9,984 1,701 
Subordinated debentures and subordinated notes8,532 4,675 1,031 
Total interest expense56,052 93,689 30,045 
Net interest income265,798 285,097 115,024 
Provision for credit losses 56,640 21,514 6,603 
Provision for credit losses on unfunded commitments9,029 — — 
Net interest income after provision for credit losses200,129 263,583 108,421 
Noninterest income:   
Service charges and fees on deposit accounts13,703 14,334 3,420 
Loan fees4,556 7,782 1,332 
Gain (loss) on sales of securities2,615 (1,852)(64)
Gain on sale of mortgage loans held for sale1,239 475 709 
Government guaranteed loan income, net14,150 4,709 2,347 
Rental income2,179 2,172 2,130 
Other8,902 2,460 1,201 
Total noninterest income47,344 30,080 11,075 
Noninterest expense:   
Salaries and employee benefits79,453 72,791 31,138 
Occupancy and equipment16,363 16,385 10,679 
Professional and regulatory fees11,729 11,597 7,282 
Data processing and software expense9,213 8,365 3,020 
Marketing3,651 3,259 1,783 
Amortization of intangibles10,790 10,887 3,467 
Telephone and communications1,312 1,847 1,299 
Merger and acquisition expense— 38,960 5,220 
COVID expenses1,377 — — 
Debt extinguishment costs11,307 — — 
Other14,192 13,712 5,371 
Total noninterest expense159,387 177,803 69,259 
Income before income tax expense88,086 115,860 50,237 
Income tax expense14,203 25,121 10,896 
Net income$73,883 $90,739 $39,341 
Net income available to common stockholders$73,883 $90,739 $39,341 
Basic earnings per share$1.48 $1.71 $1.63 
Diluted earnings per share$1.48 $1.68 $1.60 
See accompanying Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
F-4




VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income
Years Ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018
(Dollars in thousands)

 Year Ended December 31,
 202020192018
Net income$73,883 $90,739 $39,341 
Other comprehensive income (loss):   
Net unrealized gains (losses) on securities available-for-sale:
Change in net unrealized gains (losses) on securities available-for-sale during the period, net35,400 24,091 (2,153)
Reclassification adjustment for net (gains) losses included in net income(2,623)1,852 (64)
Net unrealized gains (losses) on securities available-for-sale32,777 25,943 (2,089)
Net unrealized gains on derivative instruments designated as cash flow hedges14,657 1,497 — 
Other comprehensive income (loss), before tax47,434 27,440 (2,089)
Income tax expense (benefit)10,270 5,449 (439)
Other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax37,164 21,991 (1,650)
Comprehensive income$111,047 $112,730 $37,691 
 
See accompanying Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements


F-5



VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
Consolidated Statements of Changes in Stockholders’ Equity
Years Ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018
(Dollars in thousands)
 Common StockTreasury StockAdditional
Paid-In
Capital
Retained
Earnings
Accumulated
Other
Comprehensive
Income (Loss)
Unallocated 
Employee
Stock
Ownership
Plan Shares
 
 SharesAmountSharesAmountTotal
Balance at January 1, 201824,109,515 $241 10,000 $(70)$445,517 $44,627 $(1,280)$(106)$488,929 
Restricted stock units vested, net of 20,082 shares withheld to cover taxes
105,765 — — (595)— — — (593)
Exercise of employee stock options, net of 1,691 and 4,391 shares withheld to cover taxes and cashless exercise, respectively
38,614 — — — 454 — — — 454 
Stock based compensation— — — — 4,048 — — — 4,048 
ESOP Shares Allocated— — — — — — 106 109 
Net income— — — 39,341 — — 39,341 
Other comprehensive loss— — — — — — (1,650)— (1,650)
Balance at December 31, 201824,253,894 $243 10,000 $(70)$449,427 $83,968 $(2,930)$— $530,638 
Issuance of common shares in connection with the acquisition of Green Bancorp, Inc. ("Green"), net of offering costs of $788
29,532,957 295 — — 630,332 — — — 630,627 
Issuance of common stock in connection with the acquisition of Green for vested restricted stock units, net of 25,872 shares for taxes
497,594 — — 12,479 — — — 12,484 
Restricted stock units vested, net of 55,946 shares withheld to cover taxes
246,303 — — (1,349)— — — (1,346)
Exercise of employee stock options, net of 13,709 shares withheld to cover taxes
335,832 — — 3,935 — — — 3,938 
Stock buyback(3,802,711)— 3,802,711 (94,533)— — — — (94,533)
Stock based compensation— — — — 21,652 — — — 21,652 
Reclassification of liability-classified awards to equity awards— — — — 1,403 — — — 1,403 
Net income— — — — — 90,739 — — 90,739 
Dividends paid— — — — — (26,796)— — (26,796)
Other comprehensive income— — — — — — 21,991 — 21,991 
Balance at December 31, 201951,063,869 $549 3,812,711 $(94,603)$1,117,879 $147,911 $19,061 $— $1,190,797 
Restricted stock units vested, net of 22,404 shares withheld to cover taxes
111,558 — — (666)— — — (665)
Exercise of employee stock options, net of 100,400 and 145,044 shares withheld to cover taxes and exercise, respectively
501,980 — — 1,132 — — — 1,137 
Stock warrants exercised10,000 — — — 109 — — — 109 
Stock buyback(2,349,639)— 2,349,639 (57,470)— — — — (57,470)
Stock based compensation— — — — 7,983 — — — 7,983 
Net income— — — — — 73,883 — — 73,883 
Dividends paid— — — — — (34,057)— — (34,057)
CECL impact on date of adoption— — — — — (15,505)— — (15,505)
Other comprehensive income— — — — — — 37,164 — 37,164 
Balance at December 31, 202049,337,768 $555 6,162,350 $(152,073)$1,126,437 $172,232 $56,225 $— $1,203,376 
See accompanying Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
F-6



VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows
Years Ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018
(Dollars in thousands)
 Year Ended December 31,
 202020192018
Cash flows from operating activities:            
Net income$73,883 $90,739 $39,341 
Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating activities:
Depreciation and amortization of fixed assets and intangibles15,832 15,933 7,077 
Net accretion of time deposit premium, debt discount and debt issuance costs(1,735)(8,950)
Provision for credit losses65,669 21,514 6,603 
Accretion of loan purchase discount(14,060)(28,603)(8,135)
Stock-based compensation expense7,983 21,652 4,048 
Compensation expense, liability-classified awards— 1,403 — 
Excess tax (benefit) expense from stock compensation(1,435)205 (248)
Deferred tax (benefit) expense(9,384)9,053 2,707 
Net amortization of premiums on debt securities3,236 2,875 1,931 
Unrealized gains on equity securities recognized in earnings(480)(325)— 
Change in net cash surrender value of bank owned life insurance(1,940)(2,010)(588)
Net (gain) loss on sales of securities(2,615)1,852 64 
Change in fair value of government guaranteed loans using fair value option2,040 (303)— 
Gain on sales of mortgage loans held for sale(1,239)(475)(708)
Gain on sales of government guaranteed loans(3,379)(4,388)(2,348)
Net impairment on servicing asset368 188 — 
Net gain on sales of other real estate owned(693)— — 
Write down on other real estate owned— — 156 
Originations of loans held for sale(132,842)(37,166)(35,936)
Proceeds from sale of loans held for sale125,375 34,483 36,227 
Net loss (gain) on sale of branches— 474 (349)
Gain on sale of bank premises, furniture and equipment(358)— — 
(Increase) decrease in other assets(20,546)2,196 (425)
Increase (decrease) in accounts payable and other liabilities3,970 (16,387)969 
Net cash provided by operating activities107,650 103,960 50,388 
Cash flows from investing activities:
Net cash received in acquisition— 112,710 — 
Cash settlement for sale of held for sale branches— 7,153 (31,810)
Purchases of available for sale debt securities (1,175,050)(745,297)(811,055)
Proceeds from sales of available for sale debt securities 113,771 567,718 40,822 
Proceeds from maturities, calls and pay downs of available for sale debt securities1,033,779 131,788 731,572 
Purchases of held to maturity debt securities — (8,084)— 
Maturity, calls and pay downs of held to maturity debt securities 1,793 1,249 — 
Purchases of other investments(2,888)(23,577)(9,090)
Proceeds from sales of equity securities221 — — 
Net loans held for investment originated(897,455)(151,559)(344,737)
Proceeds from sale of government guaranteed loans44,867 69,218 29,010 
Net additions to bank premises and equipment(2,864)(7,658)(5,013)
Proceeds from sales of bank premises, furniture and equipment2,157 — — 
Proceeds from sales of other real estate owned and repossessed assets7,114 — 291 
Net cash used in investing activities(874,555)(46,339)(400,010)
Cash flows from financing activities:
Net increase (decrease) in deposits619,380 (195,761)344,101 
Net increase (decrease) in advances from FHLB99,848 349,851 (43,145)
Redemption of subordinated debt(5,000)— — 
Net change in other borrowings— — (15,000)
Proceeds from issuance of subordinated notes, net of debt issuance costs paid123,026 75,000 — 
Net decrease in securities sold under agreement to repurchase(128)(873)— 
Proceeds from exercise of employee stock options4,301 3,938 454 
Payments to tax authorities for stock-based compensation(3,829)(1,346)(593)
Proceeds from exercise of stock warrants109 — — 
Proceeds from payments on ESOP loan— — 109 
Purchase of treasury stock(57,470)(94,533)— 
Dividends paid(34,057)(26,796)— 
Offering costs paid in connection with acquisition— — (899)
Net cash provided by financing activities746,180 109,480 285,027 
Net (decrease) increase in cash and cash equivalents(20,725)167,101 (64,595)
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year251,550 84,449 149,044 
Cash and cash equivalents at end of year$230,825 $251,550 $84,449 
See accompanying Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
F-7



VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts) 
1. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies
Nature of Organization and Basis of Presentation
In this report, the words, "Veritex," "the Company," "we," "us," and "our" refer to the combined entities of Veritex Holdings, Inc. and its subsidiaries, including Veritex Community Bank. The word "Holdco" refers to Veritex Holdings, Inc.. The word "the Bank" refers to Veritex Community Bank.

The accounting principles followed by the Company and the methods of applying them are in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles (“GAAP”) and prevailing practices of the banking industry. Intercompany transactions and balances are eliminated in consolidation.
Veritex is a Texas state banking organization, with corporate offices in Dallas, Texas, and currently operates 25 branches and one mortgage office located in the Dallas-Fort Worth metroplex, 12 branches in the Houston metropolitan area, and one branch in Louisville, Kentucky. The Bank provides a full range of banking services to individual and corporate customers, which include commercial and retail lending, and the acceptance of checking and savings deposits. The Texas Department of Banking (the "TDB") and the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (the "Federal Reserve") are the primary regulators of the Company and the Bank, and both regulatory agencies perform periodic examinations to ensure regulatory compliance.
Accounting Standards Codification 
The Financial Accounting Standards Board’s (“FASB”) Accounting Standards Codification (“ASC”) is the officially recognized source of authoritative GAAP applicable to all public and non-public non-governmental entities. Rules and interpretive releases of the Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”) under the authority of federal securities laws are also sources of authoritative GAAP for SEC registrants. All other accounting literature is considered non-authoritative. Citing particular content in the ASC involves specifying the unique numeric path to the content through the Topic, Subtopic, Section and Paragraph structure.
Segment Reporting
The Company has one reportable segment. All of the Company’s activities are interrelated, and each activity is dependent and assessed based on how each activity of the Company supports the others. For example, lending is dependent upon the ability of the Company to fund itself with deposits and borrowings while managing interest rate and credit risk. Accordingly, all significant operating decisions are based upon analysis of the Bank as one segment or unit. The Company’s chief operating decision-maker, the Chief Executive Officer, uses the consolidated results to make operating and strategic decisions.
 
Reclassifications 
Certain items in the Company's prior year financial statements were reclassified to conform to the current presentation including (i) the reclassification on the Consolidated Balance Sheets of accrued interest payable of $6,569 to accounts payable and other liabilities for the year ended December 31, 2019, (ii) the reclassification on the Consolidated Statement of Income from gain on sale of loans and other assets owned of $475 and $709 to gain on sale of mortgage loans held for sale for the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018, respectively, (iii) the reclassification on the Consolidated Statement of Income from net gain on sales of loans and other assets owned of $4,388 and $2,347 to government guaranteed loan income, net for the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018, respectively, (iv) the reclassification on the Consolidated Statement of Income from other noninterest income of $321 to government guaranteed loan income, net for the year ended December 31, 2019, (v) and the reclassification on the Consolidated Statement of Income of other noninterest income of $691 and $476 to rental income for the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018, respectively.
F-8



Use of Estimates
The preparation of financial statements in conformity with U.S. GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and the disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the consolidated financial statements. Actual results could differ from those estimates. The allowance for credit losses, the fair values of financial instruments, realization of deferred tax assets, and the status of contingencies are particularly subject to change.
Cash and Cash Equivalents
For the purposes of reporting cash flows, cash and cash equivalents include cash on hand, amounts due from banks and federal funds sold.
The Bank maintains deposits with other financial institutions in amounts that exceed federal deposit insurance coverage. Furthermore, federal funds sold are essentially uncollateralized loans to other financial institutions. Management regularly evaluates the credit risk associated with the counterparties to these transactions and believes that the Company is not exposed to any significant credit risks on cash and cash equivalents.
Restrictions on Cash
The Bank is required to maintain regulatory reserve balances with the FRB. On March 15, 2020, the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System announced that it had reduced the required regulatory reserve balance to 0% effective on March 26, 2020. The Board of Governors took this action in reaction to the economic dislocation caused by the COVID-19 pandemic and in light of the Federal Open Markets Committee's announcement in 2019 that it intends to implement monetary policy in an ample reserve regime, where reserve requirements do not play a role. The reserve balances required as of December 31, 2019 was approximately $170,593.
Debt Securities
Debt securities that the Company has both the positive intent and ability to hold to maturity are classified as held to maturity and are carried at amortized cost. Debt securities that the Company intends to hold for an indefinite period of time, but not necessarily to maturity, are classified as available for sale and are carried at fair value. Unrealized gains and losses on debt securities classified as available for sale have been accounted for as accumulated other comprehensive income (loss), net of taxes. Management determines the appropriate classification of debt securities at the time of purchase.

Interest income includes amortization of purchase premiums and discounts over the period to maturity using a level-yield method, except for premiums on callable debt securities. Realized gains and losses are recorded on the sale of debt securities in noninterest income.
The Company has made a policy election to exclude accrued interest from the amortized cost basis of debt securities and report accrued interest separately in other assets on the consolidated balance sheets. A debt security is placed on nonaccrual status at the time any principal or interest payments become more than 90 days delinquent or if full collection of interest or principal becomes uncertain. Accrued interest for a security placed on nonaccrual is reversed against interest income. There was no accrued interest related to debt securities reversed against interest income for the years ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018.
Equity Securities
Equity securities are recorded at fair value, with unrealized gains and losses included in other noninterest income. The Company measures equity securities that do not have readily determinable fair values at cost minus impairment, if any, plus or minus changes resulting from observable price changes in orderly transactions for the identical or a similar investment of the same issuer. Dividends on equity securities are recorded in interest income for equity securities and other investments. Realized gains and losses are recorded on the sale of equity securities in gain (loss) on sales of securities. The Company recorded no impairment for equity securities without a readily determinable fair value for the years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019.

F-9



Allowance for Credit Losses – Available for Sale Debt Securities
For available for sale debt securities in an unrealized loss position, the Company first assesses whether it intends to sell, or it is more likely than not that it will be required to sell the security before recovery of its amortized cost basis. If either of the criteria regarding intent or requirement to sell is met, the security's amortized cost basis is written down to fair value through income. For debt securities available for sale that do not meet the aforementioned criteria, the Company evaluates whether the decline in fair value has resulted from credit losses or other factors. In making this assessment, management considers the extent to which fair value is less than amortized cost, any changes to the rating of the security by a rating agency and adverse conditions specifically related to the security, among other factors. If this assessment indicates that a credit loss exists, the present value of cash flows expected to be collected from the security are compared to the amortized cost basis of the security. If the present value of cash flows expected to be collected is less than the amortized cost basis, a credit loss exists and an ACL is recorded for the credit loss, limited by the amount that the fair value is less than the amortized cost basis. Any impairment that has not been recorded through an ACL is recognized in other comprehensive income.

Changes in the ACL are recorded as provision for (or reversal of) credit loss expense. Losses are charged against the allowance when management believes the uncollectibility of an available for sale security is confirmed or when either of the criteria regarding intent or requirement to sell is met. Accrued interest receivable on available for sale debt securities is excluded from the estimate of credit losses.

Allowance for Credit Losses Held to Maturity Debt Securities

Management measures expected credit losses on held to maturity debt securities on a collective basis by major security type. The estimate of expected credit losses considers historical credit loss information that is adjusted for current conditions and reasonable and supportable forecasts. Accrued interest receivable on held to maturity debt securities is excluded from the estimate of credit losses.

Management classifies the held to maturity portfolio into the following major security types: mortgage-backed securities, collateralized mortgage obligations and municipal securities. All of the mortgage-backed securities and collateralized mortgage obligations held by the Company are issued by U.S. government entities and agencies. These debt securities are either explicitly or implicitly guaranteed by the U.S. government, are highly rated by major rating agencies and have a long history of no credit losses.

FHLB and FRB Stock
The Bank is a member of its regional Federal Reserve Bank and of the FHLB system. FHLB members are required to own a certain amount of stock based on the level of borrowings and other factors, and may invest in additional amounts. Both FRB and FHLB stock are carried at cost, restricted for sale, and periodically evaluated for impairment based on ultimate recovery of par value. Dividends are recorded in interest income for equity securities and other investments.

F-10



Loans Held for Sale
Loans are classified as held-for-sale when management has positively determined that the loans will be sold in the foreseeable future and the Company has the intent and ability to do so. The Company’s held-for-sale loans typically consist of certain government guaranteed loans or mortgage loans. The classification may be made upon origination or subsequent to origination or purchase. Once a decision has been made to sell loans not previously classified as held-for-sale, such loans are transferred into the held-for-sale classification and carried at the lower of cost or estimated fair value on an individual loan basis, except for those held-for-sale loans for which the Company elects to use the fair value option. The fair value of loans held-for-sale is based on commitments from investors or prevailing market prices. Net unrealized losses, if any, are recognized through a valuation allowance by charges to income. The Company obtains commitments to purchase the loans from secondary market investors prior to closing of the loans. Mortgage loans held for sale are sold with servicing released. Gains and losses on sales of loans held for sale are based on the difference between the selling price and the carrying value of the related loan sold.
Fair Value Option
On a specific identification basis, the Company may elect the fair value option for certain financial instruments in the period the financial instrument was originated or acquired. As of December 31, 2020, the Company had held for sale government guaranteed loans and held for investment PPP loans that the Company has elected to carry at fair value. Changes in fair value for instruments using the fair value option are recorded in noninterest income. The Company had a decrease in fair value for loans the Company elected to carry at fair value of $2,040 for the year ended December 31, 2020 as compared to an increase in the fair value for loans the Company elected to carry at fair value of $303 for the year ended December 31, 2019. There were no changes in fair value for loans held for sale using the fair value option for the year ended December 31, 2018.

In addition, the Company records upfront costs and fees as incurred that are related to items for which the fair value option is elected through noninterest income. For the year ended December 31, 2020, the Company recognized upfront fees of $12,811 on PPP loans through government guaranteed loan income, net, on the Consolidated Statements of Income. There were minimal upfront fees recognized on loans electing the fair value option for the years ended December 31, 2019 and December 31, 2018.

Gain on Sale of Guaranteed Portion of Small Business Administration ("SBA") Loans

The Company originates loans to customers under government guaranteed programs that generally provide for guarantees of 50% to 90% of each loan, subject to a maximum guaranteed amount. The Company can sell the guaranteed portion of the loan in an active secondary market and retains the unguaranteed portion in its portfolio.

All sales of government guaranteed loans are executed on a servicing retained basis, and the Company retains the rights and obligations to service the loans. The standard sale structure provides for the Company to retain a portion of the cash flow from the interest payment received on the loan. When a loan sale involves the transfer of an interest less than the entire loan, the controlling accounting method under FASB ASC 860, Transfers and Servicing, requires the seller to reallocate the carrying basis between the assets transferred and the assets retained based on the relative fair value of the respective assets as of the date of sale. The maximum gain on sale that can be recognized is the difference between the fair value of the assets sold and the reallocated basis of the assets sold. The gain on sale, which is recognized in government guaranteed loan income, net on the Consolidated Statements of Income, is the sum of the cash premium on the guaranteed loan and the fair value of the servicing assets recognized, less the discount recorded on the unguaranteed portion of the loan retained by the Company. For the years ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018, the Company recognized $3,379, $4,388 and $2,348, respectively, of gain on sales of government guaranteed loans.

Gain on Sale of Mortgage Loans Held for Sale

Certain mortgage loans held for sale are sold with servicing released. Gains and losses on sales of mortgage loans held for sale are based on the difference between the selling price and the carrying value of the loan sold.

F-11



Adoption of New Accounting Standard
On January 1, 2020, the Company adopted Accounting Standard Update (“ASU”) 2016-13 Financial Instruments - Credit Losses (Topic 326): Measurement of Credit Losses on Financial Instruments, which replaces the incurred loss methodology with an expected loss methodology that is referred to as the CECL methodology. The measurement of expected credit losses under the CECL methodology is applicable to financial assets measured at amortized cost, including loan receivables and held-to-maturity debt securities. It also applies to off-balance sheet (“OBS”) credit exposures not accounted for as insurance (loan commitments, standby letters of credit, financial guarantees, and other similar instruments) and net investments in leases recognized by a lessor in accordance with Topic 842 on leases. In addition, ASC 326 made changes to the accounting for available-for-sale debt securities. One such change is to require credit losses to be presented as an allowance rather than as a write-down on available-for-sale debt securities management does not intend to sell or believes that it is more likely than not they will be required to sell.

The Company adopted ASC 326 using the modified retrospective method for all financial assets measured at amortized cost, net investments in leases and OBS credit exposures. Results for reporting periods beginning after January 1, 2020 are presented under ASC 326 while prior period amounts continue to be reported in accordance with previously applicable GAAP. The Company recorded a net decrease to retained earnings of $15,505 as of January 1, 2020 for the cumulative effect of adopting ASC 326.

The Company adopted ASC 326 using the prospective transition approach for financial assets purchased with credit deterioration (“PCD”) that were previously classified as PCI and accounted for under ASC 310-30. In accordance with the standard, management did not reassess whether PCI assets met the criteria of PCD assets as of the date of adoption. On January 1, 2020, the amortized cost basis of the PCD assets were adjusted to reflect the addition of $19,710 of the ACL. The remaining noncredit discount will be accreted into interest income at the effective interest rate. As allowed by ASC 326, the Company elected to maintain pools of loans accounted for under ASC 310-30. In accordance with the standard, management did not reassess whether modifications to individual acquired financial assets accounted for in pools were troubled debt restructurings as of the date of adoption.

The following table illustrates the impact of ASC 326.


January 1, 2020
As Reported
Under
ASC 326
Pre-ASC 326
Adoption
Impact of ASC 326 Adoption
Assets:
Allowance for credit losses on debt securities held-to-maturity$— $— $— 
Allowance for credit losses on loans
Construction and land3,760 3,822 (62)
Farmland65 61 
1 - 4 family residential6,002 1,378 4,624 
Multi-family residential2,593 1,965 628 
Owner Occupied Commercial Real Estate13,066 1,978 11,088 
Non-Owner Occupied Commercial Real Estate15,314 8,139 7,175 
Commercial27,729 12,369 15,360 
Consumer442 122 320 
Allowance for credit losses on loans$68,971 $29,834 $39,137 
Liabilities:
Allowance for credit losses on OBS credit exposures$1,718 $878 $840 

F-12



Loans Held for Investments
Loans that management has the intent and ability to hold for the foreseeable future or until maturity or payoff are reported at amortized cost, net of the ACL. Amortized cost is the principal balance outstanding, net of purchase premiums and discounts, fair value hedge accounting adjustments, deferred loan fees and costs. The Company has made a policy election to exclude accrued interest from the amortized cost basis of loans and report accrued interest separately from the related loan balance in other assets on the Consolidated Balance Sheets.
Interest on loans is recognized using the effective-interest method on the daily balances of the principal amounts outstanding. Loan origination fees, net of certain direct origination costs, are deferred and recognized in interest income using the level-yield method without anticipating prepayments.

Loans are considered past due if the required principal and interest payments have not been received as of the date such payments were due in accordance with the terms of the loan agreement. The accrual of interest on loans is discontinued when, in management’s opinion, the borrower may be unable to meet payment obligations as they come due, as well as when required by regulatory provisions. Loans may be placed on nonaccrual status regardless of whether or not such loans are considered past due. When a loan is placed on nonaccrual status, all interest accrued but not received for loans placed on nonaccrual is reversed against interest income. Interest received on such loans is accounted for on the cash-basis or cost-recovery method, until qualifying for return to accrual. Under the cost-recovery method, interest income is not recognized until the loan balance is reduced to zero. Under the cash-basis method, interest income is recorded when the payment is received in cash. Loans are returned to accrual status when all the principal and interest amounts contractually due are brought current and future payments are reasonably assured.

Acquired Loans

Prior to January 1, 2020, loans acquired in a business combination that had evidence of deterioration of credit quality since origination and for which it was probable, at acquisition, that the Company would be unable to collect all contractually required payments receivable were considered purchased credit impaired (“PCI”). PCI loans were accounted for individually or aggregated into pools of loans based on common risk characteristics such as credit grade, loan type, and date of origination.

All loans considered to be PCI loans prior to January 1, 2020 were converted to PCD loans upon the Company’s adoption of ASC 326. The Company elected to maintain pools of loans that were previously accounted for under ASC 310-30 and will continue to account for these pools as a unit of account for all applicable areas of accounting which include credit loss measurement, interest income recognition, non-accrual determination, write-off determination and trouble debt restructuring identification. Loans are only removed from the existing pools if they are foreclosed, written off, paid off, or sold. Upon adoption of ASC 326, the ACL was determined for each loan or pool and added to the loan or pool's carrying amount to establish a new amortized cost basis. The difference between the unpaid principal balance of the loan or pool and the new amortized cost basis is the noncredit premium or discount which will be accreted into interest income over the remaining life of the loan or pool. Changes to the ACL after adoption are recorded through provision for credit loss expense.

Subsequent to January 1, 2020, loans acquired in a business combination that have experienced more-than-insignificant deterioration in credit quality since origination are considered PCD loans. At the acquisition date, an estimate of expected credit losses is made for groups of PCD loans with similar risk characteristics and individual PCD loans without similar risk characteristics. This initial ACL is allocated to individual PCD loans and added to the purchase price or acquisition date fair values to establish the initial amortized cost basis of the PCD loans. As the initial ACL is added to the purchase price, there is no credit loss expense recognized upon acquisition of a PCD loan. Any difference between the unpaid principal balance of PCD loans and the amortized cost basis is considered to relate to noncredit factors and results in a discount or premium. Discounts and premiums are recognized through interest income on a level-yield method over the life of the loans.

For acquired loans not deemed purchased credit deteriorated at acquisition, the differences between the initial fair value and the unpaid principal balance are recognized as interest income on a level-yield basis over the lives of the related loans. At the acquisition date, an initial allowance for expected credit losses is estimated and recorded as credit loss expense.

The subsequent measurement of expected credit losses for all acquired loans is the same as the subsequent measurement of expected credit losses for originated loans.

F-13



Allowance for Credit Losses - Loans

The ACL is a valuation account that is deducted from the loans' amortized cost basis to present the net amount expected to be collected on the loans.

The Company estimates the ACL on loans based on the underlying assets’ amortized cost basis, which is the amount at which the financing receivable is originated or acquired, adjusted for applicable accretion or amortization of premium, discount, and net deferred fees or costs, collection of cash, and charge-offs. In the event that collection of principal becomes uncertain, the Company has policies in place to reverse accrued interest in a timely manner. Therefore, the Company has made a policy election to exclude accrued interest from the measurement of ACL.

Expected credit losses are reflected in the ACL through a charge to provision for credit loss expense. When the Company deems all or a portion of a financial asset to be uncollectible the appropriate amount is written off and the ACL is reduced by the same amount. The Company applies judgment to determine when a financial asset is deemed uncollectible; however, an asset will typically be considered uncollectible no later than when all efforts at collection have been exhausted. Subsequent recoveries, if any, are credited to the ACL when received.

The Company measures expected credit losses of financial assets on a collective (pool) basis, when the financial assets share similar risk characteristics. Depending on the nature of the pool of financial assets with similar risk characteristics, the Company uses a discounted cash flow (“DCF”) method or a loss-rate method to estimate expected credit losses. The Company uses a probability of default/loss given default (“PD/LGD”) model to estimate expected credit losses for our PCD loans and pools.

The Company’s methodologies for estimating the ACL take into account available relevant information about the collectability of cash flows, including information about past events, current conditions, and reasonable and supportable forecasts. The methodologies apply historical loss information, adjusted for asset-specific characteristics, economic conditions
at the measurement date, and forecasts about future economic conditions expected to exist through the contractual lives of the financial assets that are reasonable and supportable, to the identified pools of financial assets with similar risk characteristics for which the historical loss experience was observed.

The Company has identified the following pools of financial assets with similar risk characteristics for measuring expected credit losses:

Real Estate — This category of loans consists of the following loan types:

Construction and land — This category of loans consists of loans to finance the ground up construction, improvement and/or carrying for sale after the completion of construction of owner occupied and non-owner occupied residential and commercial properties, and loans secured by raw or improved land. The repayment of construction loans is generally dependent upon the successful completion of the improvements by the builder for the end user, or sale of the property to a third party. Repayment of land secured loans are dependent upon the successful development and sale of the property, the sale of the land as is, or the outside cash flow of the owners to support the retirement of the debt.

Farmland — These loans are principally loans to purchase farmland.

1-4 family residential — This category of loans includes both first and junior liens on residential real estate. Home equity revolving lines of credit and home equity term loans are included in this group of loans.

Multi-family residential — This category of loans is primarily secured by non-owner occupied apartment or multifamily residential buildings. Generally, these types of loans are thought to involve a greater degree of credit risk than owner occupied commercial real estate as they are more sensitive to adverse economic conditions.

Owner occupied commercial real estate (“OOCRE”) — This category of loans includes real estate loans for a variety of commercial property types and purposes. The repayment of real estate loans is generally largely dependent on the successful operation of the property securing the loans or the business conducted on the property securing the loan. Real estate loans may be more adversely affected by conditions in the real estate markets or in the general economy. The properties securing the Company’s real estate portfolio are generally diverse in terms of type and geographic location, throughout the Dallas-Fort Worth metroplex and Houston metropolitan area. This diversity helps reduce the exposure to adverse economic events that may affect any single market or industry.

F-14



Non-owner occupied commercial real estate (“NOOCRE”) — This category of loans includes investment real estate loans that are primarily secured by office and industrial buildings, retail shopping centers and various special purpose properties. Generally, these types of loans are thought to involve a greater degree of credit risk than OOCRE as they are more sensitive to adverse economic conditions.

Commercial — This category of loans is for commercial, corporate and business purposes. The Company’s commercial business loan portfolio is comprised of loans for a variety of purposes and across a variety of industries. These loans include general commercial and industrial loans, loans to purchase capital equipment, agriculture operating loans and other business loans for working capital and operational purposes. Most commercial loans are secured by the assets being financed or other business assets, such as accounts receivable or inventory.

Mortgage warehouse — Mortgage warehouse facilities are provided to unaffiliated mortgage origination companies and are collateralized by 1-4 family residential loans. The originator closes new mortgage loans with the intent to sell these loans to third party investors for a profit. The Company provides funding to the mortgage companies for the period between the origination and their sale of the loan. The Company is repaid with the proceeds received from sale of the mortgage loan to the final investor.

Consumer — This category of loans is used for personal use typically for consumer purposes.

Collateral Dependent Financial Assets

Loans that do not share similar risk characteristics are evaluated on an individual basis. For collateral dependent financial assets where the Company has determined that foreclosure of the collateral is probable, or where the borrower is experiencing financial difficulty and the Company expects repayment of the financial asset to be provided substantially through the operation or sale of the collateral, the ACL is measured based on the difference between the fair value of the collateral and the amortized cost basis of the asset as of the measurement date. When repayment is expected to be from the operation of the collateral, expected credit losses are calculated as the amount by which the amortized cost basis of the financial asset exceeds the present value of expected cash flows from the operation of the collateral. When repayment is expected to be from the sale of the collateral, expected credit losses are calculated as the amount by which the amortized costs basis of the financial asset exceeds the fair value of the underlying collateral less estimated costs to sell. The ACL may be zero if the fair value of the collateral at the measurement date exceeds the amortized cost basis of the financial asset.

For collateralized financial assets that are not collateral dependent, the Company will consider the nature of the collateral, potential future changes in collateral values, and historical loss information for financial assets secured with similar collateral to determine the ACL.

Troubled-debt Restructurings (TDRs)

From time to time, the Company may modify its loan agreement with a borrower. A modified loan is considered a TDR, using Accounting Standards Codification 310-40, “Receivables – Troubled Debt Restructurings by Creditors,” (“ASC 310-40”), when two conditions are met: (i) the borrower is experiencing financial difficulty and (ii) concessions are made by the Company that would not otherwise be considered for a borrower with similar credit risk characteristics. Modifications to loan terms may include a lower interest rate, a reduction of principal, or a longer term to maturity. The ACL on a TDR is measured using the same method as all other loans held for investment, except that the original interest rate is used to discount the expected cash flows, not the rate specified within the restructuring. In addition, when management has a reasonable expectation of executing a TDR, the expected effect of the modification is included in the estimate of the ACL.

Contractual Term

The Company’s estimate of the ACL reflects losses expected over the remaining contractual life of the assets. The contractual term does not consider extensions, renewals or modifications unless the Company has identified an expected TDR.

Discounted Cash Flow Method

The Company uses the DCF method to estimate expected credit losses for the commercial real estate, construction and land, 1-4 family residential, commercial (excluding liquid credit and premium finance), and consumer loan pools. For each of these loan segments, the Company generates cash flow projections at the instrument level wherein payment expectations are adjusted for estimated prepayment speeds, curtailment rates, time to recovery, probability of default and loss given default. The modeling of expected prepayment speeds, curtailment rates and time to recovery are based on historical internal data.

F-15



The Company uses regression analysis of historical internal and peer data to determine suitable loss drivers to utilize when modeling lifetime probability of default and loss given default. This analysis also determines how expected probability of default and loss given default will react to forecasted levels of the loss drivers. For all loan pools utilizing the DCF method, management utilizes and forecasts Texas unemployment as a loss driver. Management also utilizes and forecasts either one-year percentage change in Texas gross domestic product or one-year percentage change in the commercial real estate property index as a second loss driver depending on the nature of the underlying loan pool and how well that loss driver correlates to expected future losses.

For all DCF models, management has determined that four quarters represents a reasonable and supportable forecast period and reverts back to a historical loss rate over four quarters on a straight-line basis as of the reporting period. Management leverages economic projections from a reputable and independent third party to inform its loss driver forecasts over the four-quarter forecast period. Other internal and external indicators of economic forecasts are also considered by management when developing the forecast metrics.

The combination of adjustments for credit expectations (default and loss) and timing expectations (prepayment speeds, curtailment rates and time to recovery) produces an expected cash flow stream at the instrument level. Instrument effective yield is calculated, net of the impacts of prepayment assumptions, and the instrument expected cash flows are then discounted at that effective yield to produce an instrument-level net present value of expected cash flows (“NPV”). An ACL is established for the difference between the instrument’s NPV and amortized cost basis. The ACL is further refined for qualitative loss factors based on management's judgment of company, market, industry or business specific data, changes in underlying loan composition of specific portfolios, trends relating to credit quality, delinquency, non-performing and adversely rated loans, and reasonable and supportable forecasts of economic conditions.

Loss-Rate Method

The Company uses a loss-rate method to estimate expected credit losses for its farmland and MW loan pool. For these loan segments, the Company applies an expected loss ratio based on internal and peer historical losses adjusted as appropriate for qualitative factors. Qualitative loss factors are based on management's judgment of company, market, industry or business specific data, changes in underlying loan composition of specific portfolios, trends relating to credit quality, delinquency, non-performing and adversely rated loans, and reasonable and supportable forecasts of economic conditions.

Probability of Default/Loss Given Default Method

The Company uses the PD/LGD method to estimate expected credit losses for the construction and land, 1-4 family residential, OOCRE, NOOCRE, commercial and consumer PCD loan pools. For each of these loan segments, the Company generates cash flow projections at the instrument level wherein payment expectations are adjusted for estimated prepayment speeds, time to recovery, probability of default, and loss given default.

The combination of adjustments for credit expectations (default and loss) and timing expectations (prepayment and time to recovery) produces an expected cash flow stream at the instrument level. An ACL is established for the difference between the instrument’s undiscounted cash flows and amortized cost basis. The ACL is further refined for qualitative loss factors based on management's judgment of company, market, industry or business specific data, changes in underlying loan composition of specific portfolios, trends relating to credit quality, delinquency, non-performing and adversely rated loans, and reasonable and supportable forecasts of economic conditions.

Loan Commitments and Allowance for Credit Losses on Off-Balance Sheet Credit Exposures
Financial instruments include OBS credit instruments, such as commitments to make loans and standby letters of credit, issued to meet customer financing needs. The Company’s exposure to credit loss in the event of nonperformance by the other party to the financial instrument for OBS loan commitments is represented by the contractual amount of those instruments. Such financial instruments are recorded when they are funded.

The Company records an ACL on OBS credit exposures, unless the commitments to extend credit are unconditionally cancellable, through a charge to provision for credit losses for unfunded commitments included in the Company’s Consolidated Statements of Income. The ACL on OBS credit exposures is estimated by loan segment at each balance sheet date under the CECL model using the same methodologies as portfolio loans, taking into consideration the likelihood that funding will occur, and is included in accounts payable and other liabilities on the Company’s consolidated balance sheets.


F-16



Derivative Financial Instruments (Not Designated as Accounting Hedges)

The Company has entered into certain derivative instruments pursuant to a customer accommodation program under which the Company enters into an interest rate swap, cap or collar agreement with a commercial customer and an agreement with offsetting terms with a correspondent bank. These derivative instruments are not designated as accounting hedges and the swap fees and changes in net fair value are recognized in noninterest income or expense on the Company’s condensed consolidated statements of income and the fair value amounts are included in other assets and accounts payable and other liabilities on the Company’s condensed consolidated balance sheets.

Derivative Financial Instruments (Designated as Accounting Hedges)

Cash flow hedge relationships mitigate exposure to the variability of future cash flows or other forecasted transactions. The Company uses interest rate swaps, floors, caps and collars to manage overall cash flow changes related to interest rate risk exposure on benchmark interest rate loans. The entire change in the fair value related to the derivative instrument is recognized as a component of other comprehensive income and subsequently reclassified into interest income when the forecasted transaction affects income.

The Company assesses the “effectiveness” of hedging derivatives on the date an arrangement was entered into and on a prospective basis at least quarterly. Hedge “effectiveness” is determined by the extent to which changes in the fair value of a derivative instrument offset changes in the fair value, cash flows or carrying value attributable to the risk being hedged. If the relationship between the change in the fair value of the derivative instrument and the change in the hedged item falls within a range considered to be the industry norm, the hedge is considered “highly effective” and qualifies for hedge accounting. A hedge is “ineffective” if the relationship between the changes falls outside the acceptable range. In that case, hedge accounting is discontinued on a prospective basis. The time value of the option is excluded from the assessment of effectiveness and is recognized in earnings using a straight-line amortization method over the life of the hedge arrangement. Gains or losses resulting from the termination or sale of a derivative accounted for as a cash flow hedge remain in other comprehensive income and are accreted or amortized to earnings over the remaining period of the former hedging relationship unless the forecasted transaction becomes probable of not occurring.

Transfers of Financial Assets

Transfers of financial assets (generally consisting of sales of loans held for sale and loan participations with unaffiliated banks) are accounted for as sales when control over the assets has been relinquished. Control over transferred assets is deemed to be surrendered when the assets have been isolated from the Company, the transferee obtains the right (free of conditions that constrain it from taking advantage of that right) to pledge or exchange the transferred assets, and the Company does not maintain effective control over the transferred assets through an agreement to repurchase them before their maturity.
Bank Premises and Equipment
Buildings and improvements, furniture and equipment are carried at cost less accumulated depreciation computed using the straight-line method over the estimated useful lives of the respective assets as follows:
Buildings and improvements
10 - 40 years
Site improvements
15 years
Tenant improvementsLease term
Leasehold improvementsLease term
Furniture and equipment
3 - 10 years
Major replacements and betterments are capitalized while maintenance and repairs are charged to expense when incurred. Gains or losses on dispositions are reflected in the consolidated statements of income as incurred.
Bank premises and equipment with definite lives are tested for impairment when a triggering event occurs. No impairment charges related to bank premises and equipment assets were recorded during the years ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018.
F-17



Leases
FASB ASU 2016-02, Leases (Topic 842) (“ASU 2016-02”), requires that lessees and lessors recognize lease assets and lease liabilities on the balance sheet and disclose key information about leasing arrangements. Topic 842 was subsequently amended by ASU 2018-11, Targeted Improvements. ASU 2016-02 provides for a modified retrospective transition approach requiring lessees to recognize and measure leases on the balance sheet at the beginning of either the earliest period presented or as of the beginning of the period of adoption. The Company elected to apply ASU 2016-02 as of the beginning of the period of adoption, January 1, 2019, and did not restate comparative periods. The Company has no material leasing arrangements for which it is the lessor of property or equipment. The Company made an accounting policy election not to apply the recognition requirements in the new standard to short-term leases. The Company has elected to apply the package of practical expedients as both the lessor and lessee allowed by the new standard under which the Company need not reassess whether any expired or existing contracts are or contain leases, the Company need not reassess the lease classification for any expired or existing lease, and the Company need not reassess initial direct costs for any existing leases. The Company has also elected to use the practical expedient to make an accounting policy election for leases of certain underlying assets to include both lease and nonlease components as a single component and account for that single component as a lease.
The Company’s operating leases relate primarily to office space and bank branches. Right-of-use (“ROU”) assets and operating lease liabilities are recognized at lease commencement based on the present value of the remaining lease payments using a discount rate that represents the Company’s incremental borrowing rate at the lease commencement date. ROU assets are further adjusted for lease incentives, deferred rent and prepaid rent. Operating lease expense, which consists of amortization of the ROU asset and the implicit interest accreted on the operating lease liability, is recognized on a straight-line basis over the lease term, and is recorded in occupancy and equipment expense in the consolidated statements of income. Certain of the Company’s leases contain options to renew the lease; however, these renewal options are not included in the calculation of the lease liabilities as they are not reasonably certain to be exercised. As a result of implementing ASU 2016-02, the Company recognized an operating lease ROU asset of $18,705 and an operating lease liability of $18,753 on January 1, 2019, with no impact on the consolidated statement of income or consolidated statement of cash flows compared to the prior lease accounting model. The ROU asset and operating lease liability are recorded in other assets and other liabilities, respectively, in the consolidated balance sheets. See Note 8 - Leases for additional information.
Securities Sold Under Agreements to Repurchase
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase represent the purchase of interests in securities by the Company’s customers. Securities sold under agreements to repurchase are stated at the amount of cash received in connection with the transaction. The Company does not account for any of its repurchase agreements as sales for accounting purposes in its financial statements. Repurchase agreements are settled on the following business day. All securities sold under agreements to repurchase are collateralized by pledged debt securities. The debt securities underlying the repurchase agreements are held in safekeeping by the Bank’s safekeeping agent.

Other Real Estate Owned
Other real estate owned represents properties acquired through or in lieu of loan foreclosure and is initially recorded at fair value less estimated costs to sell. At foreclosure, if the fair value, less estimated costs to sell, of the real estate acquired is less than the Bank’s recorded investment in the related loan, a write-down is recognized through a charge to the allowance for credit losses. If fair value declines subsequent to foreclosure, a valuation allowance is recorded through expense. Operating costs after acquisition are expensed.
Bank-Owned Life Insurance
The Company has purchased life insurance policies on certain employees. These bank-owned life insurance (“BOLI”) policies are recorded in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets at their cash surrender values. Income from these policies and changes in the cash surrender values are recorded in noninterest income in the accompanying consolidated statements of income.
F-18



Goodwill and Intangible Assets
Goodwill resulting from a business combination represents the excess of the fair value of the consideration transferred over the fair value of the net assets acquired and liabilities assumed as of the acquisition date. Goodwill is not amortized but is reviewed for potential impairment annually on October 31 of each fiscal year or when a triggering event occurs. The Company may first assess qualitative factors to determine whether it is more likely than not (that is, a likelihood of more than 50%) that the fair value of a reporting unit is less than its carrying amount, including goodwill. The Company has an unconditional option to bypass the qualitative assessment for any reporting unit in any period and proceed directly to performing the quantitative goodwill impairment test, and the Company may resume performing the qualitative assessment in any subsequent period. If the Company determines that it is more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit is less than its carrying amount, then the Company proceeds to perform the quantitative goodwill impairment test. The quantitative goodwill impairment test, used to identify both the existence of potential impairment and the amount of impairment loss, compares the fair value of a reporting unit with its carrying amount, including goodwill. If the carrying amount of a reporting unit exceeds its fair value, an impairment loss shall be recognized in an amount equal to that excess, limited to the total amount of goodwill allocated to that reporting unit. Any such adjustments to goodwill are reflected in the results of operations in the periods in which they become known.
During the second quarter of 2020, the Company observed a sustained decline in the market valuation of the Company’s common stock as a result of continued economic disruption occurring after the first quarter of 2020 primarily due to the COVID-19 pandemic. As a result, the Company determined that it was more likely than not that the fair value of the Company’s sole reporting unit was below its carrying value and proceeded to perform an interim quantitative impairment test. The Company determined the fair value of its reporting unit using a combination of a market and an income approach. Upon completion of quantitative evaluation, the Company determined that, as of June 30, 2020, the fair value of the Company's reporting unit exceeded its related carrying value, and therefore goodwill was not impaired.

The Company performed its annual goodwill impairment test as of October 31, 2020 using a qualitative impairment assessment and determined that it was not more likely than not that the fair value of our reporting unit was less than its carrying amount. The Company also did not identify any potential impairment indicators subsequent to our annual assessment. Management will continue to monitor events that could impact this conclusion in the future.

Intangible assets consist of core deposit intangibles and in-place lease intangibles associated with the purchase of our corporate office. Intangible assets are initially recognized based on a valuation performed as of the acquisition date and are amortized on a straight-line basis over their estimated useful lives of the respective intangible assets as follows:

Core deposit intangible
7 - 10 years
In-place lease intangibleLease term

All indefinite lived intangible assets are tested annually for potential impairment or when triggering events occur. Intangible assets with definite lives are tested for impairment when a triggering event occurs. No impairment charges related to goodwill and intangible assets were recorded during the years ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018.
Servicing Assets
The Company accounts for its servicing assets at amortized cost in accordance with ASC 860, "Servicing Assets and Liabilities." The codification requires that servicing rights acquired through the origination of loans, which are sold with servicing rights retained, are recognized as separate assets. Servicing assets are recorded as the difference between the contractual servicing fees and adequate compensation for performing the servicing, and are periodically reviewed and adjusted for any impairment. The amount of impairment recognized, if any, is the amount by which the servicing assets exceed their fair value. The amount of recovery, if any, cannot exceed the previous impairment recognized. Fair value of the servicing assets is estimated using discounted cash flows based on current market interest rates. Servicing rights are amortized over their estimated lives.
Marketing Expense
The Company expenses all marketing costs as they are incurred. Marketing expenses were $3,651, $3,259 and $1,783 in 2020, 2019 and 2018, respectively.
F-19



Income Taxes
The Company files a consolidated income tax return with its subsidiaries. Federal income tax expense or benefit is allocated on a separate return basis.
The Company accounts for income taxes using the asset and liability approach for financial accounting and reporting. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are reflected at currently enacted income tax rates applicable to the period in which the deferred tax assets and liabilities are expected to be realized or settled. As changes in tax laws or rates are enacted, deferred tax assets and liabilities are adjusted through the provision for income taxes. Valuation allowances are established when necessary to reduce deferred tax assets to the amount expected to be realized. Realization of deferred tax assets is dependent upon the generation of a sufficient level of future taxable income and recoverable taxes paid in prior years.
The Company may recognize the tax benefit of an uncertain tax position only if it is more likely than not that the tax position will be sustained upon examination by the taxing authorities based on the technical merits of the position. For tax positions meeting the more-likely-than-not threshold, the amount recognized in the financial statements would be the benefit that has a greater than 50% likelihood of being realized upon ultimate settlement with the relevant tax authority. For the years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019, management has determined there are no material uncertain tax positions.
When necessary, the Company would include interest assessed by taxing authorities in “interest expense” and penalties related to income taxes in “other expense” on its Consolidated Statements of Income. The Company recorded $143 and $309 of interest or penalties related to income tax for the year ended December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively, and no interest or penalties related to income tax for the year ended December 31, 2018. With few exceptions, such as state examinations, the Company is generally no longer subject to U.S. federal income tax examinations by tax authorities for the years before 2017 and state income tax examinations for tax years prior to 2016.

Fair Values of Financial Instruments
Fair values of financial instruments are estimated using relevant market information and other assumptions. Fair value estimates involve uncertainties and matters of significant judgment regarding interest rates, credit risk, prepayments and other factors, especially in the absence of broad markets for particular items. Changes in assumptions or in market conditions could significantly affect the estimates. The fair value estimates of existing on and off-balance sheet financial instruments do not include the value of anticipated future business or the value of assets and liabilities not considered financial instruments.
Revenue from Contracts with Customers
The Company records revenue from contracts with customers in accordance with ASC Topic 606, “Revenue from Contracts with Customers” (“Topic 606”). Under Topic 606, the Company must identify the contract with a customer, identify the performance obligations in the contract, determine the transaction price, allocate the transaction price to the performance obligations in the contract, and recognize revenue when (or as) the Company satisfies a performance obligation. Significant revenue has not been recognized in the current reporting period that results from performance obligations satisfied in previous periods.
The Company’s primary sources of revenue are derived from interest and dividends earned on loans, investment securities and other financial instruments that are not within the scope of Topic 606. The Company has evaluated the nature of its contracts with customers and determined that further disaggregation of revenue from contracts with customers into more granular categories beyond what is presented in the consolidated statements of income was not necessary. The Company generally fully satisfies its performance obligations on its contracts with customers as services are rendered and the transaction prices are typically fixed; charged either on a periodic basis or based on activity. Because performance obligations are satisfied as services are rendered and the transaction prices are fixed, the Company has made no significant judgments in applying the revenue guidance prescribed in ASC 606 that affect the determination of the amount and timing of revenue from contracts with customers.
F-20



Stock Based Compensation
Compensation cost is recognized for stock options and other equity awards (performance and non-performance based) issued to employees and directors, based on the fair value of these awards at the date of grant. A Black-Scholes model is utilized to estimate the fair value of stock options. The market price of the Company’s common stock on the date of grant is used to estimate fair value for other nonperformance based equity awards. A Monte Carlo simulation is used to estimate the fair value of performance-based restricted stock units that include a vesting condition and a market condition based on the Company’s total shareholder return relative to a peer group comprised of commercial banks in similar markets, which determines the number of shares of Company common stock subject to the restricted stock unit.
Compensation cost is recognized over the required service period, generally defined as the vesting period. For awards with graded vesting, compensation cost is recognized on a straight-line basis over the requisite service period for the entire award.
Liability-Classified Awards
The fair value of a liability award is determined on a quarterly basis beginning at the grant date until final vesting. Changes in the fair value of liability awards are recorded over the vesting period of the award. Changes in the fair value of liability awards that occur during the requisite service period are recognized as compensation cost over that period. The percentage of the fair value that is accrued as compensation cost at the end of each period equals the percentage of the requisite service that has been rendered at that date. Changes in the fair value of a liability award that occur after the end of the requisite service period are recognized as compensation cost in the period in which the changes occur. Any difference between the amount for which a liability award is settled and its fair value at the settlement date is an adjustment of compensation cost in the period of settlement. Compensation cost for liability awards is recorded in salaries and employee benefits and the associated liability is recorded in accounts payable and accrued expenses.

For liability to equity award modifications, the aggregate amount of compensation cost recognized is the fair value-based measure of the award on the modification date. On the modification date, the Company reclassifies the previously recorded share-based compensation liability to additional paid-in capital.

Treasury Stock
Treasury stock is stated at cost, which is determined by the first-in, first-out method.
Comprehensive Income
Comprehensive income includes all changes in stockholders’ equity during a period, except those resulting from transactions with stockholders. In addition to net income, comprehensive income includes the net effect of changes in the fair value of available for sale debt securities, net of tax, and the net effect of changes in fair value of derivative instruments designated as cash flow hedges. Comprehensive income is reported in the accompanying consolidated statements of comprehensive income.
F-21



Business Combinations
The Company applies the acquisition method of accounting for business combinations. Under the acquisition method, the acquiring entity in a business combination recognizes 100% of the assets acquired and liabilities assumed at their acquisition date fair values. Management utilizes valuation techniques appropriate for the asset or liability being measured in determining these fair values. Any excess of the purchase price over amounts allocated to assets acquired, including identifiable intangible assets, and liabilities assumed is recorded as goodwill. Where amounts allocated to assets acquired and liabilities assumed is greater than the purchase price, a bargain purchase gain is recognized. Acquisition-related costs are expensed as incurred.
Earnings Per Share
Earnings per share (“EPS”) are based upon the weighted-average number of shares outstanding. The table below sets forth the reconciliation between weighted average shares used for calculating basic and diluted EPS for the years ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018.
 Year Ended December 31,
 202020192018
Earnings (numerator)         
Net income allocated to common stockholders$73,883 $90,739 $39,341 
Shares (denominator)   
Weighted average shares outstanding for basic EPS (thousands)49,883 53,154 24,169 
Dilutive effect of employee stock-based awards153 824 421 
Adjusted weighted average shares outstanding50,036 53,978 24,590 
Earnings per share:   
Basic$1.48 $1.71 $1.63 
Diluted$1.48 $1.68 $1.60 
 
Restricted stock units and stock options of 1,481 shares at December 31, 2020 have not been included in diluted EPS because to do so would have been antidilutive for the period presented. For the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018, there were no anti-dilutive shares excluded from the diluted EPS weighted average shares.

F-22



2. Supplemental Statement of Cash Flows
Other supplemental cash flow information is presented below:
 Year Ended December 31,
 202020192018
Supplemental Disclosures of Cash Flow Information:   
Cash paid for interest$58,236 $88,175 $29,178 
Cash paid for income taxes40,690 24,100 6,525 
Supplemental Disclosures of Non-Cash Flow Information:   
Setup of ROU asset and lease liability upon adoption of ASC 842$— $9,380 $— 
Lease liabilities arising from obtaining right-of-use assets4,123 — — 
Reclassification of deferred offering costs paid in 2018 from other assets to additional paid-in-capital— 788 — 
Subordinated debt issuance costs accrued but not yet paid in 2019— 315 — 
Reclassification of lease intangibles, cease-use liability and deferred rent liability to ROU asset upon adoption of ASC 842— (48)— 
Net foreclosure of other real estate owned and repossessed assets2,764 5,995 
Loans held for investment transferred to loans held for sale4,511 — — 
Reclassification of branch assets held for sale to loans held for investment— 26,171 — 
Reclassification of branch liabilities held for sale to interest-bearing transaction and savings deposits— 1,713 — 

F-23



 Year Ended December 31,
 202020192018
Noncash assets acquired1
  
Debt securities$— $660,792 $— 
Equity securities— 12,322 — 
FHLB and FRB stock — 29,490 — 
Loans held for sale— 9,360 — 
Loans held for investment— 3,245,248 (4,050)
Accrued interest receivable2
— 11,395 — 
Bank-owned life insurance— 56,841 — 
Bank premises, furniture and equipment— 36,855 1,162 
Investment in unconsolidated subsidiaries— 666 — 
Intangible assets, net— 65,718 (956)
Goodwill— 209,393 1,995 
Other assets— 11,124 1,806 
Right of use asset2
— 9,373 — 
Deferred taxes2
— 11,783 — 
Current taxes2
— 1,812 — 
Assets held for sale— 85,307 — 
Total assets$— $4,457,479 $(43)
Noncash liabilities assumed   
Noninterest-bearing deposits$— $825,364 $303 
Interest-bearing deposits— 1,300,825 — 
Certificates and other time deposits— 1,346,915 — 
Accounts payable and other liabilities— 26,491 — 
Lease liability3
— 9,373 — 
Accrued interest payable — 5,181 (260)
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase— 3,226 — 
Advances from FHLB— 300,000 — 
Subordinated debentures and subordinated notes— 56,233 — 
Liabilities held for sale— 52,682 — 
Total liabilities$— $3,926,290 $43 
Total equity— — — 
29,532,957 shares of common stock exchanged in connection with Green
$— $631,415 $— 
497,594 share of common stock exchanged in connection with Green vested RSUs
$— $5,801 $— 
1 Noncash assets acquired and noncash liabilities assumed during 2019 relate to our acquisition of Green. Noncash assets acquired and noncash liabilities assumed during 2018 relate to our acquisitions of Sovereign and Liberty.
2 Accrued interest receivable, right of use asset, deferred taxes and current taxes are included in "Other assets" in our consolidated balance sheets for the year ended December 31, 2019.
3 Lease liability is included in "Accounts payable and other liabilities" in our consolidated balance sheets for the year ended December 31, 2019.

3. Recent Accounting Pronouncements
ASU 2019-12, "Income Taxes (Topic 740)" ("ASU 2019-12") simplifies the accounting for income taxes by removing certain exceptions and improves the consistent application of GAAP by clarifying and amending other existing guidance. ASU 2019-012 will be effective for us on January 1, 2021 and is not expected to have any material impact on our consolidated financial statements.

ASU 2020-04, "Reference Rate Reform (Topic 848): Facilitation of the Effects of Reference Rate Reform on Financial Reporting" ("ASU 2020-04") amendments provide optional guidance for a limited time to ease the potential burden in accounting for reference rate reform. The new guidance provides optional expedients and exceptions for applying U.S. GAAP to contracts, hedging relationships and other transactions affected by reference rate reform if certain criteria are met. The
F-24



amendments apply only to contracts and hedging relationships that reference the London Interbank Offered Rate ("LIBOR") or another reference rate expected to be discontinued due to reference rate reform. These amendments are effective upon issuance and may be applied prospectively to contract modifications made and hedging relationships entered into or evaluated on or before December 31, 2022. The Company is currently evaluating the amended guidance and the impact on its consolidated financial statements and related disclosures.

ASU 2020-08, Codification Improvements to Subtopic 310-20, Receivables - Nonrefundable Fees and Other Costs ("ASU 2020-08") clarifies the accounting for the amortization of purchase premiums for callable debt securities with multiple call dates. ASU 2020-8 will be effective for us on January 1, 2021 and is not expected to have a significant impact on our consolidated financial statements and related disclosures.


4. Share Transactions

On January 28, 2019, the Company's Board of Directors (the “Board”) authorized a stock buyback program (the "Stock Buyback Program") pursuant to which the Company could, from time to time, purchase up to $50,000 of its outstanding common stock in the aggregate. The Board authorized increases of $50,000 on September 3, 2019 and $75,000 on December 12, 2019, resulting in an aggregate authorization to purchase up to $175,000 under the Stock Buyback Program. The Board also authorized an extension of the original expiration date from December 31, 2019 to December 31, 2020 and then to March 31, 2021. The shares may be repurchased in the open market or in privately negotiated transactions from time to time, depending upon market conditions and other factors, and in accordance with applicable regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”). The Stock Buyback Program does not obligate the Company to purchase any shares. The Stock Buyback Program may be terminated or amended by the Board at any time prior to its expiration.
During the year ended December 31, 2020, 2,349,639 shares were repurchased through the Stock Buyback Program and held as treasury stock at an average price of $24.51. During the year ended December 31, 2019, 3,802,711 shares were repurchased through the Stock Buyback Program and held as treasury stock at an average price of $24.86 per share.

F-25



5. Securities
Equity Securities With a Readily Determinable Fair Value
The Company held equity securities with a fair value of $11,363 and $11,122 at December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively. The Company realized a loss of $8 on equity securities with a readily determinable fair value during the year ended December 31, 2020. The Company had no realized gains or losses on equity securities with a readily determinable fair value during the same period in 2019 and 2018. The gross unrealized gain recognized on equity securities with readily determinable fair values recorded in other noninterest income in the Company’s consolidated statements of income were as follows:
202020192018
Unrealized gain recognized on equity securities with a readily determinable fair value$480 $325 $— 
Equity Securities Without a Readily Determinable Fair Value
The Company held equity securities without a readily determinable fair values and measured at cost of $3,575 at December 31, 2020 and 2019.
Debt Securities
Debt securities have been classified in the consolidated balance sheets according to management’s intent. The amortized cost, related gross unrealized gains and losses, allowance for credit losses and the fair value of available for sale and held to maturity debt securities are as follows:
 December 31, 2020
  GrossGross 
 AmortizedUnrealizedUnrealizedAllowance for 
 CostGainsLossesCredit LossesFair Value
Available for Sale                
Corporate bonds$173,050 $6,417 $1,297 — $178,170 
Municipal securities115,533 10,129 — 125,656 
Mortgage-backed securities240,320 16,047 42 — 256,325 
Collateralized mortgage obligations388,080 20,895 66 — 408,909 
Asset-backed securities52,335 2,934 — — 55,269 
 $969,318 $56,422 $1,411 $— $1,024,329 
GrossGross
AmortizedUnrealizedUnrealizedAllowance for
CostGainsLossesCredit LossesFair Value
Held to maturity
Mortgage-backed securities$6,982 $849 $— — $7,831 
Collateralized mortgage obligations1,620 103 — — 1,723 
Municipal securities22,270 2,459 — — 24,729 
$30,872 $3,411 $— — $34,283 

The Company did not transfer any debt securities from available for sale to held to maturity at fair value during the year ended December 31, 2020. 
F-26



 December 31, 2019
  GrossGross 
 AmortizedUnrealizedUnrealized 
 CostGainsLossesFair Value
Available for Sale                
Corporate bonds76,997 1,974 — 78,971 
Municipal securities74,956 3,724 — 78,680 
Mortgage-backed securities288,938 9,512 260 298,190 
Collateralized mortgage obligations431,276 6,465 1,503 436,238 
Asset-backed securities69,964 2,322 — 72,286 
 $942,131 $23,997 $1,763 $964,365 
Held to maturity
Mortgage-backed securities$8,621 $452 $— $9,073 
Collateralized mortgage obligations1,809 43 — 1,852 
Municipal securities22,535 1,350 — 23,885 
$32,965 $1,845 $— $34,810 
 
The Company reassessed the classification of certain investments and, effective January 1, 2019, the Company transferred $4,758 of municipal securities and $3,045 of mortgage-backed securities from available for sale to held to maturity at fair value. The related unrealized gain was minimal. No gain or loss was recorded at the time of the transfer.

The following tables disclose the Company’s available for sale debt securities in an unrealized loss position for which an allowance for credit losses has not been recorded, aggregated by investment category and length of time that individual debt securities have been in a continuous loss position:
 December 31, 2020
 Less Than 12 Months12 Months or MoreTotals
 FairUnrealizedFairUnrealizedFairUnrealized
 ValueLossValueLossValueLoss
Available for Sale                        
Corporate bonds31,953 1,297 — — 31,953 1,297 
Municipal securities$2,667 $$— $— $2,667 $
Mortgage-backed securities34,402 108 — — 34,402 108 
 $69,022 $1,411 $— $— $69,022 $1,411 
 
 December 31, 2019
 Less Than 12 Months12 Months or MoreTotals
 FairUnrealizedFairUnrealizedFairUnrealized
 ValueLossValueLossValueLoss
Available for Sale                        
Municipal securities468 — — 468 
Mortgage-backed securities28,883 370 — — 28,883 370 
Collateralized mortgage obligations109,749 1,392 — — 109,749 1,392 
 $139,100 $1,763 $— $— $139,100 $1,763 
 
F-27



Management evaluates available for sale debt securities in unrealized loss positions to determine whether the impairment is due to credit-related factors or noncredit-related factors. Consideration is given to (1) the extent to which the fair value is less than cost, (2) the financial condition and near-term prospects of the issuer, and (3) the intent and ability of the Company to retain its investment in the security for a period of time sufficient to allow for any anticipated recovery in fair value.
The number of available for sale debt securities in an unrealized loss position totaled 11 at December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019. Management does not have the intent to sell any of these securities and believes that it is more likely than not that the Company will not have to sell any such securities before a recovery of cost. The fair value is expected to recover as the securities approach their maturity date or repricing date or if market yields for such investments decline. Accordingly, as of December 31, 2020, management believes that the unrealized losses detailed in the previous table are due to noncredit-related factors, including changes in interest rates and other market conditions, and therefore no losses have been recognized in the Company’s consolidated statements of income.
The amortized costs and estimated fair values of available for sale debt securities, by contractual maturity, as of the dates indicated, are shown in the table below. Expected maturities will differ from contractual maturities because borrowers may have the right to call or prepay obligations with or without call or prepayment penalties. Mortgage-backed securities, collateralized mortgage obligations and asset-backed securities typically are issued with stated principal amounts, and the securities are backed by pools of mortgage loans and other loans that have varying maturities. The terms of mortgage-backed securities, collateralized mortgage obligations and asset-backed securities thus approximates the terms of the underlying mortgages and loans and can vary significantly due to prepayments. Therefore, these securities are not included in the maturity categories below.
 December 31, 2020
 Available For SaleHeld to Maturity
 AmortizedFairAmortizedFair
 CostValueCostValue
Due from one year to five years$4,935 $5,139 $— $— 
Due from five years to ten years154,576 158,510 3,334 3,591 
Due after ten years129,072 140,177 18,936 21,138 
 288,583 303,826 22,270 24,729 
Mortgage-backed securities and collateralized mortgage obligations628,400 665,234 8,602 9,554 
Asset-backed securities52,335 55,269 — — 
 $969,318 $1,024,329 $30,872 $34,283 
 
 December 31, 2019December 31, 2019
 Available For SaleHeld to Maturity
 AmortizedFairAmortizedFair
 CostValueCostValue
Due in one year or less$— $— $— $— 
Due from one year to five years4,904 5,100 — — 
Due from five years to ten years74,596 76,403 1,204 1,219 
Due after ten years72,453 76,148 21,331 22,666 
 151,953 157,651 22,535 23,885 
Mortgage-backed securities and collateralized mortgage obligations720,214 734,428 10,430 10,925 
Asset-backed securities69,964 72,286 — — 
 $942,131 $964,365 $32,965 $34,810 
  
F-28



Proceeds from sales of debt securities available for sale and gross realized gains and losses for the years ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018 were as follows:
 December 31,
 202020192018
Proceeds from sales$113,771 $567,718 $40,822 
Gross realized gains2,879 532 335 
Gross realized losses256 2,384 399 

As of December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019, there were no holdings of securities of any one issuer, other than the U.S. government and its agencies, in an amount greater than 10% of shareholders' equity. As further explained in Note 12, Advances from the FHLB, there was a blanket floating lien on all debt securities to secure FHLB advances as of December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019. 

6. Loans Held for Investment and Allowance for Credit Losses
Loans held for investment in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets are summarized as follows:
 December 31,
 20202019
Loans held for investment, carried at amortized cost:
Real estate:        
Construction and land$693,030 $629,374 
Farmland13,844 16,939 
1 - 4 family residential524,344 549,811 
Multi-family residential424,962 320,041 
OOCRE717,472 706,782 
NOOCRE1,904,132 1,784,201 
Commercial1,559,546 1,712,838 
MW577,594 183,628 
Consumer13,000 17,457 
 6,427,924 5,921,071 
Deferred loan (fees) costs, net(2,468)134 
Allowance for credit losses(105,084)(29,834)
Loans held for investment carried at amortized cost, net$6,320,372 $5,891,371 
Loans held for investment, carried at fair value:
PPP Loans$358,042 $— 
Total loans held for investment, net$6,678,414 $5,891,371 
Included in the net loan portfolio as of December 31, 2020 and 2019 is an accretable discount related to purchased performing and PCD loans, previously called PCI loans prior to the Company’s adoption of ASU 2016-13, acquired within a business combination in the approximate amounts of $15,526 and $57,811, respectively. The discount is being accreted into income on a level-yield basis over the life of the loans. For the years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019, the Company recognized $5,081 and $13,522, respectively, of accretion on PCD/PCI loans into interest income. In addition, included in the net loan portfolio as of December 31, 2020 and 2019 is a discount on retained loans from sale of originated SBA loans of $3,215 and $2,193, respectively.
F-29



The majority of the Company's loan portfolio consists of loans to businesses and individuals in the Dallas-Fort Worth metroplex and the Houston metropolitan area. This geographic concentration subjects the loan portfolio to the general economic conditions within these areas. The risks created by this concentration have been considered by management in the determination of the adequacy of the ACL. Management believes the ACL was adequate to cover estimated losses on loans as of December 31, 2020 and 2019.
PPP loans held for investment, carried at fair value
Additionally, included in total loans held for investment, as of December 31, 2020, was $358,042 of PPP loans, which are carried at fair value. During the year ended December 31, 2020, the Company recognized upfront fee income of $12,811 which is included in government guaranteed loan income, net on the accompanying consolidated statements of income. During the year ended December 31, 2020, the Company recognized a valuation adjustment of $1,799 on PPP loans which is included in government guaranteed loan income, net on the accompanying consolidated statements of income and in change in fair value of government guaranteed loans using fair value option on the accompanying consolidated statements of cash flows. These PPP loans were originated through the SBA as a result of the Coronavirus Aid, Relief, and Economic Security (“CARES”) Act and are considered 100% forgiven if certain criteria are met by the borrowers. As of December 31, 2020, we do not believe any of the Company’s PPP loans will not meet such criteria.
Allowance for Credit Losses
The Company’s estimate of the ACL reflects losses expected over the remaining contractual life of the assets. The contractual term does not consider extensions, renewals or modifications unless the Company has identified an expected troubled debt restructuring. The activity in the ACL related to loans held for investment is as follows:
 December 31, 2020
 Construction and LandFarmlandResidentialMultifamilyOOCRENOOCRECommercialConsumerTotal
Balance at beginning of year$3,821 $62 $2,143 $1,200 $1,991 $8,126 $12,369 $122 $29,834 
Impact of adopting ASC 326 non-PCD loans(707)3,716 628 3,406 5,138 7,025 217 19,427 
Impact of adoption ASC 326 PCD loans645 — 908 — 7,682 2,037 8,335 103 19,710 
Credit loss expense non-PCD loans4,554 (10)1,720 4,403 4,364 15,397 24,413 (178)54,663 
Credit loss expense PCD loans(545)— (378)— (5,303)7,404 817 (18)1,977 
Charge-offs— — (18)— (2,421)(2,865)(15,507)(162)(20,973)
Recoveries— — 57 — — — 102 287 446 
Ending Balance$7,768 $56 $8,148 $6,231 $9,719 $35,237 $37,554 $371 $105,084 

 December 31, 2019
 Construction and LandFarmlandResidentialMultifamilyOOCRENOOCRECommercialConsumerTotal
Balance at beginning of year$2,186 $58 $1,614 $361 $1,393 $5,070 $8,554 $19 $19,255 
Credit Loss Expense1,635 619 839 598 3,056 14,487 276 21,514 
Charge-offs— — (157)— — — (10,898)(265)(11,320)
Recoveries— — 67 — — — 226 92 385 
Ending Balance$3,821 $62 $2,143 $1,200 $1,991 $8,126 $12,369 $122 $29,834 


F-30



 December 31, 2018
 Construction and LandFarmlandResidentialMultifamilyOOCRENOOCRECommercialConsumerTotal
Balance at beginning of year$1,270 $45 $1,195 $278 $1,113 $3,297 $5,588 $22 $12,808 
Credit Loss Expense916 13 419 83 280 1,773 3,100 19 6,603 
Charge-offs— — — — — — (175)(22)(197)
Recoveries— — — — — — 41 — 41 
Ending Balance$2,186 $58 $1,614 $361 $1,393 $5,070 $8,554 $19 $19,255 

A loan is considered collateral-dependent when the borrower is experiencing financial difficulty and repayment is expected to be provided substantially through the operation or sale of the collateral. The following table presents the amortized cost basis of collateral dependent loans, which are individually evaluated to determine expected credit losses, and the related ACL allocated to these loans as of December 31, 2020:



 
Real Property(1)
ACL Allocation
Real estate:        
1 - 4 family residential$199 $11 
OOCRE— — 
NOOCRE16,080 — 
Commercial8,666 4,668 
Consumer143 50 
Total$25,088 $4,729 
(1) Loans reported exclude PCD loans that transitioned upon adoption of ASC 326 and accounted for on a pooled basis. Refer to Note 1 for further discussion.


The following table presents loans individually and collectively evaluated for impairment, as well as PCI loans, and their respective allowance for credit loss allocations as of December 31, 2019, as determined in accordance with ASC 310 prior to the Company’s adoption of ASU 2016-13:
 December 31, 2019
 Real Estate   
 Construction,
Land and
Farmland
ResidentialCommercial Real EstateCommercialConsumerTotal
Loans individually evaluated for impairment$567 $156 $21,644 $5,188 $61 $27,616 
Loans collectively evaluated for impairment641,799 865,927 2,372,485 1,869,259 17,267 5,766,737 
PCI loans3,947 3,769 96,854 22,019 129 126,718 
Total$646,313 $869,852 $2,490,983 $1,896,466 $17,457 $5,921,071 
ACL Allocations
Loans individually evaluated for impairment$128 $37 $395 $1,042 $— $1,602 
Loans collectively evaluated for impairment3,755 3,306 9,702 10,754 122 27,639 
PCI loans— — 20 573 — 593 
Total$3,883 $3,343 $10,117 $12,369 $122 $29,834 

F-31



The following table presents information on impaired loans as of December 31, 2019, as determined in accordance with ASC 310 prior to the Company’s adoption of ASU 2016-13:    
 
December 31, 2019(1)
 Unpaid
Contractual
Principal
Balance
Recorded
Investment
with No
Allowance
Recorded
Investment
with
Allowance
Total
Recorded
Investment
Related
Allowance
Average
Recorded
Investment
YTD
Real estate:                        
Construction and land$567 $— $567 $567 $128 $1,793 
Farmland— — — — — — 
1 - 4 family residential156 — 156 156 37 158 
Multi-family residential— — — — — — 
Commercial real estate21,644 21,040 604 21,644 395 22,529 
Commercial5,188 2,011 3,177 5,188 1,042 8,546 
Consumer61 61 — 61 — 62 
Total$27,616 $23,112 $4,504 $27,616 $1,602 $33,088 
(1) Loans reported exclude PCI loans.

Nonaccrual and Past Due Loans
Loans are considered past due if the required principal and interest payments have not been received as of the date such payments were due. Loans are placed on nonaccrual status when, in management’s opinion, the borrower may be unable to meet payment obligations as they become due, as well as when required by regulatory provisions. Loans may be placed on nonaccrual status regardless of whether or not such loans are considered past due. When interest accrual is discontinued, all unpaid accrued interest is reversed. Interest income is subsequently recognized only to the extent cash payments are received in excess of principal due. Loans are returned to accrual status when all the principal and interest amounts contractually due are brought current and future payments are reasonably assured.
Nonaccrual loans, aggregated by class of loans, as of December 31, 2020 and 2019, were as follows:
 December 31,
2020
December 31,
2019
NonaccrualNonaccrual With No ACLNonaccrualNonaccrual With No ACL
Real estate:        
Construction and land$— $— $567 $— 
1 - 4 family residential3,308 3,199 1,581 1,581 
OOCRE6,266 5,645 3,029 2,778 
NOOCRE40,830 19,213 18,876 18,876 
Commercial29,318 1,015 5,672 2,747 
Consumer1,374 1,220 54 54 
Total$81,096 $30,292 $29,779 $26,036 
There were $1,508 of PCD loans that are not accounted for on a pooled basis included in nonaccrual loans at December 31, 2020. There were no PCD loans included in nonaccrual loans at December 31, 2019.
During the year ended December 31, 2020 and 2019, interest income not recognized on non-accrual loans, excluding PCD/PCI loans, was $3,368 and $1,672, respectively.
F-32



An age analysis of past due loans, aggregated by class of loans, as of December 31, 2020 and 2019 is as follows:
 December 31, 2020
 30 to 59 Days60 to 89 Days90 Days or GreaterTotal Past DueTotal CurrentPCDTotal
Loans
Total 90 Days Past Due and Still Accruing(1)
Real estate:                            
Construction and land$— $— $— $— $690,345 $2,685 $693,030 $— 
Farmland— — — — 13,844 — 13,844 — 
1 - 4 family residential2,338 122 4,802 7,262 508,341 8,741 524,344 1,670 
Multi-family residential— — — — 424,962 — 424,962 — 
OOCRE2,278 2,143 2,814 7,235 672,246 37,991 717,472 1,280 
NOOCRE7,675 2,911 17,586 28,172 1,832,784 43,176 1,904,132 — 
Commercial1,983 1,431 20,360 23,774 1,516,312 19,460 1,559,546 1,230 
MW— — — — 577,594 — 577,594 — 
Consumer75 77 1,338 1,490 11,308 202 13,000 24 
 $14,349 $6,684 $46,900 $67,933 $6,247,736 $112,255 $6,427,924 $4,204 
(1) Loans 90 days past due and still accruing excludes $32,627 of pooled PCD loans as of December 31, 2020 that transitioned upon adoption of ASC 326. Refer to Note 1 for further discussion.

 December 31, 2019
 30 to 59 Days60 to 89 Days90 Days or GreaterTotal Past DueTotal CurrentPCITotal
Loans
Total 90 Days Past Due and Still Accruing (1)
Real estate:                            
Construction and land$— $— $— $— $629,374 $3,947 $629,374 $800 
Farmland— — — — 16,939 — 16,939 — 
1 - 4 family residential2,595 520 1,155 4,270 541,772 3,769 549,811 959 
Multi-family residential— — — — 320,041 — 320,041 — 
Commercial real estate12 3,834 868 4,714 2,389,415 96,854 2,490,983 511 
Commercial3,572 1,707 1,497 6,776 1,684,043 22,019 1,712,838 1,317 
Consumer30 2,641 140 2,811 14,646 129 17,457 73 
 $6,209 $8,702 $3,660 $18,571 $5,596,230 $126,718 $5,737,443 $3,660 
(1) Loans 90 days past due and still accruing excludes $41,328 of PCI loans accounted for on a pooled basis as of December 31, 2019.
 
Loans 90 days past due and still accruing interest were $4,204 and $3,660 as of December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019, respectively. These loans are considered well-secured and in the process of collection as of the reporting date with plans in place for the borrowers to bring the loans fully current. The Company believes that it will collect all principal and interest due on each of the loans 90 days past due and still accruing.
Troubled Debt Restructuring
Modifications of terms for the Company’s loans and their inclusion as TDRs are based on individual facts and circumstances. Loan modifications that are included as TDRs may involve a reduction of the stated interest rate of the loan, an extension of the maturity date at a stated rate of interest lower than the current market rate for new debt with similar risk, or deferral of principal payments, regardless of the period of the modification. The recorded investment in TDRs was $29,157 and $2,142 as of December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively.
F-33



The following table presents the pre- and post-modification amortized cost of loans modified as TDRs during the twelve months ended December 31, 2020. There were thirteen and two new TDRs during the years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019. The Company did not grant principal reductions or interest rate concessions on any TDRs during the twelve months ended December 31, 2020. The terms of certain loans modified as TDRs during the year ended December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019 are summarized in the following tables:
During the year ended December 31, 2020
 Adjusted Payment StructurePayment DeferralsTotal ModificationsNumber of Loans
OOCRE$5,326 $— $5,326 
NOOCRE— 19,454 19,454 
Commercial1,419 1,345 2,764 
Total$6,745 $20,799 $27,544 13 

During the year ended December 31, 2019
 Adjusted Payment StructurePayment DeferralsTotal ModificationsNumber of Loans
Commercial$919 $115 $1,034 
There were no loans modified as TDR loans within the previous 12 months and for which there was a payment default during the years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019. A default for purposes of this disclosure is a TDR loan in which the borrower is 90 days past due or results in the foreclosure and repossession of the applicable collateral.
Interest income recorded during the years ended December 31, 2020 on TDR loans and interest income that would have been recorded had the terms of the loans not been modified was $1,537. Interest income recorded during the year ended December 31, 2019 on TDR loans and interest income that would have been recorded had the terms of the loans not been modified was minimal.
The Company has not committed to lend additional amounts to customers with outstanding loans classified as TDRs as of December 31, 2020 or December 31, 2019.
For the year ended December 31, 2020, the Company had 754 modifications of loans with aggregate principal balances of $1,126,975 that qualified for temporary suspension of TDR requirements under Section 4013 of the CARES Act, as amended by the Consolidated Appropriations Act, 2021, and related interagency guidance of the federal banking agencies. As of February 18, 2021, the Company had $26,111 in loans with remaining deferments.

Credit Quality Indicators
From a credit risk standpoint, the Company classifies its loans in one of the following categories: (i) pass, (ii) special mention, (iii) substandard or (iv) doubtful. Loans classified as loss are charged-off. Loans not rated special mention, substandard, doubtful or loss are classified as pass loans.
    The classifications of loans reflect a judgment about the risks of default and loss associated with the loan. The Company reviews the ratings on criticized credits monthly. Ratings are adjusted to reflect the degree of risk and loss that is felt to be inherent in each credit as of each monthly reporting period. All classified credits are evaluated for impairment. If impairment is determined to exist, a specific reserve is established. The Company’s methodology is structured so that specific reserves are increased in accordance with deterioration in credit quality (and a corresponding increase in risk and loss) or decreased in accordance with improvement in credit quality (and a corresponding decrease in risk and loss).
    Credits rated special mention show clear signs of financial weaknesses or deterioration in credit worthiness, however, such concerns are generally not so pronounced that the Company expects to experience significant loss within the short-term. Such credits typically maintain the ability to perform within standard credit terms and credit exposure is not as prominent as credits with a lower rating.
F-34



    Credits rated substandard are those in which the normal repayment of principal and interest may be, or has been, jeopardized by reason of adverse trends or developments of a financial, managerial, economic or political nature, or important weaknesses which exist in collateral. A protracted workout on these credits is a distinct possibility. Prompt corrective action is therefore required to strengthen the Company’s position, and/or to reduce exposure and to assure that adequate remedial measures are taken by the borrower. Credit exposure becomes more likely in such credits and a serious evaluation of the secondary support to the credit is performed.
    Credits rated doubtful are those in which full collection of principal appears highly questionable, and in which some degree of loss is anticipated, even though the ultimate amount of loss may not yet be certain and/or other factors exist which could affect collection of debt. Based upon available information, positive action by the Company is required to avert or minimize loss. Credits rated doubtful are generally also placed on nonaccrual.
    Credits classified as PCD are those that, at acquisition date, have experienced a more-than-insignificant deterioration in credit quality since origination. All loans considered to be PCI loans prior to January 1, 2020 were converted to PCD loans upon adoption of ASC 326. The Company elected to maintain pools of loans that were previously accounted for under ASC 310-30 and will continue to account for these pools as a unit of account. Loans are only removed from the existing pools if they are foreclosed, written off, paid off, or sold.
The Company considers the guidance in ASC 310-20 when determining whether a modification, extension or renewal of a loan constitutes a current period origination. Generally, current period renewals of credit are reunderwritten at the point of renewal and considered current period originations for purposes of the table below. Based on the most recent analysis performed, the risk category of loans by class of loans based on year or origination is as follows:    
 
Term Loans Amortized Cost Basis by Origination Year1
 20202019201820172016PriorRevolving Loans Amortized Cost BasisRevolving Loans Converted to TermTotal
As of December 31, 2020
Construction and land:
Pass$155,358 $282,497 $179,372 $11,791 $9,938 $27,147 $21,066 $— $687,169 
Special mention— — 2,666 — — — — — 2,666 
Substandard— — 510 — — — — — 510 
PCD— — — — — 2,685 — — 2,685 
Total construction and land$155,358 $282,497 $182,548 $11,791 $9,938 $29,832 $21,066 $— $693,030 
Farmland:
Pass$867 $972 $3,367 $3,688 $— $3,656 $1,294 $— $13,844 
Total farmland$867 $972 $3,367 $3,688 $— $3,656 $1,294 $— $13,844 
1 - 4 family residential:
Pass$120,580 $79,617 $91,890 $49,338 $31,936 $115,797 $19,065 $2,968 $511,191 
Special mention— 1,077 154 760 — 687 — — 2,678 
Substandard— — 142 668 — — 924 — 1,734 
PCD— — — — — 8,741 — — 8,741 
Total 1 - 4 family residential$120,580 $80,694 $92,186 $50,766 $31,936 $125,225 $19,989 $2,968 $524,344 
Multi-family residential:
Pass$107,332 $106,559 $139,721 $18,722 $32,672 $7,218 $58 $— $412,282 
Special mention— — 12,680 — — — — — 12,680 
Total multi-family residential$107,332 $106,559 $152,401 $18,722 $32,672 $7,218 $58 $— $424,962 
OOCRE:
Pass$113,741 $65,262 $75,940 $79,253 $79,202 $176,668 $5,532 $— $595,598 
Special mention— 948 22,725 3,701 12,860 4,326 — — 44,560 
Substandard370 — 10,579 3,830 11,315 6,822 201 6,206 39,323 
F-35



PCD— — — — 7,951 30,040 — — 37,991 
Total OOCRE$114,111 $66,210 $109,244 $86,784 $111,328 $217,856 $5,733 $6,206 $717,472 
NOOCRE:
Pass$361,246 $255,976 $445,079 $90,738 $174,893 $309,572 $13,413 $— $1,650,917 
Special mention101 31,714 37,572 19,262 25,997 37,951 493 — 153,090 
Substandard1,226 09,850 04,562 4,108 — 23,098 14,105 — 56,949 
PCD— — 18,744 — 6,652 17,780 — — 43,176 
Total NOOCRE$362,573 $297,540 $505,957 $114,108 $207,542 $388,401 $28,011 $— $1,904,132 
Commercial:
Pass$251,004 $158,158 $112,961 $50,734 $19,821 $41,856 $758,832 $13,400 $1,406,766 
Special mention1,306 2,539 8,224 10,033 1,201 2,165 26,922 3,670 56,060 
Substandard722 4,487 23,245 3,772 7,216 2,083 30,460 5,275 77,260 
PCD— — — 3,382 4,196 11,882 — — 19,460 
Total commercial$253,032 $165,184 $144,430 $67,921 $32,434 $57,986 $816,214 $22,345 $1,559,546 
MW:
Pass$— $— $— $— $— $— $577,594 $— $577,594 
Total MW$— $— $— $— $— $— $577,594 $— $577,594 
Consumer:
Pass$2,489 $1,216 $1,038 $3,899 $887 $353 $1,475 $— $11,357 
Special mention— — — — 25 227 — — 252 
Substandard— — — 60 — 66 1,063 — 1,189 
PCD— — — 36 — 166 — — 202 
Total consumer$2,489 $1,216 $1,038 $3,995 $912 $812 $2,538 $— $13,000 
Total Pass$1,112,617 $950,257 $1,049,368 $308,163 $349,349 $682,267 $1,398,329 $16,368 $5,866,718 
Total Special Mention1,407 36,278 84,021 33,756 40,083 45,356 27,415 3,670 271,986 
Total Substandard2,318 14,337 39,038 12,438 18,531 32,069 46,753 11,481 176,965 
Total PCD— — 18,744 3,418 18,799 71,294 — — 112,255 
Total$1,116,342 $1,000,872 $1,191,171 $357,775 $426,762 $830,986 $1,472,497 $31,519 $6,427,924 
.
1 Term loans amortized cost basis by origination year excludes $2,468 of deferred loan fees, net.

The following table summarizes the Company’s internal ratings of its loans, including PCI loans, as of December 31, 2019:
 December 31, 2019
 PassSpecial
Mention
SubstandardDoubtfulPCITotal
Real estate:                        
Construction and land$618,773 $3,965 $2,689 $— $3,947 $629,374 
Farmland16,939 — — — — 16,939 
1 - 4 family residential541,787 795 3,460 — 3,769 549,811 
Multi-family residential320,041 — — — — 320,041 
Commercial real estate2,332,357 23,494 38,278 — 96,854 2,490,983 
Commercial1,610,150 51,999 28,670 — 22,019 1,712,838 
MW183,628 — — — — 183,628 
Consumer17,106 40 182 — 129 17,457 
Total$5,640,781 $80,293 $73,279 $— $126,718 $5,921,071 

 
F-36



Purchased Credit Impaired Loans (Prior to the Adoption of ASU 2016-13)
Loans acquired with evidence of credit quality deterioration at acquisition, for which it was probable that the Company would not be able to collect all contractual amounts due, were accounted for as PCI loans. The carrying amount of PCI loans included in the consolidated balance sheets and the related outstanding balances at December 31, 2019 are set forth in the table below. The outstanding balance represents the total amount owed, including accrued but unpaid interest, and any amounts previously charged off.
 December 31, 2019
Carrying amount$126,125 
Outstanding balance157,417 
Changes in the accretable yield for PCI loans for the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018 are included in table below.
 Year Ended December 31, 2019Year Ended December 31, 2018
Balance at beginning of period$18,747 $2,723 
Additions19,870 1,459 
Reclassifications from nonaccretable12,719 19,162 
Accretion(13,112)(4,597)
Balance at year-end$38,224 $18,747 
During the year ended December 31, 2019, the Company received cash collections in excess of expected cash flows on PCI loans accounted for individually and not aggregated into loan pools of $440.
Servicing Assets
The Company was servicing loans of approximately $264,019 and $205,210 as of December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively. A summary of the changes in the related servicing assets are as follows:
 Year Ended December 31,
 20202019
Balance at beginning of year$3,113 $1,304 
Servicing assets acquired through acquisition— 2,382 
Increase from loan sales1,121 1,253 
Servicing asset impairment, net of recoveries(368)(188)
Amortization charged as a reduction to income(503)(1,638)
Balance at year-end$3,363 $3,113 
Fair value of servicing assets is estimated by discounting estimated future cash flows from the servicing assets using discount rates that approximate current market rates over the expected lives of the loans being serviced. A valuation allowance is recorded when the fair value is below the carrying amount of the asset. As of December 31, 2020 and 2019 there was a valuation allowance of $556 and $188, respectively.
The Company may also receive a portion of subsequent interest collections on loans sold that exceed the contractual servicing fees. In that case, the Company records an interest-only strip based on its relative fair market value and the other components of the loans. There was no interest-only strip receivable recorded at December 31, 2020 and 2019.
During the years ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018, the Bank sold $41,488, $64,830 and $26,662, respectively, of SBA loans held for investment resulting in a gain of $3,379, $4,388 and $2,348, respectively. The gain on sale of SBA loans is recorded in government guaranteed loan income, net in the accompanying consolidated statements of income. 
F-37



7. Bank Premises and Equipment
Bank premises and equipment in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets are summarized as follows:
 December 31,
 20202019
Building and improvements$61,035 $60,959 
Site improvements3,303 2,633 
Tenant improvements779 744 
Leasehold improvements5,923 5,542 
Land44,078 45,878 
Furniture, fixtures and equipment17,751 16,073 
Construction in Progress630 608 
 133,499 132,437 
Less accumulated depreciation and amortization18,436 13,901 
 $115,063 $118,536 
The Company recorded depreciation and amortization expense of approximately $4,535, $3,911 and $3,017 for the years ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018, respectively.

8. Leases
Operating leases in which the Company is the lessee are recorded as operating lease ROU assets and operating lease liabilities, included in other assets and accounts payable and other liabilities, respectively, on the Company’s consolidated balance sheets. The Company does not currently have finance leases in which it is the lessee.
    Operating lease ROU assets represent the Company’s right to use an underlying asset during the lease term and operating liabilities represent its obligation to make lease payments arising from the lease. ROU assets and operating lease liabilities are recognized at lease commencement based on the present value of the remaining lease payments using a discount rate that represents the Company’s incremental borrowing rate at the lease commencement date. ROU assets are further adjusted for lease incentives. Operating lease expense, which is comprised of amortization of the ROU asset and the implicit interest accreted on the operating lease liability, is recognized on a straight-line basis over the lease term, and is recorded in net occupancy expense in the consolidated statements of income.     
    The Company’s leases related primarily to office space and bank branches with remaining lease terms generally ranging from one to eight years. Certain lease arrangements contain extension options which typically range from five to 10 years at the then fair market rental rates. As these extension options are not generally considered reasonably certain of exercise, they are not included in the lease term. As of December 31, 2020, operating lease ROU assets and liabilities were $14,875 and $15,601, respectively. As of December 31, 2019, operating lease ROU assets and liabilities were $13,205 and $14,095, respectively, and is recorded in other assets and accounts payable and accrued expenses, respectively, in the consolidated balance sheets.
    The table below summarizes the Company’s net lease cost:

For the Year Ended December 31,
20202019
Operating lease cost$4,131 $4,999 
Variable lease cost810 988 
Net lease cost$4,941 $5,987 

    The table below summarizes other information related to the Company’s operating leases:

F-38



For the Year Ended December 31,
20202019
Cash paid for amounts included in the measurement of lease liabilities:
Operating cash flows from operating leases$3,994 $4,325 
Weighted-average remaining lease term - operating leases, in years3.3 years4.4 years
Weighted-average discount rate - operating leases1.56 %1.59 %

    A maturity analysis of operating lease liabilities and reconciliation of the undiscounted cash flows to the total operating lease liability is as follows:
December 31, 2020
Lease payments due:
Within one year$3,637 
After one but within two years3,323 
After two but within three years3,246 
After three but within four years2,808 
After four but within five years2,058 
After five years1,325 
Total undiscounted cash flows16,397 
Less: Discount on cash flows(796)
Total lease liability$15,601 

    There were no sale and leaseback transactions, leveraged leases or lease transactions with related parties during the years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019. As of December 31, 2020, the Company did not have any leases that had not yet commenced, but will create significant rights and obligations for the Company.

9. Intangible Assets
Intangible assets in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets are summarized as follows:
 December 31, 2020
Remaining
 WeightedGross Net
 AmortizationIntangibleValuationAccumulatedIntangible
 PeriodAssetAllowanceAmortizationAsset
Core deposit intangibles6.0 years$81,769 $— $24,011 $57,758 
Servicing asset7.4 years6,847 556 2,928 3,363 
Intangible lease assets1.4 years4,779 — 4,167 612 
  $93,395 $556 $31,106 $61,733 
 




 December 31, 2019
Remaining
 WeightedGross Net
 AmortizationIntangibleValuationAccumulatedIntangible
 PeriodAssetAllowanceAmortizationAsset
Core deposit intangibles7.0 years$81,769 $— $14,206 $67,563 
Servicing asset6.7 years5,726 188 2,425 3,113 
Intangible lease assets1.4 years4,765 — 3,178 1,587 
  $92,260 $188 $19,809 $72,263 
 
For the years ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018, amortization expense related to intangible assets of approximately $11,297, $12,022 and $4,060, respectively, is included within amortization of intangibles, occupancy and equipment and other income within the consolidated statements of income. For the years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019, a valuation allowance related to intangible assets was 556 and $188, respectively. There was no impairment expense related to intangible assets as of December 31, 2018. The estimated aggregate future amortization expense for intangible assets remaining as of December 31, 2020 was as follows:
YearAmount
2021$10,509 
202210,439 
202310,266 
202410,238 
20259,800 
Thereafter10,481 
 $61,733 

10. Goodwill
Changes in the carrying amount of goodwill in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets are summarized as follows:
 December 31,
 20202019
Balance at beginning of year$370,840 $161,447 
Green acquisition— 209,393 
Balance at end of year$370,840 $370,840 
 
F-40



11. Deposits
Deposits in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets are summarized as follows:
 December 31,
 20202019
Noninterest-bearing demand accounts$2,097,099 $1,556,500 
Interest-bearing demand accounts453,111 388,877 
Savings accounts106,820 86,079 
Limited access money market accounts2,398,525 2,180,016 
Certificates of deposit, greater than $1001,179,853 1,234,324 
Certificates of deposit, less than $100277,438 448,554 
Total$6,512,846 $5,894,350 

As of December 31, 2020, the scheduled maturities of certificates of deposit were as follows:
YearAmount
2021$1,194,780 
2022217,932 
202324,035 
202412,365 
20258,179 
Total$1,457,291 
The aggregate amount of demand deposit overdrafts that have been reclassified as loans were $106 and $259 as of December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively. Brokered deposits at December 31, 2020 and 2019 totaled approximately $199,801 and $312,467, respectively.

12. Advances from the FHLB
Advances from the FHLB totaled $777,718 and $677,870 at December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively. As of December 31, 2020, the advances were collateralized by a blanket floating lien on certain debt securities and loans, had a weighted average rate of 0.94% and mature on various dates from 2022 to 2035. The Company had the availability to borrow additional funds of approximately $766,437 as of December 31, 2020.
Contractual maturities of FHLB advances at December 31, 2020 were as follows:
2022$27,718 
2025 and thereafter750,000 
Total$777,718 
 
13. Other Credit Extensions
As of December 31, 2020 the Company maintained five credit facilities with commercial banks that provided federal funds credit extensions with an availability to borrow up to an aggregate amount of $175,000. As of December 31, 2019, the Company maintained three credit facilities with commercial banks that provide federal funds credit extensions with an availability to borrow up to an aggregate amount of approximately $150,000. There were no borrowings under these credit facilities as of December 31, 2020 and 2019.
As of December 31, 2020 and 2019, the Company maintained a secured line of credit with the FRB with an availability to borrow approximately $871,485 and $1,022,401, respectively. Approximately $94,222 and $843,861 of
F-41



commercial loans were pledged as collateral at December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively. There were no borrowings under this line of credit as of December 31, 2020 and 2019.

14. Borrowed Funds
Borrowed funds in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets are as follows:
 December 31,
 20202019
Junior subordinated debentures (1)
$30,244 $30,023 
Subordinated notes (2)
232,534 115,548 
$262,778 $145,571 
(1) Junior subordinated debentures are net of a discount of $3,624 and 3,845 as of December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively.
(2) Subordinated notes include a premium of $1,038 and $2,081 and debt issuance costs of $3,504 and $1,533 as of December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively.
 
Junior Subordinated Debentures
In connection with a previous acquisition, the Company assumed $3,093 in fixed to floating rate junior subordinated debentures underlying common securities and preferred capital securities (the “Parkway Trust Securities”), issued by Parkway National Capital Trust I (“Parkway Trust”), a statutory business trust and acquired wholly owned subsidiary of the Company. The Company became a guarantor and, as such, unconditionally guaranteed payment of accrued and unpaid distributions required to be paid on the Parkway Trust Securities subject to certain exceptions, the redemption price when a capital security is called for redemption and amounts due if Parkway Trust is liquidated or terminated.
The Company owns all of the outstanding common securities of the Parkway Trust. The Parkway Trust used the proceeds from the issuance of the Parkway Trust Securities to buy the debentures originally issued by Fidelity Resource Company. These debentures are the Parkway Trust’s only assets and the interest payments from the debentures finance the distributions paid on the Parkway Trust Securities.
The Parkway Trust Securities pay cumulative cash distributions quarterly at a rate per annum equal to the 3-month LIBOR plus 1.85%. So long as no event of default leading to an acceleration event has occurred, the Company has the right at any time and from time to time during the term of the debentures to defer payments of interest by extending the interest distribution period for up to twenty consecutive quarterly periods. The effective rate as of December 31, 2020 and 2019 was 2.07% and 3.74%, respectively. The Parkway Trust Securities are subject to mandatory redemption, in whole or in part, upon repayment of the debentures at the stated maturity in the year 2036 or their earlier redemption, in each case at a redemption price equal to the aggregate liquidation preference of the Parkway Trust Securities plus any accumulated and unpaid distributions thereon to the date of redemption. Prior redemption is permitted under certain circumstances.
In connection with the acquisition of Sovereign on August 1, 2017, the Company assumed $8,609 in floating rate junior subordinated debentures underlying common securities and preferred capital securities (the “SovDallas Trust Securities”), issued by SovDallas Capital Trust I (“SovDallas Trust”), a statutory business trust and wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company. The Company became a guarantor and, as such, unconditionally guaranteed payment of accrued and unpaid distributions required to be paid on the SovDallas Trust Securities subject to certain exceptions, the redemption price when a capital security is called for redemption and amounts due if SovDallas Trust is liquidated or terminated. The Company also owns all of the outstanding common securities of the SovDallas Trust.

F-42



The SovDallas Trust invested the total proceeds from the sale of the SovDallas Trust Securities and the investment in common shares in floating rate junior subordinated debentures originally issued by Sovereign. Interest on the SovDallas Trust Securities is payable quarterly at a rate equal to 3-month LIBOR plus 4.00%. Principal payments are due at maturity in July 2038. The effective rate as of December 31, 2020 and 2019 was 4.23% and 6.10%. The SovDallas Trust Securities are guaranteed by the Company and are subject to redemption. The Company may redeem the debt securities, in whole or in part, at any time at an amount equal to the principal amount of the debt securities being redeemed plus any accrued and unpaid interest.
In connection with the acquisition of Green on January 1, 2019, the Company assumed $5,155 in floating rate junior subordinated debentures underlying common securities and preferred capital securities (the “Patriot I Trust Securities”), issued by Patriot I Capital Trust I (“Patriot I Trust”), a statutory business trust and wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company. The Company became a guarantor and, as such, unconditionally guaranteed payment of accrued and unpaid distributions required to be paid on the Patriot I Trust Securities subject to certain exceptions, the redemption price when a capital security is called for redemption and amounts due if Patriot I Trust is liquidated or terminated. The Company also owns all of the outstanding common securities of the Patriot I Trust.
The Patriot I Trust invested the total proceeds from the sale of the Patriot I Trust Securities and the investment in common shares in floating rate junior subordinated debentures originally issued by Green. Interest on the Patriot I Trust Securities is payable quarterly at a rate equal to 3-month LIBOR plus 1.85%. Principal payments are due at maturity in April 2036. The effective rate as of December 31, 2020 and 2019 was 2.09% and 3.84%. The Patriot I Trust Securities are guaranteed by the Company and are subject to redemption. The Company may redeem the debt securities, in whole or in part, at any time at an amount equal to the principal amount of the debt securities being redeemed plus any accrued and unpaid interest.
In connection with the acquisition of Green on January 1, 2019, the Company assumed $17,011 in floating rate junior subordinated debentures underlying common securities and preferred capital securities (the “Patriot II Trust Securities”), issued by Patriot II Capital Trust I (“Patriot II Trust”), a statutory business trust and wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company. The Company became a guarantor and, as such, unconditionally guaranteed payment of accrued and unpaid distributions required to be paid on the Patriot II Trust Securities subject to certain exceptions, the redemption price when a capital security is called for redemption and amounts due if Patriot II Trust is liquidated or terminated. The Company also owns all of the outstanding common securities of the Patriot II Trust.
The Patriot II Trust invested the total proceeds from the sale of the Patriot II Trust Securities and the investment in common shares in floating rate junior subordinated debentures originally issued by Sovereign. Interest on the Patriot II Trust Securities is payable quarterly at a rate equal to 3-month LIBOR plus 1.80%. Principal payments are due at maturity in September 2037. The effective rate as of December 31, 2020 and 2019 was 2.02% and 3.69%. The Patriot II Trust Securities are guaranteed by the Company and are subject to redemption. The Company may redeem the debt securities, in whole or in part, at any time at an amount equal to the principal amount of the debt securities being redeemed plus any accrued and unpaid interest.
The Parkway Trust Securities, SovDallas Trust Securities, Patriot I Trust Securities and Patriot II Trust Securities qualify as Tier 1 capital, subject to regulatory limitations, under guidelines established by the Federal Reserve.
Subordinated Notes
During 2013 the Company issued, in the aggregate principal amount of $5,000, subordinated promissory notes (the “Notes”) in a private offering. The Notes were issued to certain entities controlled by an affiliate of the Company. The Notes are unsecured, with interest payable quarterly at a fixed rate of 6.0% per annum, and unpaid principal and interest due at the stated maturity on December 31, 2023. The Notes qualify as Tier 2 Capital, subject to regulatory limitations, under guidelines established by the Federal Reserve. In addition, the Notes may be redeemed, in whole or in part, on any interest payment date that occurs on or after December 23, 2018, subject to approval of the Federal Reserve. The Notes were redeemed in whole on February 14, 2020.
In connection with the issuance of the Notes, the Company issued warrants to purchase 25,000 shares of common stock of the Company at an exercise price of $11.00 per share, exercisable at any time, in whole or in part, prior to December 31, 2023. The fair value of the warrants was calculated at $0.80 and is recorded as additional paid-in capital, and the related debt discount is being accreted into interest expense. 10,000 warrants were exercised on February 12, 2020, costing $110,000.
F-43



In connection with the Company’s acquisition of Green on January 1, 2019, the Company assumed $35,000 of 8.50% Fixed-to-Floating Rate Subordinated Notes (the “8.50% Fixed-to-Floating Notes”) that mature on December 15, 2026. The 8.50% Fixed-to-Floating Notes, which qualify as Tier 2 capital under the Federal Reserve’s capital guidelines, have an interest rate of 8.50% per annum during the fixed-rate period from date of issuance through December 15, 2021. Interest is payable semi-annually on each June 15 and December 15 through December 15, 2021.

During the floating rate period from December 15, 2021, to but excluding the maturity date or date of earlier redemption, the 8.50% Fixed-to-Floating Notes will bear interest at a rate per annum equal to three-month LIBOR for the related interest period plus 6.685%, payable quarterly on each March 15, June 15, September 15 and December 15. The 8.50% Fixed-to-Floating Notes are subordinated in right of payment to all of the Company's senior indebtedness and effectively subordinated to all existing and future debt and all other liabilities of the Bank. The Company may elect to redeem the 8.50% Fixed-to-Floating Notes (subject to regulatory approval), in whole or in part, on any early redemption date which is any interest payment date on or after December 15, 2021 at a redemption price equal to 100% of the principal amount plus any accrued and unpaid interest. Other than on an early redemption date, the 8.50% Fixed-to-Floating Notes cannot be accelerated except in the event of bankruptcy or the occurrence of certain other events of insolvency or reorganization.

On November 8, 2019, the Company issued $75,000 in aggregate principal amount of 4.75% Fixed-to-Floating Rate Subordinated Notes (the "2019 Notes"). The 2019 Notes were issued in a private placement transaction to certain qualified institutional buyers and accredited and were registered under the Securities Act effective February 13, 2020. The 2019 Notes were issued under an indenture for Fixed-to-Floating Rate Subordinated Notes dated November 8, 2019, between Veritex Holdings, Inc., as issuer, and UMB Bank, N.A., as trustee. The Company may elect to redeem the 2019 Notes (subject to regulatory approval), in whole or in part, on any early redemption date which is any interest payment date on or after November 15, 2024 at a redemption price equal to 100% of the principal amount plus any accrued and unpaid interest. The 2019 Notes, which qualify as Tier 2 capital under the Federal Reserve's capital guidelines, have an interest rate of 4.75% per annum during the fixed rate period from date of issuance through November 15, 2024. Interest is payable semi-annually on each May 15 and November 15 through November 15, 2024. The interest rate on the notes will vary beginning November 15, 2024, at a floating rate equal to the secured overnight financing rate, as determined quarterly on the determination date for the applicable interest period, plus 347 basis points.
On October 5, 2020, the Company completed the issuance and sale of $125,000 in aggregate principal amount of its 4.125% Fixed-to-Floating Rate Subordinated Debt due in 2030 (the “2020 Notes”). The 2020 Notes will bear interest: (i) from and including the date of issuance to, but excluding, October 15, 2025, at a rate of 4.125% per year and (ii) from and including October 15, 2025 to, but excluding, the maturity date (unless redeemed prior to such date), at a floating rate per year equal to the Benchmark (which is expected to be Three-Month Term Secured Overnight Funding Rate) plus 399.5 basis points. The Company has the right, subject to certain circumstances and the receipt of any required approval of the Federal Reserve Board, to redeem the 2020 Notes at the Company’s option, in whole or in part, on any interest payment date on or after October 15, 2025.The Company intends to use the net proceeds from the offering of 2020 Notes for general corporate purposes, including the potential repayment of outstanding indebtedness, and supporting capital levels of the Bank.

15. Income Taxes
The provision for income taxes is summarized as follows:
 Year Ended December 31,
 202020192018
Income tax expense (benefit):         
Current $23,587 $16,068 $8,189 
Deferred(9,384)9,053 2,707 
 $14,203 $25,121 $10,896 
 
F-44



The table below reconciles income tax expense for the years ended December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018 computed by applying the applicable U.S. federal statutory income tax rate, reconciled to the tax expense computed at the effective income tax rate:
 Year Ended  December 31, 
 202020192018
Federal incomes tax expense rate at 21% for December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018$18,498 $24,330 $10,550 
Bank-owned life insurance (407)(422)(124)
Non-deductible transaction costs— 308 727 
Tax exempt interest income(452)(391)(169)
Impact of IRS Settlement— (1,556)— 
Deferred tax true up (1,181)— — 
Deferred tax asset re-measurement due to the Tax Act— — 34 
162(m) Disallowance65 1,512 — 
State Taxes902 760 110 
Excess benefit on share-based compensation(1,435)205 (248)
Net Operating Loss ("NOL") Carryback(1,799)— — 
Other12 375 16 
Total income tax expense$14,203 $25,121 $10,896 
Effective tax rate16.1 %21.7 %21.7 %

Deferred income taxes reflect the net tax effects of temporary differences between the recorded amounts of assets and liabilities for financial reporting purposes, and the amounts used for income tax purposes. Significant components of the Company’s deferred tax assets and liabilities are as follows:
 December 31,
 20202019
Deferred tax assets:        
Allowance for credit losses$24,324 $6,232 
Equity compensation3,390 3,703 
Purchase premium/loan discounts2,945 9,347 
Lease liability3,276 2,960 
Purchase securities2,905 2,945 
Other3,901 3,930 
Total deferred tax assets40,741 29,117 
Deferred tax liabilities:
Intangibles11,911 13,527 
Bank premises and equipment4,036 4,811 
ROU asset3,124 2,773 
Net unrealized gain on available for sale debt securities and derivative instruments14,944 4,669 
Other2,063 1,904 
Total deferred tax liabilities36,078 27,684 
Net deferred tax asset$4,663 $1,433 
Included within other assets in the accompanying consolidated balance sheet as of December 31, 2020 is a current tax receivable of $25,520 and a deferred tax asset of $4,663. Additionally, included within accounts payable and accrued expenses in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets as of December 31, 2020 is a $270 current state tax payable. Included in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets as of December 31, 2019 is a current tax receivable of $10,403 and a net deferred
F-45



tax asset of $1,433 in other assets. Additionally, included within accounts payable and accrued expenses in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets as of December 31, 2019 is a $780 current state tax payable.
The following table provides a rollforward of the Company's gross federal and state unrecognized tax benefits for the years ending December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018. During the year ending December 31, 2020, the Company recorded an uncertain tax position liability for state nexus tax exposure of $549 in accounts payable and other liabilities in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets. During the year ending December 31, 2019, the Company recorded an uncertain tax position associated with the acquisition of Green and subsequently reached a settlement with the taxing authority.
December 31
202020192018
Unrecognized tax benefits at the beginning of the year:$— $— $— 
Gross increases, related to tax positions taken in a prior period281 2,155 — 
Gross increases, related to tax positions taken in current period268 — — 
Settlement with taxing authority— (2,155)— 
Unrecognized tax benefits at the end of the year$549 $— $— 
The Company has federal "NOL" carryforwards that are subject to a pre-tax limitation under Section 382 of approximately $3,055 as of December 31, 2020. The federal NOL carryforwards will expire with the 2031 tax year, if unused.

The Company files income tax returns in the U.S. federal jurisdiction and U.S. state jurisdictions. As of December 31, 2020, the Company is no longer subject to U.S. federal income tax examinations for tax years prior to 2017 and state income tax examinations for tax years prior to 2016.

16. Commitments and Contingencies
Litigation
The Company may from time to time be involved in legal actions arising from normal business activities. Management believes that these actions in which the Company or any of its subsidiaries is a defendant are without merit or that the ultimate liability, if any, resulting from them will not materially affect the financial position or results of operations of the Company.
Qualified Affordable Housing Investments
The Company invests in certain qualified affordable housing projects. At December 31, 2020 and 2019, the balance of the investments for qualified affordable housing projects was $2,899 and $3,292, respectively. This balance is reflected in other assets on the consolidated balance sheets. The total unfunded commitment related to the investments in a qualified housing project totaled $362 and $1,091 at December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively, which is reflected in accrued interest payable on the consolidated balance sheets. The Company expects to fulfill this commitment during the year ending 2034.
As of December 31, 2020, the expected future minimum commitment payments under the Company’s qualified affordable housing investments for each of the following five years were:
Year Ending December 31,Future Minimum Payments
2021$132 
202226 
202326 
202437 
202551 
Thereafter90 
Total$362 

F-46



Refer to Note 12 "Advances from the FHLB", Note 14 "Borrowed Funds" and Note 18 "Off-Balance Sheet Loan Commitments" for further discussion on commitments.

17. Fair Value Disclosures
The authoritative guidance for fair value measurements defines fair value as the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants. A fair value measurement assumes that the transaction to sell the asset or transfer the liability occurs in the principal market for the asset or liability or, in the absence of a principal market, the most advantageous market for the asset or liability. The price in the principal (or most advantageous) market used to measure the fair value of the asset or liability shall not be adjusted for transaction costs. An orderly transaction is a transaction that assumes exposure to the market for a period prior to the measurement date to allow for marketing activities that are usual and customary for transactions involving such assets and liabilities; it is not a forced transaction. Market participants are buyers and sellers in the principal market that are (i) independent, (ii) knowledgeable, (iii) able to transact and (iv) willing to transact.
The authoritative guidance requires the use of valuation techniques that are consistent with the market approach, the income approach and/or the cost approach. The market approach uses prices and other relevant information generated by market transactions involving identical or comparable assets and liabilities. The income approach uses valuation techniques to convert future amounts, such as cash flows or earnings, to a single present amount on a discounted basis. The cost approach is based on the amount that currently would be required to replace the service capacity of an asset (replacement costs). Valuation techniques should be consistently applied. Inputs to valuation techniques refer to the assumptions that market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability. Inputs may be observable, meaning those that reflect the assumptions market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability developed based on market data obtained from independent sources, or unobservable, meaning those that reflect the reporting entity’s own assumptions about the assumptions market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability developed based on the best information available in the circumstances. In that regard, the authoritative guidance establishes a fair value hierarchy for valuation inputs that gives the highest priority to quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities and the lowest priority to unobservable inputs. The fair value hierarchy is as follows:
Level 1 Inputs.  Unadjusted quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities that the reporting entity has the ability to access at the measurement date.
Level 2 Inputs.  Inputs other than quoted prices included in Level 1 that are observable for the asset or liability, either directly or indirectly. These include quoted prices for similar assets or liabilities in active markets, quoted prices for identical or similar assets or liabilities in markets that are not active, inputs other than quoted prices that are observable for the asset or liability (for example, interest rates, volatilities, prepayment speeds, loss severities, credit risks and default rates) or inputs that are derived principally from or corroborated by observable market data by correlation or other means. Level 2 investments consist primarily of obligations of U.S. government agencies, corporate bonds, municipal securities, mortgage-backed securities, collateralized mortgage obligations and asset-backed securities.
Level 3 Inputs.  Significant unobservable inputs that reflect an entity’s own assumptions that market participants would use in pricing the assets or liabilities.
In general, fair value is based upon quoted market prices, where available. If such quoted market prices are not available, fair value is based upon internally developed models that primarily use, as inputs, observable market-based parameters. Valuation adjustments may be made to ensure that financial instruments are recorded at fair value. While management believes the Company’s valuation methodologies are appropriate and consistent with other market participants, the use of different methodologies or assumptions to determine the fair value of certain financial instruments could result in a different estimate of fair value at the reporting date.
A description of the valuation methodologies used for instruments measured at fair value, as well as the general classification of such instruments pursuant to the valuation hierarchy, is set forth below.
Assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis include the following:
Available for Sale Debt Securities:  Debt securities classified as available for sale are reported at fair value utilizing Level 2 inputs. For those debt securities classified as Level 2, the Company obtains fair value measurements from an
F-47



independent pricing service. The fair value measurements consider observable data that may include dealer quotes, market spreads, cash flows, the U. S. Treasury yield curve, live trading levels, trade execution data for similar securities, market consensus prepayments speeds, credit information and the bond’s terms and conditions, among other things.

Equity Security With a Readily Determinable Fair Value: This investment represents our Community Reinvestment Act security which is reported at fair value utilizing a Level 1 input which includes a quoted price in an active market for the identical asset.

PPP Loans: The fair value of PPP loans is based on commitments from investors or prevailing market prices.
Loans Held for Sale: The fair value of government guaranteed loans held-for-sale is based on commitments from investors or prevailing market prices.
Derivative Financial Instruments: The fair value of correspondent interest rate swaps, customer interest rate swaps, correspondent interest rate caps and collars and commercial loan interest rate floors are derived from pricing models based on past, present and projected future market conditions, quoted market prices of instruments with similar characteristics or discounted cash flows, classified in Level 2 of the fair value hierarchy.

The following table summarizes assets measured at fair value on a recurring basis as of December 31, 2020 and 2019, segregated by the level of the valuation inputs within the fair value hierarchy utilized to measure fair value:
 December 31, 2020
 Level 1Level 2Level 3Total
 InputsInputsInputsFair Value
Financial Assets:
Available for sale debt securities$— $1,024,329 $— $1,024,329 
Equity securities with a readily determinable fair value11,363 — — 11,363 
PPP Loans— 358,042 — 358,042 
Loans held for sale (1)
— 6,681 — 6,681 
Interest rate swap designated as hedging instruments— 17,543 — 17,543 
Customer interest rate swaps not designated as hedging instruments— 10,937 — 10,937 
Correspondent interest rate caps and collars not designated as hedging instruments— — 
Financial Liabilities:
Interest rate swap designated as hedging instruments$— $2,255 $— $2,255 
Correspondent interest rate caps and collars not designated as hedging instruments— 11,666 — 11,666 
Customer interest rate swaps not designated as hedging instruments— — 
(1) Represents loans held for sale elected to be carried at fair value upon origination or acquisition.

F-48



December 31, 2019
Level 1Level 2Level 3Total
InputsInputsInputsFair Value
Financial Assets:
Available for sale debt securities$— $964,365 $— $964,365 
Equity securities with a readily determinable fair value11,122 — — 11,122 
Loans held for sale (1)
— 10,068 — 10,068 
Correspondent interest rate swaps— 105 — 105 
Customer interest rate swaps— 4,393 — 4,393 
Correspondent interest rate caps and collars— 11 — 11 
Commercial loan interest rate floor— 3,353 — 3,353 
Financial Liabilities:
Correspondent interest rate swaps$— $4,736 $— $4,736 
Customer interest rate swaps— 84 — 84 
Customer interest rate caps and collars— 11 — 11 
(1) Represents loans held for sale elected to be carried at fair value upon origination or acquisition.
There were no transfers between Level 2 and Level 3 during the years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019.
F-49



Certain assets, including collateral dependent loans with an ACL, servicing asset with a valuation allowance and other real estate owned are measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis; that is, the instruments are not measured at fair value on an ongoing basis but are subject to fair value adjustments in certain circumstances (for example, when there is evidence of impairment).
Collateral Dependent Loans with an ACL: A loan is considered collateral-dependent when the borrower is experiencing financial difficulty and repayment is expected to be provided substantially through the operation or sale of the collateral. The ACL is measured by estimating the fair value of the loan's underlying collateral. For real estate loans, fair value of the loan’s collateral is determined by third-party appraisals, which are then adjusted for the estimated selling and closing costs related to liquidation of the collateral. Appraisals for collateral dependent loans with an ACL are performed by certified general appraisers whose qualifications and licenses have been reviewed and verified by the Company. Once reviewed, a member of the credit department reviews the assumptions and approaches utilized in the appraisal as well as the overall resulting fair value in comparisons to independent data sources such as recent market data or industry wide-statistics. On a periodic basis, the Company compares the actual selling price of collateral that has been sold to the most recent appraised value to determine what additional adjustments, if any, should be made to the appraisal value to arrive at fair value.
Other Real Estate Owned with a Valuation Allowance: The Company records other real estate owned at fair value less estimated costs to sell at the date of foreclosure. After foreclosure, other real estate owned is carried at the lower of the initial carrying amount (fair value less estimated costs to sell or lease) and the value determined by subsequent appraisals or internal valuations of the other real estate owned. The Company outsources the valuation of other real estate owned with material balances to third-party appraisers. For this asset class, the actual valuation methods (income, sales comparable, or cost) vary based on the status of the project or property. The unobservable inputs may vary depending on the individual assets with no one of the three methods being the predominant approach. The Company reviews the third-party appraisal for appropriateness and adjusts the value to consider applicable selling and closing costs.
Servicing Assets with a Valuation Allowance: The fair value of the servicing asset is estimated using discounted cash flows based on current market interest rates. A valuation allowance is recorded when the fair value is below the carrying amount of the asset.
The following table summarizes assets measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis as of December 31, 2020 and 2019, segregated by the level of the valuation inputs within the fair value hierarchy utilized to measure fair value:
 Fair Value 
 Measurements Using 
 Level 1Level 2Level 3Total
 InputsInputsInputsFair Value
As of December 31, 2020                
Assets:    
Collateral dependent loans with an ACL
$— $— $2,386 $2,386 
Servicing assets with a valuation allowance— — 2,975 2,975 
As of December 31, 2019    
Assets:    
Impaired loans$— $— $4,504 $4,504 
Other real estate owned— — 5,995 5,995 
At December 31, 2020, collateral dependent loans with an ACL had a recorded investment of $7,115, with $4,729 specific allowance for credit loss allocated. At December 31, 2019, impaired loans with an allowance had a recorded investment of $4,504, with $1,602 specific allowance for credit loss allocated.
At December 31, 2020, servicing assets of $3,531 had a valuation allowance totaling $556.
Other real estate owned consisted of four properties recorded with a fair value of approximately $5,995 at December 31, 2019.
There were no liabilities measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis as of December 31, 2020 and 2019.
F-50



Fair Value of Financial Instruments
The Company is required under current authoritative guidance to disclose the estimated fair value of its financial instrument assets and liabilities, including those subject to the requirements discussed above. For the Company, as for most financial institutions, substantially all of its assets and liabilities are considered financial instruments, as defined in such guidance. Many of the Company’s financial instruments, however, lack an available trading market as characterized by a willing buyer and willing seller engaging in an exchange transaction.
The estimated fair value amounts of financial instruments have been determined by the Company using available market information and appropriate valuation methodologies. However, considerable judgment is required to interpret data to develop an estimate of fair value. Accordingly, the estimates presented herein are not necessarily indicative of the amounts the Company could realize in a current market exchange. The use of different market assumptions and/or valuation methodologies may have a material effect on the estimated fair value amounts. In addition, reasonable comparability between financial institutions may not be likely due to the wide range of permitted valuation techniques and numerous estimates that must be made given the absence of active secondary markets for many of the financial instruments. This lack of uniform valuation methodologies also introduces a greater degree of subjectivity to these estimated fair values.
The methods and assumptions used by the Company in estimating fair values of financial instruments as disclosed herein in accordance with ASC Topic 825, Financial Instruments, other than for those measured at fair value on a recurring and nonrecurring basis discussed above, are as follows:
Cash and cash equivalents:  The carrying amount of cash and cash equivalents approximates their fair value.
Held-to-maturity debt securities: The fair values of these debt securities is determined by matrix pricing, which is a mathematical technique widely used in the industry to value debt securities without relying exclusively on quoted prices for the specific securities but rather by relying on the securities' relationship to other benchmark quoted securities (Level 2 inputs).

Loans held for investment:  The fair value of loans held for investment, excluding previously presented collateral dependent loans with an ACL measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis, is estimated using a discounted cash flow analysis. The discount rates used to determine fair value use interest rate spreads that reflect factors such as liquidity, credit, and prepayment risk of the loans. Loans are considered a Level 3 financial asset.
Loans held for sale Loans held for sale, include mortgage loans, which are carried at the lower of cost or estimated fair value. The fair value for the mortgage loans approximate their carrying value and these loans are considered Level 2 financial assets.
Accrued interest receivable: The carrying amounts of accrued interest approximate their fair values due to short-term maturity.
Bank-owned life insurance:  The carrying amounts of bank-owned life insurance policies approximate their fair value.
Servicing Asset: Fair value is estimated by discounting estimated future cash flows from the servicing assets using discount rates that approximate current market rates over the expected lives of the loans being serviced. A valuation allowance is recorded when the fair value is below the carrying amount of the asset.
Equity securities without a readily determinable fair value: Certain equity securities are carried at cost as these securities did not have a readily determinable fair value. There were no observable price changes in orderly transactions for the identical or a similar investment of the same issuer as of December 31, 2020 and 2019.
FHLB and FRB stock:  FHLB and FRB stock are carried at cost basis due to restrictions placed on the transferability of these investments. As a result, the fair value of these investments was not practicable to determine.
Deposits:  The fair values disclosed for demand deposits are, by definition, equal to the amount payable on demand at the reporting date (that is, their carrying amounts). The carrying amounts of variable-rate certificates of deposit (“CDs”) approximate their fair values at the reporting date. Fair values for fixed-rate CDs are estimated using a discounted cash flow calculation that applies interest rates currently being offered on CDs to a schedule of aggregated expected monthly maturities on time deposits.
F-51



Advances from FHLB:  The fair value of advances maturing within 90 days approximates carrying value. Fair value of other advances is based on the Company’s current borrowing rate for similar arrangements.
Subordinated debentures and subordinated notes:  The fair values are based upon prevailing rates on similar debt in the marketplace.
Securities sold under agreement to repurchase: The carrying amount of securities sold under agreements to repurchase is a reasonable estimate of fair value because these borrowings reprice at market rates generally daily.
Off-balance sheet instruments:  Commitments to extend credit and standby letters of credit are generally priced at market at the time of funding and were not material to the Company’s consolidated financial statements.
F-52



The estimated fair values and carrying values of all financial instruments not measured at fair value on a recurring or non-recurring basis under current authoritative guidance as of December 31, 2020 and 2019 were as follows:
 Fair Value
 Carrying
AmountLevel 1Level 2Level 3
December 31, 2020
Financial assets:                
Cash and cash equivalents$230,825 $— $230,825 $— 
Held-to-maturity debt securities30,872 — 34,283 — 
Loans held for sale(1)
14,733 — 14,733 — 
Loans held for investment(2)
6,317,986 — — 6,335,402 
Accrued interest receivable23,798 — 23,798 — 
Bank-owned life insurance82,855 — 82,855 — 
Servicing asset388 — 486 — 
Equity securities without a readily determinable fair value3,575 N/AN/AN/A
FHLB and FRB stock71,236 N/AN/AN/A
Financial liabilities: 
Deposits$6,512,846 $— $6,608,849 $— 
Advances from FHLB777,718 — 782,321 — 
Accrued interest payable2,665 — 2,665 — 
Subordinated debentures and subordinated notes262,778 — 262,778 — 
Securities sold under agreement to repurchase2,225 — 2,199 — 
December 31, 2019
Financial assets:
Cash and cash equivalents$251,550 $— $251,550 $— 
Held-to-maturity debt securities32,965 — 34,810 — 
Loans held for sale(1)
4,012 — 4,012 — 
Loans held for investment(2)
5,921,205 — — 5,899,945 
Accrued interest receivable19,508 — 19,508 — 
Bank-owned life insurance80,915 — 80,915 — 
Servicing asset3,113 — 3,113 — 
Equity securities without readily determinable fair value3,575 N/AN/AN/A
FHLB and FRB stock68,348 N/AN/AN/A
Financial liabilities: 
Deposits$5,894,350 $— $5,692,217 $— 
Advances from FHLB677,870 — 708,692 — 
Accrued interest payable5,893 — 5,893 — 
Subordinated debentures and subordinated notes145,571 — 145,571 — 
Securities sold under agreement to repurchase2,353 — 2,353 — 
(1) Loans held for sale primarily represent mortgage loans held for sale that are carried at lower of cost or market.
(2) Loans held for investment includes MW and is carried at amortized cost.
F-53



18. Off-Balance Sheet Loan Commitments
The Company is a party to financial instruments with off-balance sheet risk in the normal course of business to meet the financing needs of its customers. These financial instruments include commitments to extend credit, mortgage warehouse commitments and standby letters of credit. Those instruments involve, to varying degrees, elements of credit risk in excess of the amount recognized in the consolidated balance sheets.
The Company’s exposure to credit loss in the event of nonperformance by the other party to a financial instrument for commitments to extend credit, mortgage warehouse commitments and standby letters of credit is represented by the contractual amount of those instruments. The Company uses the same credit policies in making commitments and conditional obligations as it does for on-balance sheet instruments.
The following table sets forth the approximate amounts of these financial instruments as of December 31, 2020 and 2019:
 December 31,
 20202019
Commitments to extend credit$2,743,571 $1,602,891 
Mortgage warehouse commitments354,603 347,459 
Standby and commercial letters of credit44,427 27,196 
 $3,142,601 $1,977,546 
Commitments to extend credit are agreements to lend to a customer as long as there is no violation of any condition established in the contract. Commitments generally have fixed expiration dates or other termination clauses and may require payment of a fee. Since many of the commitments may expire without being drawn upon, the total commitment amounts do not necessarily represent future cash requirements. Management evaluates each customer’s creditworthiness on a case-by-case basis and substantially all of the Company’s commitments to extend credit are contingent upon customers maintaining specific credit standards at the time of future loan funding. The amount of collateral obtained, if deemed necessary upon extension of credit, is based on management’s credit evaluation of the borrower.
Standby letters of credit are conditional commitments issued by the Company to guarantee the performance of a customer to a third party. Standby letters of credit generally have fixed expiration dates or other termination clauses and may require payment of a fee. The credit risk involved in issuing letters of credit is essentially the same as that involved in extending loan facilities to customers. The Company’s policy for obtaining collateral and the nature of such collateral is essentially the same as that involved in making commitments to extend credit.
Mortgage warehouse commitments are unconditionally cancellable and represent the unused capacity on mortgage warehouse facilities the Company has approved. The Company reserves the right to refuse to buy any mortgage loans offered for sale by a customer, for any reason, at the Company’s sole and absolute discretion.
The table below presents the activity in the allowance for unfunded commitment credit losses related to those financial instruments discussed above. This allowance is recorded in accounts payable and other liabilities on the Consolidated Balance Sheets:

 December 31,
 20202019
Beginning balance for allowance for credit losses on unfunded commitments$878 $878 
Impact of CECL adoption840 — 
Provision for credit losses on unfunded commitments9,029 — 
Ending balance of allowance for credit losses on unfunded commitments$10,747 $878 


F-54



19. Derivative Financial Instruments

The Company primarily uses derivatives to manage exposure to market risk, including interest rate risk and credit risk and to assist customers with their risk management objectives. Management will designate certain derivatives as hedging instruments in a qualifying hedge accounting relationship. The Company’s remaining derivatives consist of derivatives held for customer accommodation or other purposes.

The fair value of derivative positions outstanding is included in other assets and accounts payable and other liabilities on the accompanying consolidated balance sheets and in the net change in each of these financial statement line items in the accompanying Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows. For derivatives not designated as hedging instruments, swap fee income and gains and losses due to changes in fair value are included in noninterest income and the operating section of the Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows. For derivatives designated as hedging instruments, the entire change in the fair value related to the derivative instrument is recognized as a component of other comprehensive income and subsequently reclassified into interest income when the forecasted transaction affects income. The notional amounts and estimated fair values as of December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019 were as shown in the table below.


December 31, 2020December 31, 2019
Estimated Fair ValueEstimated Fair Value
Notional AmountAsset DerivativeLiability DerivativeNotional AmountAsset DerivativeLiability Derivative
Derivatives designated as hedging instruments (cash flow hedges):
Interest rate swap on borrowing advances$500,000 $17,543 $— $— $— $— 
Interest rate swap on money market deposit account payments250,000 — 2,255 — — — 
Commercial loan interest rate floor— — — 275,000 3,353 — 
Total derivatives designated as hedging instruments$750,000 $17,543 $2,255 275,000 3,353 — 
Derivatives not designated as hedging instruments:
Financial institution counterparty:
Interest rate swaps$303,918 $— $11,666 $222,394 $105 $4,736 
Interest rate caps and collars41,916 — 90,093 11 — 
Commercial customer counterparty:
Interest rate swaps303,918 10,937 — 222,394 4,393 84 
Interest rate caps and collars41,916 — 90,093 — 11 
Total derivatives not designated as hedging instruments$691,668 $10,938 $11,667 $624,974 $4,509 $4,831 
Offsetting derivative assets/liabilities(2,895)(2,895)
Total derivatives$1,441,668 $28,482 $13,923 $899,974 $4,967 $1,936 

F-55



Pre-tax gain (loss) included in the Consolidated Statements of Income and related to derivative instruments for the years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019 was as follows:


For the Year Ended December 31, 2020For the Year Ended December 31, 2019
Net gain (loss) recognized in other comprehensive income on derivativeGain (loss) reclassified from accumulated other comprehensive income into incomeLocation of gain (loss) reclassified from accumulated other comprehensive income into incomeNet gain (loss) recognized in other comprehensive income on derivativeGain (loss) reclassified from accumulated other comprehensive income into incomeLocation of gain (loss) reclassified from accumulated other comprehensive income into income
Derivatives designated as hedging instruments (cash flow hedges):
Interest rate swap on borrowing advances$13,859 $— Interest Expense$— $— Interest Expense
Interest rate swap on money market deposit account payments(1,781)(605)Interest Expense— — Interest Expense
Commercial loan interest rate floors(813)1,937 Interest Income1,497 (808)Interest Income
Total$11,265 $1,332 $1,497 $(808)
Net Gain recognized in other noninterest incomeLoss recognized in other noninterest income
Derivatives not designated as hedging instruments:
Interest rate swaps, caps and collars$2,481 $550 

Cash Flow Hedges

Cash flow hedge relationships mitigate exposure to the variability of future cash flows or other forecasted transactions. The Company uses interest rate swaps, floors, caps and collars to manage overall cash flow changes related to interest rate risk exposure on benchmark interest rate loans.

In March 2020, the Company entered into an interest rate swap for a notional amount of $500,000 to hedge the variability of cash flow payments attributable to changes in interest rates in regards to forecasted issuances of three-month term debt arrangements every three months from March 2022 through March 2032. These forecasted borrowings can be sourced from an FHLB advance, repurchase agreement, brokered certificate of deposit or some combination of the foregoing.

In March 2020, the Company entered into an interest rate swap for a notional amount of $250,000 to hedge the variability of cash flow payments attributable to changes in interest rates in regards to forecasted money market account borrowings from March 2020 through March 2025.

In May 2019, the Company entered into a $275,000 notional interest rate floor for commercial loans with a two-year term. The interest rate floor had a purchased floor strike of 2.43%. In February 2020, the Company terminated this interest rate floor. The gain resulting from the termination of the interest rate floor will remain in other comprehensive income (loss) and will be accreted into earnings over the remaining period of the former hedging relationship unless the forecasted transaction becomes probable of not occurring.
F-56



Interest Rate Swap, Floor, Cap and Collar Agreements Not Designated as Hedging Derivatives

In order to accommodate the borrowing needs of certain commercial customers, the Company has entered into interest rate swap or cap agreements with those customers. These interest rate derivative contracts effectively allow the Company’s customers to convert a variable rate loan into a fixed rate loan. In order to offset the exposure and manage interest rate risk, at the time an agreement was entered into with a customer, the Company entered into an interest rate swap or cap with a correspondent bank counterparty with offsetting terms. These derivative instruments are not designated as accounting hedges and changes in the net fair value are recognized in noninterest income or expense. Because the Company acts as an intermediary for its customers, changes in the fair value of the underlying derivative contracts substantially offset each other and do not have a material impact on the Company’s results of operations. The fair value amounts are included in other assets and other liabilities.

The following is a summary of the interest rate swaps outstanding as of December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019.

December 31, 2020
Notional AmountFixed RateFloating RateMaturityFair Value
Non-hedging derivative instruments:
Customer interest rate derivative:
Interest rate swaps - receive fixed/pay floating$303,918 
3.14% - 8.470%
LIBOR 1 month + —% - 5.00%
PRIME H15 - 25
Wtd. Avg.
4.1 years
$(11,666)
Interest rate caps and collars$41,916 
2.500% / 3.000%
LIBOR 1 month + —%
Wtd. Avg.
1.6 years
$
Correspondent interest rate derivative:
Interest rate swaps - pay fixed/receive floating$303,918 
3.14% - 8.470%
LIBOR 1 month + —% - 5.00%
PRIME H15 - 25
Wtd. Avg.
4.1 years
$10,937 
Interest rate caps and collars$41,916 
3.000% / 5.000%
LIBOR 1 month + —% - 2.5%
Wtd. Avg.
1.6 years
$(1)

December 31, 2019
Notional AmountFixed RateFloating RateMaturityFair Value
Non-hedging derivative instruments:
Customer interest rate derivative:
Interest rate swaps - receive fixed/pay floating$222,394 
2.944% - 8.470%
LIBOR 1 month + —% - 5.00%
PRIME H15 - 25
Wtd. Avg.
3.3 years
$(4,632)
Interest rate caps and collars$90,093 
2.430% / 5.800%
LIBOR 1 month + —% - 3.75%
Wtd. Avg.
1.5 years
$11 
Correspondent interest rate derivative:
Interest rate swaps - pay fixed/receive floating$222,394 
2.944% - 8.470%
LIBOR 1 month + —% - 5.00%
PRIME H15 - 25
Wtd. Avg.
3.3 years
$4,309 
Interest rate caps and collars$90,093 
3.000% / 5.800%
LIBOR 1 month + — - 3.75%
Wtd. Avg.
1.5 years
$(11)

F-57




20. Employee Benefits
 
Defined Contribution Plan
 
The Company maintains a retirement savings 401(k) profit sharing plan (the “Plan”) in which substantially all employees may participate. The Plan allows employees to make discretionary “before tax” contributions through salary reductions under section 401(k) of the Internal Revenue Code. The Company may make a discretionary match of employees’ contributions based on a percentage of salary deferrals and certain discretionary profit sharing contributions. For the year ended December 31, 2020 and 2019, the company made matching contributions of $3,210 and $2,896, respectively.

Employee Stock Ownership Plan ("ESOP")

Effective January 1, 2012, the Company adopted the ESOP, which covered substantially all employees (subject to certain exclusions). The Company ceased making new contributions to the ESOP effective January 1, 2019 and approved an amendment to terminate the ESOP effective on June 30, 2019. During the year ended December 31, 2020, the Company received an IRS determination letter approving a liquidation of the ESOP. As of December 31, 2020, the Company had not yet liquidated the ESOP assets.

There was no compensation expense attributed to the ESOP for the years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019. Compensation expense attributed to ESOP contributions recorded in the accompanying consolidated statements of income for the year ended December 31, 2018 was approximately $863.
 
21. Stock and Incentive Plans
2010 Stock Option and Equity Incentive Plan
In 2010, the Company adopted the 2010 Stock Option and Equity Incentive Plan (the “2010 Incentive Plan”), which the Company’s shareholders approved in 2011. The maximum number of shares of common stock that may be issued pursuant to grants or options under the 2010 Incentive Plan is 1,000,000. The 2010 Incentive Plan is administered by the Board and provides for both the direct award of stock and the grant of stock options to eligible directors, officers, employees and outside consultants of the Company or its affiliates as defined in the 2010 Incentive Plan. The Company may grant either incentive stock options or nonqualified stock options as directed in the 2010 Incentive Plan.
The Board authorized grants of equity awards under the 2010 Incentive Plan consisting of 100,000 shares of direct stock awards (restricted shares) and 900,000 shares of stock options, of which 500,000 shares are or were performance-based stock options. Options were generally granted with an exercise price equal to the market price of the Company’s stock as of the date of the grant. In general, the terms of awards varied depending on whether a participant was a shareholder owning more than 10% of the total combined voting power of all classes of Company stock (a “controlling participant”). Options granted to non-controlling participants generally vested after 5 years of continuous service, with 10-year contractual terms, and forfeiture of unexercised options upon termination of employment with the Company. Other grant terms varied for controlling participants. Restricted share awards generally vested after 4 years of continuous service. The terms of the 2010 Incentive Plan provide that all unearned non-performance options and restricted shares become immediately exercisable and fully vested upon a change in control.
During the years ending December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018, the Company did not award any restricted stock units, non-performance based stock options or performance-based stock options or other awards under the 2010 Incentive Plan.
Stock based compensation expense is measured based upon the fair market value of the award at the grant date and is recognized ratably over the period during which the shares are earned (the requisite service period). For the year ended December 31, 2020, there was no stock compensation expense related to the 2010 Incentive Plan. For the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018, approximately $3 and $27 of stock compensation expense related to the 2010 Incentive Plan, respectively, was recognized in the accompanying consolidated statements of income.
F-58



A summary of the status of options granted under the 2010 Incentive Plan at December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018 and changes during the years then ended is presented below:
2010 Incentive Plan
 Nonperformance-based stock options
 Shares
Underlying
Options
Weighted Average Exercise
Price
Weighted
Average Remaining
Contractual
Term
Aggregate Intrinsic Value
Outstanding at December 31, 2017305,000 $10.16 3.59 years
Exercised(30,000)10.61 
Outstanding at December 31, 2018275,000 $10.12 2.39 years
Exercised(17,500)10.24 
Outstanding at December 31, 2019257,500 $10.28 1.37 years
Exercised(237,500)10.12  
Outstanding and exercisable at December 31, 202020,000 $10.09 1.06 years$374 
As of December 31, 2020 and 2019, there was no unrecognized stock compensation expense related to non-performance based stock options. As of December 31, 2018, there was approximately $3 of unrecognized compensation expense related to non-performance-based stock options.
A summary of the status of the restricted stock units under the 2010 Incentive Plan as of December 31, 2020, 2019, and 2018 and changes during the years is presented below:
2010 Incentive Plan
 Nonperformance-based restricted stock units
 Shares
Underlying
Options
Weighted Average Exercise
Price
Outstanding at December 31, 201724,250 $13.19 
Forfeited(500)10.85 
Vested into shares(23,750)12.14 
Outstanding at December 31, 2018— $— 
Outstanding at December 31, 2019— — 
Outstanding at December 31, 2020— $— 
As of December 31, 2020, 2019, and 2018, there was no remaining unrecognized compensation expense related to non-vested restricted stock units.
F-59



A summary of the fair value of the Company’s stock options exercised and restricted stock units vested under the 2010 Incentive Plan as of December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018 is presented below:
 Fair Value of Options Exercised or Restricted Stock Units Vested as of December 31,
 202020192018
Nonperformance-based stock options exercised$6,579 $454 $803 
Nonperformance-based restricted stock units vested— — 713 
2019 Amended Plan and Green Acquired Omnibus Plans
2020 Grants of Restricted Stock Units

    In the year ended December 31, 2020, the Company granted non-performance-based and performance-based restricted stock units (“RSUs”) under the 2019 Amended and Restated Omnibus Incentive Plan, which amended and restated the 2014 Omnibus Incentive Plan (“2019 Amended Plan”), and the Veritex (Green) 2014 Omnibus Equity Incentive Plan (“Veritex (Green) 2014 Plan”). The majority of the non-performance-based RSUs granted to employees during the year ended December 31, 2020 vest after three or five equal installments on each anniversary of the grant date. There were also non-performance-based restricted stock units granted with no vesting conditions on the grant date.

    The performance-based RSUs granted in January 2020 are subject to “cliff” vesting, with a vesting date of January 1, 2023, based on a performance period starting on December 31, 2019 and ending on December 31, 2022. The vesting percentage is determined based on the Company’s total shareholder return (“TSR”) relative to the TSR of 15 peer companies (“Peer Group”) over the performance period. Below is a table showing the range of vesting percentages for the performance-based RSUs based on the Company’s TSR percentile rank.

Vesting %
Below the 24.9th percentile of Peer Group TSR
— %
Within the 25th to 49.9th percentile of Peer Group TSR
50 %
Within the 50th to 74.9th percentile of Peer Group TSR
100 %
At or above the 75th percentile of Peer Group TSR
150 %

A Monte Carlo simulation was used to estimate the fair value of performance-based RSUs on the grant date that include a market condition based on the Company’s TSR relative to its Peer Group, which determines the eligible number of RSUs to vest.

2020 Grant of Stock Options
    In January 2020, the Company granted non-performance-based options under the 2019 Amended Plan and the Veritex (Green) 2014 Plan, which vest over three equal installments on each anniversary of the grant date.
The fair value of each option award is estimated on the grant date using the Black-Scholes option-pricing model with the following assumptions used for the grants:

 
 For the Year Ended December 31,
 202020192018
Dividend yield
2.33% to 5.14%
1.73% to 2.01%
—%
Expected life
5.00 to 6.51 years
4.52 to 7.51 years
5.00 to 7.50 years
Expected volatility
27.49% to 42.37%
28.85% to 29.65%
27.87% to 37.55%
Risk-free interest rate
0.36% to 1.76%
1.53% to 2.51%
1.06% to 2.94%

 

F-60



The expected life is based on the amount of time that options being valued are expected to remain outstanding. The expected volatility is based on historical volatility of the Company. The dividend yield assumption is based on the Company’s dividend history. The risk-free interest rates are based upon yields of U.S. Treasury issues with a term equal to the expected life of the option being valued.
Stock Compensation Expense and Liability Award Compensation Expense
Stock compensation expense for equity awards under the 2019 Amended Plan was approximately $6,080 and $3,044 for the years ended December 31, 2020, 2019, respectively.
Stock compensation expense for options and restricted stock unit awards granted under the Veritex (Green) 2014 Plan was approximately $1,903 and $1,525 for the year ended December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively.
There was no compensation expense for liability-classified awards sunder the 2019 Amended Plan during the year ended December 31, 2020. There was $1,403 of compensation expense for liability-classified awards under the 2019 Amended Plan during the year December 31, 2019.
On May 22, 2019, the shareholders of the Company approved a proposal to approve the 2019 Amended and Restated Omnibus Incentive Plan, which amended and restated our 2014 Omnibus Incentive Plan (the "Equity Plan"). The Equity Plan has two complementary purposes: (i) to attract and retain talented individuals to serve as officers, employees, directors and service providers; and (ii) to increase shareholder value by aligning the interests of our officers, employees, directors and service providers with the long-term interests of our company and our shareholders. The Equity Plan offers eligible officers, employees, directors and service providers the opportunity to acquire shares of our common stock, or receive monetary payments, on the potentially favorable terms provided by the Equity Plan. The Equity Plan is administered by the Compensation Committee of the Board. The maximum number of shares of the Company’s common stock that may be issued pursuant to grants or options under the Equity Plan is 1,500,000.
 
2019 Amended Plan

A summary of the status of the Company’s stock options under the 2019 Amended Plan as of December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018, and changes during the years then ended, is as follows:

F-61



 2019 Amended Plan
 Nonperformance-based stock options
Equity AwardsLiability Awards
 Shares
Underlying
Options
Weighted Average Exercise
Price
Weighted
Average Remaining
Contractual
Term
Aggregate Intrinsic ValueShares
Underlying
Options
Weighted Average Exercise
Price
Weighted
Average Remaining
Contractual
Term
Aggregate Intrinsic Value
Outstanding at December 31, 2017330,723 $22.71 8.86 years— — — 
Granted137,576 28.04 — — 
Forfeited(4,083)27.59 — — 
Exercised(14,696)15.29 — — 
Outstanding at December 31, 2018449,520 $24.47 8.24 years— $— — 
Granted200,561 22.72 253,633 21.38 
Conversion to equity awards253,633 21.38 (253,633)21.38 
Forfeited(41,336)25.51 — — 
Exercised(12,610)15.42 — — 
Outstanding at December 31, 2019849,768 $23.61 8.24 years— — — 
Granted185,025 26.73  — — 
Forfeited(25,053)27.37  — — 
Exercised(33,939)19.10  — 
Outstanding at December 31, 2020975,801 $24.26 7.45 years$2,422 — — — $— 
Options exercisable at December 31, 2020491,704 $24.25 6.40 years$1,199 — — — $— 
Weighted average fair value of options granted during the period $6.37  $— 

As of December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018 there was $2,470, $2,948 and $2,103 of total unrecognized compensation expense related to stock options awarded under the 2019 Amended Plan, respectively. As of December 31, 2020, there was no unrecognized compensation expense related to liability options awarded under the 2019 Amended Plan. The unrecognized compensation expense at December 31, 2020 is expected to be recognized over the remaining weighted average requisite service period of 2.65 years.

A summary of the status of the Company’s non-performance based restricted stock units under the 2019 Amended Plan as of December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018, and changes during the year then ended is as follows:

F-62



 2019 Amended Plan
Nonperformance-based restricted stock units
Equity AwardsLiability Awards
 UnitsWeighted
Average
Grant Date
Fair Value
UnitsWeighted
Average
Grant Date
Fair Value
Outstanding at December 31, 2017150,722 $13.29 — $— 
Granted60,650 29.27 — — 
Vested into shares(73,988)24.44 — — 
Forfeited(3,929)26.29 — — 
Outstanding at December 31, 2018133,455 $19.67 — $— 
Granted127,459 22.44 165,739 21.38 
Conversion to equity awards165,739 21.38 (165,739)21.38 
Vested into shares(250,965)22.29 — 
Outstanding at December 31, 2019175,688 $21.65 $— 
Granted360,400 20.38 — 
Vested into shares(93,377)24.73 — 
Forfeited(1,579)29.13 — 
Outstanding at December 31, 2020441,132 $20.39 $— 

A summary of the status of the Company’s performance based restricted stock units under the 2019 Amended Plan as of December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018, and changes during the years then ended is as follows:


 2019 Amended Plan
Performance-based restricted stock units
Equity AwardsLiability Awards
 UnitsWeighted
Average
Grant Date
Fair Value
UnitsWeighted
Average
Grant Date
Fair Value
Outstanding at December 31, 201753,594 $17.68 — $— 
Granted40,269 27.59 — — 
Vested into shares(28,109)18.69 — — 
Forfeited(1,766)27.59 — — 
Outstanding at December 31, 201863,988 $21.28 — $— 
Granted38,746 22.53 32,249 21.38 
Conversion to equity awards32,249 21.38 (32,249)21.38 
Vested into shares(51,284)25.31 — 
Forfeited(19,972)21.38 — — 
Outstanding at December 31, 201963,727 $22.76 — $— 
Granted39,398 25.94 — 
Vested into shares(1,841)19.69 — — 
Forfeited(1,089)19.69 — — 
Outstanding at December 31, 2020100,195 $23.20 — $— 

As of December 31, 2020, 2019, and 2018 there was $8,222, $4,329 and $3,430 of total unrecognized compensation expense related to restricted stock units awarded under the 2019 Amended Plan, respectively. As of December 31, 2020, there was no unrecognized compensation related to liability restricted stock units awarded under the 2019 Amended Plan. The unrecognized compensation expense at December 31, 2020 is expected to be recognized over the remaining weighted average requisite service period of 2.61 years.
F-63




A summary of the fair value of the Company’s stock options exercised and restricted stock units vested under the 2019 Amended Plan as of December 31, 2020, 2019 and 2018 is presented below:
 Fair Value of Options Exercised or Restricted Stock Units Vested as of December 31,
 202020192018
Nonperformance-based stock options exercised$954 334 383 
Nonperformance-based restricted stock units vested2,529 6,113 2,128 
Performance-based restricted stock units vested36 1,089 745 

Veritex (Green) 2014 Plan

A summary of the status of the Company’s stock options under the Veritex (Green) 2014 Plan as of December 31, 2020 and 2019 changes during the years then ended is as follows:
Veritex (Green) 2014 Plan
Non-performance Based Stock Options
Shares
Underlying
Options
Weighted
Exercise
Price
Weighted
Average
Contractual
Term
Aggregate Intrinsic Value
Outstanding at January 1, 2019$— 
Converted in acquisition of Green304,77815.41 
Granted211,79321.38 
Forfeited(12,673)13.17 
Exercised(116,929)13.60 
Outstanding at December 31, 2019386,96919.30 
Granted31,07529.13 
Forfeited(30,711)20.92 
Exercised(35,333)19.42 
Outstanding at December 31, 2020352,000$19.99 6.97 years$2,124
Options exercisable at December 31, 2020209,844$17.89 6.11 years$1,642
Weighted average fair value of options granted during the period$9.56 

As of December 31, 2020 and 2019, there was $626 and $1,062, respectively, of total unrecognized compensation expense related to options awarded under the Veritex (Green) 2014 Plan. The unrecognized compensation expense at December 31, 2020 is expected to be recognized over the remaining weighted average requisite service period of 2.13 years.
F-64



A summary of the status of the Company’s non-performance-based restricted stock units under the Veritex (Green) 2014 Plan as of December 31, 2020 and 2019 and changes during the years then ended, is as follows:

Veritex (Green) 2014 Plan
Non-performance Based Restricted Stock Units
UnitsWeighted Average Grant Date Fair Value
Outstanding at January 1, 2019$— 
Granted116,25021.38 
Outstanding at December 31, 2019116,25021.38 
Granted93,91821.36 
Vested into shares(38,744)21.38 
Forfeited(15,237)23.62 
Outstanding at December 31, 2020156,187$22.64 

A summary of the status of the Company’s performance-based restricted stock units under the Veritex (Green) 2014 Plan as of December 31, 2020 and 2019 and changes during the years then ended, is as follows:

Veritex (Green) 2014 Plan
Performance Based Restricted Stock Units
UnitsWeighted Average Grant Date Fair Value
Outstanding at January 1, 2019$— 
Granted26,14521.38 
Forfeited(825)21.38 
Outstanding at December 31, 201925,320$21.38 
Granted8,53125.94
Forfeited(3,123)19.69
Outstanding at December 31, 202030,728$21.43 

As of December 31, 2020 and 2019, there was $2,484 and $1,991, respectively, of total unrecognized compensation related to outstanding restricted stock units awarded under the Veritex (Green) 2014 Plan to be recognized over a remaining weighted average requisite service period of 2.02 years.
    A summary of the fair value of the Company’s stock options exercised and restricted stock units vested under the Veritex (Green) 2014 Plan during the year ended December 31, 2020 and 2019 is presented below:

Fair Value of Options Exercised or Restricted Stock Units Vested in the year ended December 31,
20202019
Non-performance-based stock options exercised$1,021 $3,054 
Non-performance-based restricted stock units vested828— 

F-65



Green Bancorp Inc. 2010 Stock Option Plan and Green Bancorp Inc. 2006 Stock Option Plan

    In addition to the Veritex (Green) 2014 Plan discussed earlier in this Note, the Company assumed two stock and incentive plans in the Green acquisition, the Green Bancorp Inc. 2010 Stock Option Plan (“Green 2010 Plan”) and the Green Bancorp Inc. 2006 Stock Option Plan (“Green 2006 Plan”).
A summary of the status of the Company’s non-performance-based restricted stock units under the Green 2010 Plan as of December 31, 2020 and 2019 and changes during the years then ended, is as follows:


Green 2010 Plan
Non-performance Based Stock Options
Shares
Underlying
Options
Weighted
Exercise
Price
Weighted
Average
Contractual
Term
Aggregate Intrinsic Value
Outstanding at January 1, 2019$— 
Converted in acquisition of Green768,62810.73 
Forfeited(6,241)13.69 
Exercised(190,652)10.93 
Outstanding at December 31, 2019571,73510.64 
Exercised(440,652)10.35 
Outstanding and exercisable at December 31, 2020131,083$11.60 4.90 years$1,843
As of December 31, 2020 and 2019, there was no unrecognized compensation expense related to options awarded under the Green 2010 Plan.
A summary of the fair value of the Company’s stock options exercised under the Green 2010 Plan during the year ended December 31, 2020 and 2019 is presented below:
Fair Value of Options Exercised in the year ended December 31,
20202019
Non-performance-based stock options exercised$12,231 $5,554 

F-66



A summary of the status of the Company’s non-performance-based restricted stock units under the Green 2006 Plan as of December 31, 2020 and 2019 and changes during the years then ended, is as follows:
Green 2006 Plan
Non-performance Based Stock Options
Shares
Underlying
Options
Weighted
Exercise
Price
Weighted
Average
Contractual
Term
Aggregate Intrinsic Value
Outstanding at January 1, 2019$— 
Converted in acquisition of Green11,85010.45 
Exercised(11,850)10.45 
Outstanding at December 31, 2019 and 2020— 
As of December 31, 2020 and 2019, there was no unrecognized compensation expense related to options awarded under the Green 2006 Plan.
A summary of the fair value of the Company’s stock options exercised under the Green 2006 Plan during the year ended December 31, 2020 and 2019 is presented below:
Fair Value of Options Exercised in the year ended December 31,
20202019
Non-performance-based stock options exercised$— $345 


22. Significant Concentrations of Credit Risk
Most of the Company’s business activity is with customers located within the Dallas-Fort Worth metroplex and Houston metropolitan area. Such customers are normally also depositors of the Company.
The distribution of commitments to extend credit approximates the distribution of loans outstanding. The Company has a diversified loan portfolio, however a significant portion of the Company's loans are collateralized by real estate. Repayment of these loans is in part dependent upon the economic conditions in the market area.
The contractual amounts of credit related financial instruments such as commitments to extend credit, MW commitments, credit card arrangements, and letters of credit represent the amounts of potential accounting loss should the contract be fully drawn upon, the customer default, and the value of any existing collateral become worthless.

23. Related Party Transactions
In the ordinary course of business, the Company has and expects to continue to have transactions, including borrowings, with its employees, officers, directors and their affiliates. These loans are on substantially the same terms, including interest rates and collateral, as those prevailing at the time for comparable transactions with other unaffiliated persons and do not involve more than normal risk of collectability. The aggregate amounts of such loans were approximately $34,944 and $70,113 as of December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively. During the year ended December 31, 2020, new advances of approximately $12,477 were made to related parties with approximately $19,991 principal payments received. During the year ended December 31, 2019, new advances of approximately $42,163 were made to related parties with approximately $42,398 principal payments received. There were $13,191 and $17,180 in unfunded commitments to related parties as of December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively. At December 31, 2020, there were no loans to employees, officers, directors or their affiliates that were considered non-performing or potentially problem loans.
Deposits received from related parties as of December 31, 2020 and 2019 totaled approximately $506,068 and $70,986, respectively.
F-67




24. Capital Requirements and Restrictions on Retained Earnings
Under applicable U.S. banking laws, there are legal restrictions limiting the amount of dividends the Company can declare. Approval of the regulatory authorities is required if, among other things, the effect of the dividends declared would cause regulatory capital of the Company to fall below specified minimum levels.

The Company on a consolidated basis and the Bank are subject to various regulatory capital requirements administered by federal banking agencies. Failure to meet minimum capital requirements triggers certain mandatory and may lead to additional discretionary actions by regulators that, if undertaken, could have a direct material effect on the Company’s financial statements. Under capital adequacy guidelines and the regulatory framework for prompt corrective action, the Bank must meet specific capital guidelines that involve quantitative measures of the Bank’s assets, liabilities, and, if the Bank were not eligible for or did not opt into the Community Bank Leverage Ratio (“CBLR”) framework, certain off-balance sheet items as calculated under regulatory accounting practices. If the Company were not eligible for or did not opt into the CBLR framework, its capital amounts and classification would also be subject to qualitative judgments by the regulators about components of capital, risk weightings of assets, and other factors.

Under the Economic Growth, Regulatory Reform, and Consumer Protection Act (“EGRRCPA”) and implementing regulations of the federal banking agencies, certain banking organizations with less than $10 billion in assets may elect to satisfy a single CBLR of Tier 1 capital to average total consolidated assets in lieu of the generally applicable capital requirements of the capital rules implementing Basel III. We have elected to use the CBLR framework. Accordingly, if we and the Bank continue to meet all requirements under this framework, we and the Bank will not be required to report or calculate risk-based capital, and the Bank will be considered to have met the well-capitalized ratio requirements under Prompt Corrective Action (“PCA”) regulations. The federal banking agencies have finalized the CBLR minimum at 9% and we and the Bank exceed this standard. The U.S. Coronavirus Aid, Relief, and Economic Security Act (“CARES Act”), enacted March 27, 2020, temporarily reduced the CBLR to 8% until the earlier of December 31, 2020 or the expiration of the national emergency declaration, and rules issued by the federal banking agencies provide a graduated transition back to the 9% threshold by January 1, 2022.

If we were not eligible for or did not opt into the CBLR framework, we would be subject to other quantitative measures established by regulation to ensure capital adequacy. These generally applicable capital requirements require a banking organization that does not operate under the CBLR framework to maintain minimum amounts and ratios (set forth in the table below) of total Tier 1, and common equity Tier 1 capital (as defined in the regulations) to risk-weighted assets (as defined), and of Tier 1 capital (as defined) to average assets (as defined). Additionally, to be categorized as “well capitalized,” a banking organization that does not operate under the CBLR framework is required to maintain minimum total risk-based common equity Tier 1, Tier 1, and total capital ratios and Tier 1 leverage ratios as set forth in the table below.

As of December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019, the Company’s and the Bank’s capital ratios exceeded those levels necessary to be categorized as “well capitalized” if the Company and the Bank were not operating under the CBLR framework. There are no conditions or events since December 31, 2020 that management believes have changed the Company’s category.

In the first quarter of 2020, U.S. federal regulatory authorities issued an interim final rule that provides banking organizations that adopt CECL during the 2020 calendar year with the option to delay for two years the estimated impact of CECL on regulatory capital relative to regulatory capital determined under the prior incurred loss methodology, followed by a three-year transition period to phase out the aggregate amount of the capital benefit provided during the initial two-year delay (i.e., a five-year transition in total). In connection with our adoption of CECL on January 1, 2020, the Company elected to utilize the five-year CECL transition. As a result, the effects of CECL on the Company's and the Bank’s regulatory capital will be delayed through the year 2021, after which the effects will be phased-in over a three-year period from January 1, 2022 through December 31, 2024.

A comparison of the Company’s and Bank’s actual capital amounts and ratios to capital amounts and ratios that would be required if the Company and Bank were not operating under the CBLR framework is presented in the following table:
F-68



 Actual For Capital 
Adequacy Purposes
 To Be Well
Capitalized Under
Prompt Corrective
Action Provisions
 AmountRatio Amount Ratio Amount Ratio
As of December 31, 2020                                        
Total capital (to risk-weighted assets)          
Company$1,099,031 13.57 %$647,918 8.0 %n/an/a
Bank968,481 11.96 647,813 8.0 $809,767 10.0 %
Tier 1 capital (to risk-weighted assets)
Company782,487 9.66 486,017 6.0 n/an/a
Bank884,471 10.92 485,973 6.0 647,964 8.0 
Common equity tier 1 (to risk-weighted assets)
Company753,261 9.30 364,481 4.5 n/an/a
Bank884,471 10.92 364,480 4.5 526,471 6.5 
Tier 1 capital (to average assets)
Company782,487 9.43 331,914 4.0 n/an/a
Bank884,471 10.66 331,884 4.0 414,855 5.0 
As of December 31, 2019
Total capital (to risk-weighted assets)
Company$917,939 13.10 %$560,573 8.0 %n/an/a
Bank870,838 12.44 560,024 8.0 $700,031 10.0 %
Tier 1 capital (to risk-weighted assets)
Company771,679 11.02 420,152 6.0 n/an/a
Bank840,126 12.00 420,063 6.0 560,084 8.0 
Common equity tier 1 (to risk-weighted assets)
Company742,675 10.60 315,287 4.5 n/an/a
Bank840,126 12.00 315,047 4.5 455,068 6.5 
Tier 1 capital (to average assets)
Company771,679 10.17 303,512 4.0 n/an/a
Bank840,126 11.07 303,569 4.0 379,461 5.0 

Dividend Restrictions

Dividends paid by the Bank are subject to certain restrictions imposed by regulatory agencies. Capital requirements further limit the amount of dividends that may be paid by the Bank. The Bank is subject to limitations on dividend payouts if, among other things, it does not have a capital conservation buffer of 2.5% or more. The Bank had a capital conservation buffer of 3.95% as of December 31, 2020. Dividends of $65,000 and $56,750 were paid by the Bank to the Holdco during the years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively. Dividends of $34,057, or $0.17 per outstanding share on the applicable record date, were paid by the Company during the year ended December 31, 2020. Dividends of $26,796, or $0.125 per outstanding share on the applicable record date, were paid by the Company during the year ended December 31, 2019.

F-69



25. Parent Company Only Financial Statements
The following balance sheets, statements of income and statements of cash flows for Veritex Holdings, Inc. should be read in conjunction with the consolidated financial statements and the notes thereto.
Balance Sheet
 December 31,
 20202019
Assets        
Cash and cash equivalents$129,969 $45,563 
Investment in subsidiaries1,335,603 1,289,273 
Other assets4,638 2,780 
Total assets$1,470,210 $1,337,616 
Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity  
Other liabilities$4,056 $1,248 
Other borrowings262,778 145,571 
Total liabilities$266,834 $146,819 
Stockholders’ equity  
Common stock$555 $511 
Additional paid-in capital1,126,437 1,117,879 
Retained earnings172,232 147,911 
Accumulated other comprehensive income56,225 19,061 
Treasury stock(152,073)(94,565)
Total stockholders’ equity1,203,376 1,190,797 
Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity$1,470,210 $1,337,616 

Statements of Income
 Year Ended December 31,
 202020192018
Cash dividends from subsidiary$65,000 $56,750 $— 
Excess of earnings over dividend from subsidiary16,693 43,199 44,850 
Other53 50 20 
81,746 99,999 44,870 
Interest on borrowings8,529 4,672 974 
Salaries and employee benefits612 790 853 
Merger and acquisition expense— 4,942 3,886 
Other798 797 529 
9,939 11,201 6,242 
Earnings before income tax benefit71,807 88,798 38,628 
Income tax benefit(2,076)(1,941)(713)
Net income$73,883 $90,739 $39,341 
F-70




Statements of Cash Flows
 Year Ended December 31,
 202020192018
Cash flows from operating activities:        
Net income$73,883 $90,739 $39,341 
Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by (used in) operating activities:   
Amortization of debt discount and debt issuance costs, net1,263 2,353 
Equity in undistributed net income of Bank(16,693)(43,199)(44,850)
(Increase) decrease in other assets(1,853)(1,861)2,226 
Increase (decrease) in other liabilities726 (5,024)(2,042)
Net cash provided (used in) by operating activities57,326 43,008 (5,323)
Cash flows from investing activities:   
Net cash received in acquisition— 5,818 — 
Net cash used in investing activities— 5,818 — 
Cash flows from financing activities:   
Proceeds from issuance of subordinated notes, net of debt issuance costs paid123,026 75,000 — 
Net proceeds from sale of common stock in public offering— — 
Proceeds from exercise of stock warrants109 — — 
Redemption of subordinated debt(5,000)— — 
Proceeds from exercise of employee stock options4,301 3,938 454 
Payments to tax authorities for stock-based compensation(3,829)(1,346)(593)
Proceeds from payments on ESOP loan— — 109 
Offering costs paid in connection with acquisition— — (899)
Repurchase of treasury stock(57,470)(94,533)— 
Dividends paid(34,057)(26,796)— 
Net cash provided (used in) by financing activities27,080 (43,737)(927)
Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents84,406 5,089 (6,250)
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year45,563 40,474 46,724 
Cash and cash equivalents at end of year$129,969 $45,563 $40,474 

F-71



26. Summary of Quarterly Financial Statements (Unaudited)
The following quarterly information is unaudited. However, in the opinion of management, the information reflects all adjustments, necessary for the fair presentation of the results of operations, for the periods presented.
2020
Fourth QuarterThird QuarterSecond QuarterFirst Quarter
Interest income$78,100 $77,429 $79,342 $86,979 
Interest expense11,334 11,559 13,585 19,574 
Net interest income66,766 65,870 65,757 67,405 
Provision for credit losses— 8,692 16,172 31,776 
Provision for credit losses for unfunded commitments902 1,447 2,799 3,881 
Noninterest income9,012 9,795 21,290 7,247 
Noninterest expense47,373 36,408 40,061 35,545 
Income tax expense (benefit)4,702 6,198 3,987 (684)
Net income$22,801 $22,920 $24,028 $4,134 
Earnings per share:
Basic$0.46 $0.46 $0.48 $0.08 
Diluted0.46 0.46 0.48 0.08 

2019
Fourth QuarterThird QuarterSecond QuarterFirst Quarter
Interest Income$91,742 $95,643 $96,177 $95,224 
Interest Expense21,878 24,769 24,735 22,307 
Net interest income69,864 70,874 71,442 72,917 
Provision for credit losses3,493 9,674 3,335 5,012 
Noninterest income7,132 8,430 6,034 8,484 
Noninterest expense36,284 34,630 39,896 66,993 
Income tax expense8,168 7,595 7,369 1,989 
Net income $29,051 $27,405 $26,876 $7,407 
Earnings per share:
Basic$0.56 $0.52 $0.50 $0.14 
Diluted0.56 0.51 0.49 0.13 



F-72



27. Subsequent Events
On February 24, 2021, the Company announced the termination of $500,000 of an interest rate swap entered into in March 2020 to hedge the variability of cash flow payments attributable to changes in interest rates in regards to forecasted issuances of three-month term debt arrangements every three-months from March 2022 through March 2032. As a result of the interest rate swap termination, the Company expects to recognize a net pre-tax gain of approximately $42,995 into income starting in March 2022 on a straight line basis over a 10 year period.

F-73



Exhibit Index
Exhibit
Number
 Description
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
101*** The following materials from Veritex Holdings Inc.’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2018 (Extensible Business Reporting Language): (i) Consolidated Balance Sheets, (ii) Consolidated Statements of Operations, (iii) Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income (Loss), (iv) Consolidated Statements of Changes in Shareholders’ Equity, (v) Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows, and (vi) Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
104 Cover Page Interactive Data File (formatted as Inline XBRL and contained in Exhibit 101).
F-74




* Filed herewith.
** Furnished herewith.
*** Submitted electronically herewith.
Management contract or compensatory plan or arrangement.


SIGNATURES
Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned thereunto duly authorized.
Date: February 26, 2021Veritex Holdings, Inc.
 By:/s/ C. Malcolm Holland, III
  Name:C. Malcolm Holland, III
  Title:Chairman and Chief Executive Officer
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons, on behalf of the registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated.
F-75



   
   
NameTitleDate
/s/ C. Malcolm Holland, III
C. Malcolm Holland, III
Chairman and Chief Executive Officer
(Principal Executive Officer)
February 26, 2021
/s/ Terry S. Earley
Terry S. Earley
Chief Financial Officer
(Principal Financial and Principal Accounting Officer)
February 26, 2021
/s/ Pat S. Bolin
Pat S. Bolin
DirectorFebruary 26, 2021
/s/ William D. Ellis
William D. Ellis
DirectorFebruary 26, 2021
/s/ Ned N. Fleming, III
Ned N. Fleming, III
DirectorFebruary 26, 2021
/s/ Mark C. Griege
Mark C. Griege
DirectorFebruary 26, 2021
/s/ Steven D. Lerner
Steven D. Lerner
DirectorFebruary 26, 2021
/s/ Manuel J. Mehos
Manuel J. Mehos
DirectorFebruary 26, 2021
/s/ Gregory B. Morrison
Gregory B. Morrison
DirectorFebruary 26, 2021
/s/ John T. Sughrue
John T. Sughrue
DirectorFebruary 26, 2021
/s/ April Box
April Box
DirectorFebruary 26, 2021
/s/ Blake Bozman
Blake Bozman
DirectorFebruary 26, 2021
/s/ William E. Fallon
William E. Fallon
DirectorFebruary 26, 2021
/s/ Gordon Huddleston
Gordon Huddleston
DirectorFebruary 26, 2021
/s/ Arcilia Acosta
Arcilia Acosta
DirectorFebruary 26, 2021

F-76